M98oomodule 1
M98oomodule 1
ISBN 978-81-8441-871-2 1
FOUNDATION COURSE
A
P
E
R 1
1
Board of Studies
The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India October | 2020 | P2748 (Revised)
ICAI Bhawan, A - 29, Sector - 62, Noida - 201 309 BOARD OF STUDIES
Phone : 0120 - 3045930 THE INSTITUTE OF CHARTERED ACCOUNTANTS OF INDIA (ICAI)
E-mail : [email protected]
(SET UP BY AN ACT OF PARLIAMENT)
Website : http://www.icai.org
NEW DELHI
This study material has been prepared by the faculty of the Board of Studies. The objective of the
study material is to provide teaching material to the students to enable them to obtain knowledge
in the subject. In case students need any clarifications or have any suggestions to make for further
improvement of the material contained herein, they may write to the Director of Studies.
All care has been taken to provide interpretations and discussions in a manner useful for the students.
However, the study material has not been specifically discussed by the Council of the Institute or any
of its Committees and the views expressed herein may not be taken to necessarily represent the
views of the Council or any of its Committees.
Permission of the Institute is essential for reproduction of any portion of this material.
All rights reserved. No part of this book may be reproduced, stored in a retrieval system, or
transmitted, in any form, or by any means, electronic, mechanical, photocopying, recording, or
otherwise, without prior permission, in writing, from the publisher.
Website : www.icai.org
E-mail : [email protected]
The Board of Studies, ICAI has revised and updated the study material for Foundation (Entry Level
Exam to the Chartered Accountancy Course). The contents have been designed and developed with
an objective to synchronize the syllabus with the guidelines prescribed by IAESB (International
Accounting Education Standards Board), IFAC (International Federation of Accountants), to instill
and enhance the necessary pre-requisites for becoming a well-rounded, competent and globally
competitive Accounting Professional.
The level of complexity of the study material is as per standards accorded by IAESB comprising an
ideal mix of subjective and objective examination pattern to ensure discerning students get through
and seek admission to the CA Course.
The paper of 'Principles and Practice of Accounting' at Foundation level concentrates on
conceptual understanding of fundamentals of accounting. The objective of this paper is to develop
an understanding of the basic concepts and principles of Accounting and apply the same in
preparing financial statements of non-corporate entitie and simple problem solving.
This Study Material endeavouring towards accounting education, is committed to provide a
framework for understanding accounting discipline and describing the fundamental accounting
concepts and conventions of the basic accounting system. An attempt has been made to provide a
solid foundation on which students can successfully build and enhance their studies.
KNOW YOUR SYLLABUS AND STUDY MATERIAL
The Study Material of Principles and Practice of Accounting has been designed having regard to
the needs of home study and distance learning students. The Study Material has been divided into
ten chapters, each addressing to a special aspect of accounting. Chapters 1 to 5 lay emphasis on
bookkeeping aspect of accounting whereas chapter 7 deals with preparation of financial statements
of sole proprietors. Chapter 6 covers accounting for special transactions like consignment, bills of
exchange, sale of goods on approval basis, and average due date which are useful for different
business entities. Chapter 8 discusses accounting of partnership firms and chapter 9 deals with
financial statements of Not-for-profit organizations. Chapter 10 explains basic concepts of company
accounts.
The study material has been bifurcated into two modules (Module I : Chapters 1 to 6 and Module II:
Chapters 7 to 10) for easy handling and convenience of students. It is important to read the Study
Material thoroughly and practice the questions for understanding the coverage of syllabus.
FRAMEWORK OF CHAPTERS – UNIFORM STRUCTURE COMPRISING OF SPECIFIC
COMPONENTS
Efforts have been made to present each topic of the syllabus in a lucid manner. Care has been
taken to present the chapters in a logical sequence to facilitate easy understanding by the
OBJECTIVE:
To develop an understanding of the basic concepts and principles of Accounting and apply
the same in preparing financial statements and simple problem solving.
CONTENTS:
1. Theoretical Framework
(i) Meaning and Scope of accounting
(ii) Accounting Concepts, Principles and Conventions
(iii) Accounting terminology - Glossary
(iv) Capital and revenue expenditure, Capital and revenue receipts, Contingent assets and
contingent liabilities
(v) Accounting Policies
(vi) Accounting as a Measurement Discipline – Valuation Principles, Accounting Estimates.
(vii) Accounting Standards – Concepts and Objectives.
(viii) Indian Accounting Standards – Concepts and Objectives.
2. Accounting Process
(i) Books of Accounts
(ii) Preparation of Trial Balance
(iii) Rectification of Errors.
3. Bank Reconciliation Statement
Introduction, reasons, preparation of bank reconciliation statement.
4. Inventories
Cost of inventory, Net realizable value, Basis and technique of inventory valuation and record
keeping.
5. Concept and Accounting of Depreciation
Concepts, Methods of computation and accounting treatment of depreciation, Change in
depreciation methods.
6. Accounting for Special Transactions
(i) Bills of exchange and promissory notes
Meaning of Bills of Exchange and Promissory Notes and their Accounting Treatment;
Accommodation bills.
MODULE 1
CHAPTER 1 : Theoretical Framework
CHAPTER 2 : Accounting Process
CHAPTER 3 : Bank Reconciliation Statement
CHAPTER 4 : Inventories
CHAPTER 5 : Concept and Accounting of Depreciation
CHAPTER 6 : Accounting for Special Transactions
MODULE 2
CHAPTER 7 : Preparation of Final Accounts of Sole Proprietors
CHAPTER 8 : Partnership Accounts
CHAPTER 9 : Financial Statements of Not-For-Profit Organizations
CHAPTER 10 : Company Accounts
w Understand the meaning of book-keeping and the distinction of accounting with book-keeping.
w Identify the various user groups for whom accounting information is to be generated.
w Understand the relationship of accounting with Economics, Statistics, Mathematics, Law and
Management.
w Appreciate the enlarged boundary of accounting profession and the areas where in a chartered
accountant plays an important role of rendering useful services to the society.
Input Identification of
transaction
Economic
events and Accounting Cycle Output
transactions
measured
in financial
terms
1.1 INTRODUCTION
Every individual performs some kind of economic activity. A salaried person gets salary and spends to
buy provisions and clothing, for children’s education, construction of house, etc. A sports club formed
by a group of individuals, a business run by an individual or a group of individuals, a local authority like
Calcutta Municipal Corporation, Delhi Development Authority, Governments, either Central or State, all
are carrying some kind of economic activities. Not necessarily all the economic activities are run for any
individual benefit; such economic activities may create social benefit i.e. benefit for the public, at large.
Anyway such economic activities are performed through ‘transactions and events’. Transaction is used
to mean ‘a business, performance of an act, an agreement’ while event is used to mean ‘a happening, as a
consequence of transaction(s), a result.’
An individual invests `2,00,000 for running a stationery business. On 1st January, he purchases goods for
` 1,15,000 and sells for ` 1,47,000 during the month of January. He pays shop rent for the month ` 5,000
and finds that still he has goods worth ` 15,000 in hand. The individual performs an economic activity.
He carries on a few transactions and encounters with some events. Is it not logical that he will want to
know©the result
The of hisofactivity?
Institute Chartered Accountants of India
We see that the individual, who runs the stationery business, earns a surplus of ` 42,000.
`
Goods sold 1,47,000
Goods in hand 15,000
1,62,000
Less : Goods purchased 1,15,000
Shop rent paid 5,000 (1,20,000)
Surplus 42,000
Earning of ` 42,000 surplus is an event; also having the inventories in hand is another event, while purchase
and sale of goods, investment of money and payment of rent are transactions.
Similarly, a municipal corporation got government grant ` 500 lakhs for adult education; it spent ` 250 lakhs
for purchasing literacy kits, paid ` 200 lakhs to the tutors and is left with a balance of ` 50 lakhs. These are
also transactions and events.
Similarly, the Central Government raised money through taxes, paid salaries to the employees, and spent
on various developmental activities. Whenever receipts of the Government are more than expenses it has
surplus, but if expenses are more than receipts it runs in deficit. Here raising money through various sources
can be termed as transaction and surplus or deficit at the end of the accounting year can be termed as an
event.
So, everybody wants to keep records of all transactions and events and to have adequate information about
the economic activity as an aid to decision-making. Accounting discipline has been developed to serve this
purpose as it deals with the measurement of economic activities involving inflow and outflow of economic
resources, which helps to develop useful information for decision-making process.
Accounting has universal application for recording transactions and events and presenting suitable
information to aid decision-making regarding any type of economic activity ranging from a family function
to functions of the national government. But hereinafter we shall concentrate only on business activities
and their accounting because the objective of this study material is to provide a basic understanding on
accounting for business activities. Nevertheless, it will give adequate knowledge to think coherently of
accounting as a field of study for universal application.
The growth of accounting discipline is closely associated with the development of the business world. Thus,
to understand accounting as a field of study for universal application, it is best identified with recording of
business transactions and communication of financial information about business enterprise to facilitate
decision-making. The aim of accounting is to meet the information needs of the rational and sound decision-
makers, and thus, called the language of business.
As per this definition, accounting is simply an art of record keeping. The process of accounting starts by
first identifying the events and transactions which are of financial character and then be recorded in the
books of account. This recording is done in Journal or subsidiary books, also known as primary books. Every
good record keeping system includes suitable classification of transactions and events as well as their
summarisation for ready reference. After the transactions and events are recorded, they are transferred to
secondary books i.e. Ledger. In ledger, transactions and events are classified in terms of income, expense,
assets and liabilities according to their characteristics and summarised in profit and loss account and balance
sheet. Essentially the transactions and events are to be measured in terms of money. Measurement in terms
of money means measuring at the ruling currency of a country, for example, rupee in India, dollar in U.S.A.
and like. The transactions and events must have at least in part, financial characteristics. The inauguration
of a new branch of a bank is an event without having financial character, while the business disposed of by
the branch is an event having financial character. Accounting also interprets the recorded, classified and
summarised transactions and events.
However, the above-mentioned definition does not reflect the present day accounting function. The
dimension of accounting is much broader than that described in the above definition. According to the
above definition, accounting ends with interpretation of the results of the financial transactions and events
but in the modern world with the diversification of management and ownership, globalisation of business
and society gaining more interest in the functioning of the enterprises, the importance of communicating
the accounting results has increased and therefore, this requirement of communicating and motivating
informed judgement has also become the part of accounting as defined in the widely accepted definition
of accounting, given by the American Accounting Association in 1966 which treated accounting as:
“The process of identifying, measuring and communicating economic information to permit informed
judgments and decisions by the users of accounts.”
In 1970, the Accounting Principles Board (APB) of American Institute of Certified Public Accountants (AICPA)
enumerated the functions of accounting as follows:
“The function of accounting is to provide quantitative information, primarily of financial nature, about
economic entities, that is needed to be useful in making economic decisions.”
Thus, accounting may be defined as the process of recording, classifying, summarising, analysing and
interpreting the financial transactions and communicating the results thereof to the persons interested in
such information.
1.2.1 Procedural aspects of Accounting
On the basis of the above definitions, procedure of accounting can be basically divided into two parts:
(i) Generating financial information and
(ii) Using the financial information.
Generating Financial Information
1. Recording – This is the basic function of accounting. All business transactions of a financial character,
as evidenced by some documents such as sales bill, pass book, salary slip etc. are recorded in the books
of account. Recording is done in a book called “Journal.” This book may further be divided into several
subsidiary books according to the nature and size of the business. Students will learn how to prepare
journal and various subsidiary books in chapter 2.
2. Classifying – Classification is concerned with the systematic analysis of the recorded data, with a
view to group transactions or entries of one nature at one place so as to put information in compact
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
and usable form. The book containing classified information is called “Ledger”. This book contains
on different pages, individual account heads under which, all financial transactions of similar nature
are collected. For example, there may be separate account heads for Salaries, Rent, Printing and
Stationeries, Advertisement etc. All expenses under these heads, after being recorded in the Journal,
will be classified under separate heads in the Ledger. This will help in finding out the total expenditure
incurred under each of the above heads. Students will learn how to prepare ledger books in chapter 2.
3. Summarising – It is concerned with the preparation and presentation of the classified data in a manner
useful to the internal as well as the external users of financial statements. This process leads to the
preparation of the financial statements.
4. Analysing – The term ‘Analysis’ means methodical classification of the data given in the financial
statements. The figures given in the financial statements will not help anyone unless they are in a
simplified form. For example, all items relating to fixed assets are put at one place while all items relating
to current assets are put at another place. It is concerned with the establishment of relationship between
the items of the Profit and Loss Account and Balance Sheet i.e. it provides the basis for interpretation.
Students will learn this aspect of financial statements in the later stages of the Chartered Accountancy
Course.
5. Interpreting – This is the final function of accounting. It is concerned with explaining the meaning and
significance of the relationship as established by the analysis of accounting data. The recorded financial
data is analysed and interpreted in a manner that will enable the end-users to make a meaningful
judgement about the financial condition and profitability of the business operations. The financial
statement should explain not only what had happened but also why it happened and what is likely to
happen under specified conditions.
6. Communicating – It is concerned with the transmission of summarised, analysed and interpreted
information to the end-users to enable them to make rational decisions. This is done through preparation
and distribution of accounting reports, which include besides the usual profit and loss account and
the balance sheet, additional information in the form of accounting ratios, graphs, diagrams, fund
flow statements etc. Students will learn this aspect of financial statements in the later stages of the
Chartered Accountancy Course.
The first two procedural stages of the process of generating financial information along with the preparation
of trial balance are covered under book-keeping while the preparation of financial statements and its
analysis, interpretation and also its communication to the various users are considered as accounting stages.
Students will learn the term book-keeping and its distinction with accounting, in the coming topics of this
unit.
Using the Financial Information
There are certain users of accounts. Earlier it was viewed that accounting is meant for the proprietor or
owner of the business, but changing social relationships diluted the earlier thinking. It is now believed
that besides the owner or the management of the business enterprise, users of accounts include the
investors, employees, lenders, suppliers, customers, government and other agencies and the public at large.
Accounting provides the art of presenting information systematically to the users of accounts. Accounting
data is more useful if it stresses economic substance rather than technical form. Information is useless and
meaningless unless it is relevant and material to a user’s decision. The information should also be free of any
biases. The users should understand not only the financial results depicted by the accounting figures, but
also should be able to assess its reliability and compare it with information about alternative opportunities
and the past experience. The owners or the management of the enterprise, commonly known as internal
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
users, use the accounting information in an analytical manner to take the valuable decisions for the business.
So the information served to them is presented in a manner different to the information presented to the
external users. Even the small details which can affect the internal working of the business are given in the
management report while financial statements presented to the external users contains key information
regarding assets, liabilities and capital which are summarised in a logical manner that helps them in their
respective decision-making.
2. Ascertainment of results of above recorded transactions – Accountant prepares profit and loss
account to know the results of business operations for a particular period of time. If revenue exceed
expenses then it is said that business is running profitably but if expenses exceed revenue then it
can be said that business is running under loss. The profit and loss account helps the management
and different stakeholders in taking rational decisions. For example, if business is not proved to be
remunerative or profitable, the cause of such a state of affair can be investigated by the management
for taking remedial steps.
3. Ascertainment of the financial position of the business – Businessman is not only interested in
knowing the results of the business in terms of profits or loss for a particular period but is also anxious
to know that what he owes (liability) to the outsiders and what he owns (assets) on a certain date. To
know this, accountant prepares a financial position statement popularly known as Balance Sheet. The
balance sheet is a statement of assets and liabilities of the business at a particular point of time and
helps in ascertaining the financial health of the business.
5. To know the solvency position – By preparing the balance sheet, management not only reveals what
is owned and owed by the enterprise, but also it gives the information regarding concern’s ability to
meet its liabilities in the short run (liquidity position) and also in the long-run (solvency position) as and
when they fall due.
Objectives of Accounting
Systematic Communicating
Recording of Ascertainment of Ascertainment of
Information to
Transactions Results Financial Position
various Users
Book-keeping: Manufacturing,
Journal, Leader and Trading, Profit and Balance Sheet Financial Reports
Trial Balance Loss Account
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
1.6 BOOK-KEEPING
Book-keeping is an activity concerned with the recording of financial data relating to business operations
in a significant and orderly manner. It covers procedural aspects of accounting work and embraces record
keeping function. Obviously, book-keeping procedures are governed by the end product, the financial
statements. The term ‘financial statements’ means Profit and Loss Account, Balance Sheet and cash flow
statements including Schedules and Notes forming part of Accounts.
Book-keeping also requires suitable classification of transactions and events. This is also determined with
reference to the requirement of financial statements. A book-keeper may be responsible for keeping all
the records of a business or only of a minor segment, such as position of the customers’ accounts in a
departmental store. Accounting is based on a careful and efficient book-keeping system.
The essential idea behind maintaining book-keeping records is to show correct position regarding each
head of income and expenditure. A business may purchase goods on credit as well as in cash. When the
goods are bought on credit, a record must be kept of the person to whom money is owed. The proprietor of
the business may like to know, from time to time, what amount is due on credit purchase and to whom. If
proper record is not maintained, it is not possible to get details of the transactions in regard to the incomes and expenses.
At the end of the accounting period, the proprietor wants to know how much profit has been earned or
loss has been incurred during the course of the period. For this lot of information is needed which can be
gathered from a proper record of the transactions. Therefore, in book-keeping, the proper maintenance of
books of account is indispensable for any business.
At this level, the major concern of the curriculum is with book-keeping and preparation of financial
statements. It seems important to mention at this point that book-keeping and preparation of financial
statements have legal implications also. Maintenance of books of accounts and the preparation of financial
statements of a company are guided by the Companies Act, banks and insurance companies by special Acts
governing these institutions and so on. However, for sole-proprietorship and partnership business, there is
no specific legislation regarding maintenance of books of accounts and preparation of financial statements.
Accountancy
Accounting
Book Keeping
(iii) Lenders: They are interested to know whether their loan-principal and interest will be paid back when due.
(iv) Suppliers and Creditors: They are also interested to know the ability of the enterprise to pay their
dues, that helps them to decide the credit policy for the relevant concern, rates to be charged and
so on. Sometimes, they also become interested in long-term continuation of the enterprise if their
existence becomes dependent on the survival of that business.
(v) Customers: Customers are also concerned with the stability and profitability of the enterprise because
their functioning is more or less dependent on the supply of goods, suppose, a company produces
some chemicals used by pharmaceutical companies and supplies chemicals on three month’s credit. If
all of a sudden it faces some trouble and is unable to supply the chemical, the customers will also be in
trouble.
(vi) Government and their agencies: They regulate the functioning of business enterprises for public
good, allocate scarce resources among competing enterprises, control prices, charge excise duties and
taxes, and so they have continued interest in the business enterprise.
(vii) Public: The public at large is interested in the functioning of the enterprise because it may make a
substantial contribution to the local economy in many ways including the number of people employed
and their patronage to local suppliers.
(viii) Management : Management as whole is also interested in the accounts for various managerial
decisions. On the basis of the accounts, management determines the effects of their various decisions
on the functioning of the organisation. This helps them to make further managerial decisions.
but these are moulded in the work environment and suitably tempered with reference to relevance,
verifiability, freedom from bias, timeliness, comparability, reliability and understand ability.
An example may be given to explain the nexus between accounting and economics. Economists think
that value of an asset is the present value of all future earnings which can be derived from such assets.
Now think about a plant whose working life is more than one hundred years. How can you estimate
future stream of earnings? So accountants developed the workable valuation base – the acquisition
cost i.e., the price paid to acquire the assets.
At the macro-level, accounting provides the database over which the economic decision models have
been developed; micro-level data arranged by the accounting system is summed up to get macro-level
database.
Non-overlapping zones of accounting are not negligible. Development of the systems of recording,
classifying and summarising transactions and events, harmonising the systems by uniform rules and
communicating the data is essentially a non-overlapping area of accounting.
(b) Accounting and Statistics: The use of statistics in accounting can be appreciated better in the context of
the nature of accounting records. Accounting information is very precise; it is exact to the last paisa. But,
for decision-making purposes such precision is not necessary and hence, the statistical approximations
are sought.
In accounts, all values are important individually because they relate to business transactions. As
against this, statistics is concerned with the typical value, behaviour or trend over a period of time or
the degree of variation over a series of observations. Therefore, wherever a need arises for only broad
generalisations or the average of relationships, statistical methods have to be applied in accounting
data.
Further, in accountancy, the classification of assets and liabilities as well as the heads of income and
expenditure has been done as per the needs of financial recording to ascertain financial results of
various operations. Other types of classification like the geographical and historical ones and ad hoc
classification are done depending on the purpose to make such classification meaningful.
Accounting records generally take a short-term view of events and are confined to a year while statistical
analysis is more useful if a longer view is taken for the purpose. For example, to fit the trend line a longer
period will be required. However, statistical methods do use past accounting records maintained on a
consistent basis.
The functional relations showing mathematical relations of one variable with one or more other
variables are based on statistical work. These relations are used widely in making cost or price estimates
for some estimated future values assigned to the given independent variables. For example, given the
functional relation of total cost to the price of an input, the effect of changes in future prices on the cost
of production can be calculated.
In accountancy, a number of financial and other ratios are based on statistical methods, which help
in averaging them over a period of time. Several accounting and financial calculations are based on
statistical formulae.
Statistical methods are helpful in developing accounting data and in their interpretation. For example,
time series and cross-sectional comparison of accounting data is based on statistical techniques. Now-
a-days multiple discriminate analysis is popularly used to identify symptoms of sickness of a business
firm. Therefore, the study and application of statistical methods would add extra edge to the accounting
data.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
(c) Accounting and Mathematics: Double Entry book-keeping can be converted in algebraic form; in fact
the first known book on this subject was part of a treatise on algebra. The fundamental accounting
equation will be discussed in detail under ‘Dual Aspect Concept’ of this chapter.
Knowledge of arithmetic and algebra is a pre-requisite for accounting computations and measurements.
Calculations of interest and annuity are the examples of such fundamental uses. While computing
depreciation, finding out installments in hire-purchase and instalments payment transactions,
calculating amount to be set aside for repayment of loan and replacement of assets and calculating
lease rentals, mathematical techniques are frequently used. Accounting data are also presented in ratio
form.
With the advent of the computer, mathematics is becoming a vital part of accounting. Instead of writing
accounts in traditional fashion, the transactions and events can be recorded in the matrix form and the
rules of matrix algebra can be applied for classifying and summarising data.
Now-a-days statistics and econometric models are largely used for developing decision models for
the users of accounts. Also, Operations Research Techniques provide lot of decision models. Since
accounting is meant for providing information to the users, to be effective, accounting data should
feed the information requirements of such statistical, econometric and operations research models.
Understanding mathematics has become a must to grasp the decision models framed by statisticians,
econometricians and the O.R. experts.
Presently graphs and charts are being extensively used for communicating accounting information. In
addition to statistical knowledge, knowledge in geometry and trigonometry seems to be essential to
have a better understanding about the accounting communications system.
(d) Accounting and Law: An economic entity operates within a legal environment. All transactions with
suppliers and customers are governed by the Contract Act, the Sale of Goods Act, the Negotiable
Instruments Act, etc. The entity itself is created and controlled by laws. For example, a company is
created by the Companies Act and also controlled by Companies Act.
Similarly, every country has a set of economic, fiscal and labour laws. Transactions and events are always
guided by laws of the land. Very often the accounting system to be followed has been prescribed by the
law. For example, the Companies Act has prescribed the format of financial statements for companies.
Banking, insurance and electric supply undertakings may also have to produce financial statements as
prescribed by the respective legislations controlling such entities.
However, legal prescription about the accounting system is the product of developments in accounting
knowledge. That is to say, legislation about accounting system cannot be enacted unless there is a
corresponding development in the accounting discipline. In that way accounting influences law and is
also influenced by law.
(e) Accounting and Management: Management is a broad occupational field, which comprises many
functions and encompasses application of many disciplines including those mentioned above.
Accountants are well placed in the management and play a key role in the management team. A
large portion of accounting information is prepared for management decision-making. Although
management relies on other data sources, accounting data are used as basic source documents. In the
management team, an accountant is in a better position to understand and use such data. In other
words, since an accountant plays an active role in management, he understands the data requirements.
So the accounting system can be moulded to serve the management purpose.
An accountant with his education, training, analytical mind and experience is best qualified to provide
multiple need-based services to the ever growing society. The accountants of today can do full justice not
only to matters relating to taxation, costing, management accounting, financial lay-out, company legislation
and procedures but they can delve deep into the fields relating to financial policies, budgetary policies and
even economic principles. The area of activities which can be undertaken by the accountants is not limited
but it can also cover many additional facets.
1.12.1 Areas of Service
The practice of accountancy has crossed its usual domain of preparation of financial statements, interpretation
of such statements and audit thereof. Accountants are presently taking active role in company laws and other
corporate legislation matters, in taxation laws matters (both direct and indirect) and in general management
problems. Some of the services rendered by accountants to the society are briefly mentioned hereunder:
(i) Maintenance of Books of Accounts: An accountant is able to maintain a systematic record of financial
transactions in order to establish the net result of the transactions entered into during a period and to
state the financial position of the concern as at a particular date.
For the fulfillment of the twin objective of ascertaining the profit earned or loss suffered and the financial
position, it is necessary that all transactions be recorded in a systematic manner, which can be done
only by an accountant. Proper maintenance of books of accounts assists management in planning,
decision-making, controlling functions.
(ii) Statutory Audit: Every limited company is required to appoint a chartered accountant or a firm of
chartered accountants as their auditor who are statutorily required to report each year whether in their
opinion the balance sheet shows a true and fair view of the state of affairs on the balance sheet date,
and the profit and loss account shows a true and fair view of the profit or loss for the year.
Auditing is not confined to the accounts of companies; other organisations may also have their accounts
audited, either because the law so requires (for example, the Co-operative Societies Act, the Income-tax
Act, etc.) or because the proprietors wisely decided so (for example, a partnership firm or an individual
trader).
(iii) Internal Audit: It is a management tool whereby an internal auditor thoroughly examines the
accounting transactions and also the system, according to which these have been recorded with a view
to ensure the management that the accounts are being properly maintained and the system contains
adequate safeguards to check any leakage of revenue or misappropriation of property or assets and the
operations have been carried out in conformity with the plans of management.
Now-a-days internal auditing has developed as a service to management. The internal auditor
constructively contributes in improving the operational efficiency of the business through an
independent review and appraisal of all business operations.
(iv) Taxation: An accountant can handle taxation matters of a business or a person and he can represent
that business or person before the tax authorities and settle the tax liability under the statute prevailing.
He can also assist in avoiding or reducing tax burden by proper planning of tax affairs.
Accountants also have a social obligation to express their views on broad tax policy, on the effect of tax
rate on business and the economy in general and on all other aspects of taxation in which they have
knowledge superior to that of the general public.
(v) Management Accounting and Consultancy Services: Management accountant performs an
advisory function. He is largely responsible for internal reporting to the management for planning and
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
controlling current operations, decision-making on special matters and for formulating long-range
plans. His job is to collect, analyse, interpret and present all accounting information which is useful to
the management. Accountant provides management consultancy services in the areas of management
information system, expenditure control and evaluation of appraisal techniques for new investments
and divestments, working capital management, corporate planning etc.
(vi) Financial Advice: Many people need help and guidance in planning their personal financial affairs. An
accountant who knows about finances, taxation and family problems is well placed to give such advice.
Some of the areas in which an accountant can render financial advice are:
(a) Investments: An accountant can explain the significance of the formidable documents which
shareholders receive from companies and help in making decisions relating to their investments.
(b) Insurance: An accountant can provide information to his clients on various insurance policies and
helps in choosing appropriate policy.
(c) Business Expansion: As businesses grow in size and complexity and mergers are being considered,
accountants are in the forefront in interpreting accounts, making suggestions as to the form of
schemes and the fairness of proposals considering cost and financial consequences and generally
advising their clients. They also advise on how to set about the problem of borrowing money or
whether this is an appropriate method of finance. Accountants can render extremely useful service
in connection of negotiations with foreign collaborators.
(d) Investigations: Financial investigations are required for a variety of purposes. Examples are:
(i) To ascertain the financial position of a business, for the information of interested parties in
connection with an issue of capital, the purchase or sale of the business or a reconstruction or
amalgamation.
(ii) To help the management to decide whether it is cheaper to manufacture an article or to buy
out.
(iii) To ascertain why profits have fallen.
(iv) To achieve greater efficiency in management.
(v) To ascertain whether fraud has occurred and if so, its nature and extent and to make suggestions
which will help to prevent a recurrence.
(vi) To value businesses and shares in private companies for purposes such as purchase, sale, estate
duty or wealth tax etc.
For such problems requiring financial investigation, you need an accountant. His task as an
independent professional is to establish the facts fairly and clearly for the benefit of those who have
to make decisions and to give advice in many areas in which he has competence and experience.
(e) Pension schemes: Specialist advice from actuaries, insurance agents or insurance company is
needed before launching or amending a provident fund or pension scheme in a business. But
before making a final decision, an accountant has to be consulted. Later on, his help may be needed
for managing the scheme or obtaining tax relief.
(vii) Other Services
(a) Secretarial Work: Companies, clubs, and associations indeed, virtually all organisations involve
secretarial work. Accountants frequently do this work.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
(b) Share Registration Work: Accountants are often used by many companies to undertake the work
involved in registering share transfers and new issues.
(c) Company Formation: In conjunction with legal advisers, accountants help in the formation of a
company or advise against doing so.
(d) Receiverships, Liquidations, etc.: An accountant has to sometimes take on the onerous duties of
liquidator when a company is being wound up or receiver when a debenture holder exercises a
right to recover a loan on which the borrower has defaulted. Accountant is just the man for the job.
He is also just the man to help you to keep insolvency away if you consult him in time.
(e) Arbitrations: At times, accountants are invited by parties to act as arbitrators in a dispute or settle
disputes of various kinds.
(f ) As regards the Cost Accounts: A cost accountant’s job is to continuously report cost data and related
information at frequent intervals to the management.
(g) Accountant and Information Services: An accountant will be effective in his role if he supplies the
information promptly and in an unambiguous language. He should develop a system by which
there is a regular flow of information both horizontally and vertically.
The information system should be such that comparability of financial statement is possible both
business-wise and year-wise so that it benefits both the management and the investors. Dependence
on data from the computerised information system will put new responsibilities on an accountant but
his product will command greater attention and respect.
1.12.2 Chartered Accountant in Industry
An accountant, though he is a part of the highest planning team is not a planner in an industry. He works
with the functional departments and translates the organisation’s aims in terms of financial expectations.
Therefore, he has to make a thorough study of the business and of individuals in the functional departments,
whether they are engineers or salesmen. A qualified accountant will be able to play an important role
in performing important functions of a business relating to accounting, costing and budgetary control,
estimating and treasury.
1.12.3 Chartered Accountant in Public Sector Enterprises
Both in the developed and developing countries, public sector enterprises have become a special feature of the
national economy. The system of financial and budgetary control and of accounting, auditing and reporting
has, therefore, become a matter of interest and concern to the nation, and does not remain confined merely
to a limited number of shareholders. The form of accounting followed by these corporations or companies
is different from that of ordinary government accounting. It is the duty of the accountants to prepare the
accounts and reports of these public corporations in such a way that they enable the general public to know
how far the items appearing in the various types of records and financial statements justify their existence.
1.12.4 Chartered Accountant in Framing Fiscal Policies
Accountants have a positive role to play in the determination of proper fiscal policies and advancement of
trade, commerce and industry. They should develop new techniques and prepare themselves for new fields
of service towards their commitment to the concept of the public goods and services. A business enterprise
can be successful in the commercial sense only if accounting and business knowledge are pooled together.
It is a social obligation for both accountants in industry and in practice to disclose greater information
regarding the corporate results. The state of affairs of the economy can be ascertained only when such
consolidated corporate information is disclosed.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
SUMMARY
w “Accounting is the art of recording, classifying, and summarising in a significant manner and in terms of
money, transactions and events which are, in part at least, of a financial character, and interpreting the
result thereof.”
w Accounting procedure can be basically divided into two parts:
(i) Generating financial information and
(ii) Using the financial information.
w The objectives of accounting can be given as follows:
(i) Systematic recording of transactions
(ii) Ascertainment of results of above recorded transactions
(iii) Ascertainment of the financial position of the business
(iv) Providing information to the users for rational decision-making
(v) To know the solvency position
w The main functions of accounting are as follows:
(i) Measurement (ii) Forecasting
(iii) Decision-making (iv) Comparison & Evaluation
(v) Control (vi) Government Regulation and Taxation
w Objectives of Book-keeping:
(i) Complete Recording of Transactions and
(ii) Ascertainment of Financial Effect on the Business
w The various sub-fields of accounting are:
(i) Financial Accounting (ii) Management Accounting
(iii) Cost Accounting (iv) Social Responsibility Accounting
(v) Human Resource Accounting
w The various users of accounting information:
(i) Investors (ii) Employees
(iii) Lenders (iv) Suppliers and Creditors
(v) Customers (vi) Government and their agencies
(vii) Public (viii) Management
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
w Accounting is closely related with several other disciplines and thus to acquire a good knowledge in
accounting one should be conversant with the relevant portions of such disciplines.
An accountant with his education, training, analytical mind and experience is best qualified to provide
multiple need-based services to the ever growing society. The accountants of today can do full justice not
only to matters relating to taxation, costing, management accounting, financial lay-out, company legislation
and procedures but they can delve deep into the fields relating to financial policies, budgetary policies and
even economic principles.
(a) Accounting.
(b) Book-keeping.
(c) Management Accounting.
(a) Creditors/Suppliers
(b) Lenders/ Customers
(c) Both (a) and (b)
(a) An event.
(b) A transaction.
(c) A transaction as well as an event.
10. On March 31, 2020 after sale of goods worth ` 2,000, he is left with the closing inventory of ` 10,000.
This is
(a) An event.
(b) A transaction.
(c) A transaction as well as an event.
Theoretical Questions
1. Define accounting. What are the sub-fields of accounting?
4. Discuss the limitations which must be kept in mind while evaluating the Financial Statements.
Theoretical Questions
1. Accounting is the art of recording, classifying, and summarising in a significant manner and in terms
of money, transactions and events which are, in part at least, of a financial character, and interpreting
the result thereof. Various subfields of accounting are listed as: Financial Accounting; Management
Accounting; Cost Accounting; Social Responsibility Accounting and Human Resource Accounting.
2. Users of accounts can be listed as Investors, Employees, Lenders, Suppliers and Creditors, Customers,
Govt. and their agencies, public and Management.
3. Refer para 1.10 for understanding the relationship of Accounting with Economics, Statistics and Law.
4. Limitations which must be kept in mind while evaluating the Financial Statements are as follows:
w The factors which may be relevant in assessing the worth of the enterprise don’t find place in the
accounts as they cannot be measured in terms of money.
w Balance Sheet shows the position of the business on the day of its preparation and not on the
future date while the users of the accounts are interested in knowing the position of the business
in the near future and also in long run and not for the past date.
w Accounting ignores changes in some money factors like inflation etc.
w There are occasions when accounting principles conflict with each other.
w Certain accounting estimates depend on the sheer personal judgement of the accountant.
w Different accounting policies for the treatment of same item adds to the probability of manipulations.
5. The practice of accountancy has crossed its usual domain of preparation of financial statements,
interpretation of such statements and audit thereof. Accountants are presently taking active role
in company laws and other corporate legislation matters, in taxation laws matters (both direct and
indirect) and in general management problems. For details, refer Para 1.12.
w Grasp the basic accounting concepts, principles and conventions and observe their implications while
recording transactions and events.
ª Going Concern
ª Consistency
ª Accrual
w Understand the qualitative characteristics that will help to develop the skill in course of time to prepare
financial statements.
Entity concept
Periodicity concept
Matching concept
Realisation concept
Conservatism
Consistency
Materiality
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Let us imagine a situation where you are a proprietor and you take copies of your books of account to five
different accountants. You ask them to prepare the financial statements on the basis of the above records
and to calculate the profits of the business for the year. After few days, they are ready with the financial
statements and all the five accountants have calculated five different amounts of profits and that too with
very wide variations among them. Guess in such a situation what impact would it leave on you about
accounting profession. To avoid this, a generally accepted set of rules have been developed. This generally
accepted set of rules provides unity of understanding and unity of approach in the practice of accounting
and also in better preparation and presentation of the financial statements.
Accounting is a language of the business. Financial statements prepared by the accountant communicate
financial information to the various stakeholders for decision-making purpose. Therefore, it is important
that financial statements prepared by different organizations should be prepared on uniform basis. Also
there should be consistency over a period of time in the preparation of these financial statements. If every
accountant starts following his own norms and notions for accounting of different items then there will be
an utter confusion.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
To avoid confusion and to achieve uniformity, accounting process is applied within the conceptual
framework of ‘Generally Accepted Accounting Principles’ (GAAPs). The term GAAPs is used to describe rules
developed for the preparation of the financial statements and are called concepts, conventions, postulates,
principles etc. These GAAPs are the backbone of the accounting information system, without which the
whole system cannot even stand erectly. These principles are the ground rules, which define the parameters
and constraints within which accounting reports are generated. Accounting principles are basic norms and
assumptions on which the whole accounting system has been developed and established. Accountant
also adheres to various accounting standards issued by the regulatory authority for the standardization of
accounting policies to be followed under specific circumstances. These conceptual frameworks, GAAPs and
accounting standards are considered as the theory base of accounting.
`
Capital 7,00,000
Machinery 5,00,000
Cash 2,00,000
This means that the enterprise owes to Mr. X ` 7,00,000. Now if Mr. X spends ` 5,000 to meet his family
expenses from the business fund, then it should not be taken as business expenses and would be
charged to his capital account (i.e., his investment would be reduced by ` 5,000). Following the entity
concept the revised financial position would be
Liability ` `
Capital 7,00,000
Less : Drawings (5,000) 6,95,000
Machinery 5,00,000
Cash 1,95,000
(b) Money measurement concept: As per this concept, only those transactions, which can be measured in
terms of money are recorded. Since money is the medium of exchange and the standard of economic
value, this concept requires that those transactions alone that are capable of being measured in terms
of money be only to be recorded in the books of accounts. Transactions, even if, they affect the results of
the business materially, are not recorded if they are not convertible in monetary terms. Transactions and
events that cannot be expressed in terms of money are not recorded in the business books. For example;
employees of the organization are, no doubt, the assets of the organizations but their measurement in
monetary terms is not possible therefore, not included in the books of account of the organization.
Measuring unit for money is taken as the currency of the ruling country i.e., the ruling currency of a
country provides a common denomination for the value of material objects.
It may be mentioned that when transactions occur across the boundary of a country, one may see many
currencies. Suppose a businessman sells goods worth ` 50 lakhs at home and he also sells goods worth
of 1 lakh Euro in the United States. What is his total sales? ` 50 lakhs plus 1 lakh Euro.
These are not amenable to even arithmetic treatment. So transactions are to be recorded at uniform
monetary unit i.e. in one currency. Suppose EURO 1 = ` 71.
Total Sales = ` 50 lakhs plus 71 lakhs = ` 121 lakhs. Money Measurement Concept imparts the essential
flexibility for measurement and interpretation of accounting data.
This concept ignores that money is an inelastic yardstick for measurement as it is based on the implicit
assumption that purchasing power of the money is not of sufficient importance as to require adjustment.
Also, many material transactions and events are not recorded in the books of accounts just because
theycannot be measured in monetary terms. Therefore it is recognized by all the accountants that this
concept has its own limitations and inadequacies. Yet it is used for accounting purposes because it is
not possible to adopt a better measurement scale.
Entity and money measurement are viewed as the basic concepts on which other procedural concepts
hinge.
(c) Periodicity concept: This is also called the concept of definite accounting period. As per ‘going concern’
concept an indefinite life of the entity is assumed. For a business entity it causes inconvenience to
measure performance achieved by the entity in the ordinary course of business.
If a textile mill lasts for 100 years, it is not desirable to measure its performance as well as financial
position only at the end of its life.
So a small but workable fraction of time is chosen out of infinite life cycle of the business entity for
measuring performance and looking at the financial position. Generally one year period is taken up for
performance measurement and appraisal of financial position. However, it may also be 6 months or 9
months or 15 months.
According to this concept accounts should be prepared after every period & not at the end of the life of
the entity. Usually this period is one calendar year. We generally follow from 1st April of a year to 31st
March of the immediately following year.
Thus, for performance appraisal it is not necessary to look into the revenue and expenses of an unduly
long time-frame. This concept makes the accounting system workable and the term ‘accrual’ meaningful.
If one thinks of indefinite time-frame, nothing will accrue. There cannot be unpaid expenses and non-
receipt of revenue. Accrued expenses or accrued revenue is only with reference to a finite time-frame
which is called accounting period.
Thus, the periodicity concept facilitates in:
(i) Comparing of financial statements of different periods
(ii) Uniform and consistent accounting treatment for ascertaining the profit and assets of the business
(iii) Matching periodic revenues with expenses for getting correct results of the business operations
(d) Accrual concept: Under accrual concept, the effects of transactions and other events are recognised
on mercantile basis i.e., when they occur (and not as cash or a cash equivalent is received or paid) and
they are recorded in the accounting records and reported in the financial statements of the periods
to which they relate. Financial statements prepared on the accrual basis inform users not only of past
events involving the payment and receipt of cash but also of obligations to pay cash in the future and
of resources that represent cash to be received in the future.
To understand accrual assumption knowledge of revenues and expenses is required. Revenue is the
gross
© Theinflow of cash,
Institute receivables
of Chartered and other
Accountants ofconsideration
India arising in the course of the ordinary activities
of an enterprise from sale of goods, from rendering services and from the use by others of enterprise’s
resources yielding interest, royalties and dividends. For example, (1) Mr. X started a cloth merchandising.
He invested ` 50,000, bought merchandise worth ` 50,000. He sold such merchandise for ` 60,000.
Customers paid him ` 50,000 cash and assure him to pay ` 10,000 shortly. His revenue is ` 60,000. It
arose in the ordinary course of cloth business; Mr. X received ` 50,000 in cash and ` 10,000 by way of
receivables.
Take another example; (2) an electricity supply undertaking supplies electricity spending ` 16,00,000
for fuel and wages and collects electricity bill in one month ` 20,00,000 by way of electricity charges.
This is also revenue which arose from rendering services.
Lastly, (3) Mr. A invested ` 1,00,000 in a business. He purchased a machine paying ` 1,00,000. He rented
it for ` 20,000 annually to Mr. B. ` 20,000 is the revenue of Mr. A; it arose from the use of the enterprise’s
resources.
Expense is a cost relating to the operations of an accounting period or to the revenue earned during the
period or the benefits of which do not extend beyond that period.
In the first example, Mr. X spent ` 50,000 to buy the merchandise; it is the expense of generating revenue
of ` 60,000. In the second instance ` 16,00,000 are the expenses. Also whenever any asset is used it has
a finite life to generate benefit. Suppose, the machine purchased by Mr. A in the third example will last
for 10 years only. Then ` 10,000 is the expense every year relating to the cost of machinery.
Accrual means recognition of revenue and costs as they are earned or incurred and not as money is
received or paid. The accrual concept relates to measurement of income, identifying assets and liabilities.
Example: Mr. J D buys clothing of ` 50,000 paying cash ` 20,000 and sells at ` 60,000 of which customers
paid only ` 50,000.
His revenue is ` 60,000, not ` 50,000 cash received. Expense (i.e., cost incurred for the revenue) is
` 50,000, not ` 20,000 cash paid. So the accrual concept based profit is ` 10,000 (Revenue – Expenses).
As per Accrual Concept : Revenue – Expenses = Profit
Accrual Concept provides the foundation on which the structure of present day accounting has been
developed.
Alternative as per Cash basis
Cash received in ordinary course of business – Cash paid in ordinary course of business = profit.
Timing of revenue and expense booking could be different from cash receipt or paid.
i) when cash received before revenue is booked - a liability is created when cash is received in
advance
ii) when cash received after revenue is booked - an asset called Trade receivables is created
iii) when cash paid before expense is booked - creates an asset called Trade Advance when
cash is paid in advance
iv)when cash paid after expense is booked - creates a liability called payables or Trade
payables or outstanding liabilities
(e) Matching concept: In this concept, all expenses matched with the revenue of that period should only
be taken into consideration. In the financial statements of the organization if any revenue is recognized
then expenses related to earn that revenue should also be recognized.
This concept is based on accrual concept as it considers the occurrence of expenses and income and
do not concentrate on actual inflow or outflow of cash. This leads to adjustment of certain items like
prepaid and outstanding expenses, unearned or accrued incomes.
It is not necessary that every expense identify every income. Some expenses are directly related to the
revenue and some are time bound. For example:- selling expenses are directly related to sales but rent,
salaries etc are recorded on accrual basis for a particular accounting period. In other words periodicity
concept has also been followed while applying matching concept.
Mr. P K started cloth business. He purchased 10,000 pcs. garments @ ` 100 per piece and sold 8,000 pcs.
@ ` 150 per piece during the accounting period of 12 months 1st January to 31st December, 2019. He
paid shop rent @ ` 3,000 per month for 11 months and paid ` 8,00,000 to the suppliers of garments and
received ` 10,00,000 from the customers.
Let us see how the accrual and periodicity concepts operate.
Periodicity Concept fixes up the time-frame for which the performance is to be measured and financial
position is to be appraised. Here, it is January 2019 - December, 2019. So revenues and expenses are
to be measured for the year 2019 and assets and liabilities are to be ascertained as on 31st December,
2019.
Accrual Concept operates to measure revenue of ` 12,00,000 (arising out of sale of garments 8,000 Pcs
× ` 150) which accrued during 2019, not the cash received ` 10,00,000 and also the expenses correctly.
Shop rent for 12 months is an expense item amounting to ` 36,000, not ` 33,000 the cash paid.
Should the accountant treat ` 10,00,000 as expenses for purchase of merchandise ? And should he treat
` 1,64,000 as profit? (Revenue ` 12,00,000-Merchandise ` 10,00,000. Shop Rent ` 36,000). Obviously the
answer is No. Matching links revenue with expenses.
Revenue – Expenses = Profit
But this unqualified equation may create misconception. It should be defined as :
Periodic Profit = Periodic Revenue – Matched Expenses
From the revenue of an accounting period such expenses are deducted which are expended to generate
the revenue to determine profit of that period.
In the given example revenue relates to only sale of 8,000 pcs. of garments. So the cost of 8,000 pcs of
garments should be treated as expenses.
Thus, Profit = Revenue ` 12,00,000
Less: Expenses:
Merchandise ` 8,00,000
Shop Rent ` 36,000 (` 8,36,000)
` 3,64,000
Assets:
Inventory (2,000 pcs × ` 100) ` 2,00,000
Trade receivables ` 2,00,000
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
Liability ` Assets `
Capital 7,00,000 Machinery 5,70,000
Cash 1,30,000
7,00,000 7,00,000
Now if he decides to back out and desires to sell the machine, it may fetch more than or less than
` 5,70,000. So his financial position should be different. If going concern concept is taken, increase/
decrease in the value of assets in the short-run is ignored. The concept indicates that assets are kept for
generating benefit in future, not for immediate sale; current change in the asset value is not realisable
and so it should not be counted.
(g) Cost concept: By this concept, the value of an asset is to be determined on the basis of historical cost, in
other words, acquisition cost. Although there are various measurement bases, accountants traditionally
prefer this concept in the interests of objectivity. When a machine is acquired by paying ` 5,00,000,
following cost concept the value of the machine is taken as ` 5,00,000. It is highly objective and free
from all bias. Other measurement bases are not so objective. Current cost of an asset is not easily
determinable. If the asset is purchased on 1.1.1995 and such model is not available in the market, it
becomes difficult to determine which model is the appropriate equivalent to the existing one. Similarly,
unless the machine is actually sold, realisable value will give only a hypothetical figure. Lastly, present
value base is highly subjective because to know the value of the asset one has to chase the uncertain
future.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
However, the cost concept creates a lot of distortion too as outlined below :
(a) In an inflationary situation when prices of all commodities go up on an average, acquisition cost
loses its relevance. For example, a piece of land purchased on 1.1.1995 for ` 2,000 may cost `
1,00,000 as on 1.1.2020. So if the accountant makes valuation of asset at historical cost, the accounts
will not reflect the true position.
(b) Historical cost-based accounts may lose comparability. Mr. X invested ` 1,00,000 in a machine on
1.1.1995 which produces ` 50,000 cash inflow during the year 2020, while Mr. Y invested ` 5,00,000
in a machine on 1.1.2005 which produced ` 50,000 cash inflows during the year. Mr. X earned at the
rate 50% while Mr. Y earned at the rate 10%. Who is more efficient? Since the assets are recorded at
the historical cost, the results are not comparable. Obviously it is a corollary to (a).
(c) Many assets do not have acquisition costs. Human assets of an enterprise are an example. The cost
concept fails to recognise such asset although it is a very important asset of any organization.
Many other controversial issues have arisen in financial accounting that revolves around the cost
concept which will be discussed at the advanced stage. However, later on we shall see that in many
circumstances, the cost convention is not followed. See conservatism concept for an example, which
will be discussed later on in this unit.
(h) Realisation concept: It closely follows the cost concept. Any change in value of an asset is to be
recorded only when the business realises it. When an asset is recorded at its historical cost of ` 5,00,000
and even if its current cost is ` 15,00,000 such change is not counted unless there is certainty that such
change will materialize.
However, accountants follow a more conservative path. They try to cover all probable losses but do
not count any probable gain. That is to say, if accountants anticipate decrease in value they count it,
but if there is increase in value they ignore it until it is realised. Economists are highly critical about the
realisation concept. According to them, this concept creates value distortion and makes accounting
meaningless.
Example: Mr. X purchased a piece of land on 1.1.1995 paying `2,000. Its current market value is
` 1,02,000 on 31.12.2020. Should the accountant show the land at `2,000 following cost concept and
ignoring `1,00,000 value increase since it is not realised? If he does so, the financial position would be:
Balance Sheet
Liability ` Asset `
Capital 2,000 Land 2,000
2,000 2,000
Is it not proper to show it in the following manner?
Balance Sheet
Liabilities ` Asset `
Capital 2,000 Land 1,02,000
Unrealised Gain 1,00,000
1,02,000 1,02,000
Now-a-days the revaluation of assets has become a widely accepted practice when the change in value
is of permanent nature. Accountants adjust such value change through creation of revaluation (capital)
reserve.
Thus the going concern, cost concept and realization concept gives the valuation criteria.
(i) Dual aspect concept: This concept is the core of double entry book-keeping. Every transaction or event
has two aspects:
(1) It increases one Asset and decreases other Asset;
(2) It increases an Asset and simultaneously increases Liability;
(3) It decreases one Asset, increases another Asset;
(4) It decreases one Asset, decreases a Liability.
Alternatively:
(5) It increases one Liability, decreases other Liability;
(6) It increases a Liability, increases an Asset;
(7) It decreases Liability, increases other Liability;
(8) It decreases Liability, decreases an Asset.
Example:
Balance Sheet
Liabilities ` Assets `
Capital 1,50,000 Machinery 2,00,000
Bank Loan 75,000 Cash 1,00,000
Other Loan 75,000
3,00,000 3,00,000
Transactions:
(a) A new machine is purchased paying ` 50,000 in cash.
(b) A new machine is purchased for ` 50,000 on credit, cash is to be paid later on.
(c) Cash paid to repay bank loan to the extent of ` 50,000.
(d) Raised bank loan of ` 50,000 to pay off other loan.
Effect of the Transactions:
(a) Increase in machine value and decrease in cash balance by ` 50,000.
Liabilities ` Assets `
Capital 1,50,000 Machinery 2,50,000
Bank Loan 75,000 Cash 50,000
Other Loan 75,000
3,00,000 3,00,000
(b) Increase in machine value and increase in Creditors by ` 50,000.
Balance Sheet (2 & 6)
Liabilities ` Assets `
Capital 1,50,000 Machinery 2,50,000
Creditors for machinery 50,000 Cash 1,00,000
Bank Loan 75,000
Other Loan 75,000
3,50,000 3,50,000
Liabilities ` Assets `
Capital 1,50,000 Machinery 2,00,000
Bank Loan 25,000 Cash 50,000
Other Loan 75,000
2,50,000 2,50,000
Liabilities ` Assets `
Capital 1,50,000 Machinery 2,00,000
Bank Loan 1,25,000 Cash 1,00,000
Other Loan 25,000
3,00,000 3,00,000
? ILLUSTRATION
Develop the accounting equation from the following information: -
SOLUTION
For the year ended March 31, 2019:
Equity = Capital ` 1,00,000
Liabilities = Bank Loan + Trade Payables
` 1,00,000 + ` 75,000 = ` 1,75,000
Assets = Fixed Assets + Trade Receivables + Inventory + Cash & Bank
` 1,25,000 + ` 75,000 + ` 70,000 + ` 5,000 = ` 2,75,000
Equity + Liabilities = Assets
` 1,00,000 + ` 1,75,000 = 2,75,000
The need for comparability should not be confused with mere uniformity and should not be allowed
to become an impediment to the introduction of improved accounting standards. It is not appropriate
for an enterprise to continue accounting in the same manner for a transaction or other event if the
policy adopted is not in keeping with the qualitative characteristics of relevance and reliability. It is also
inappropriate for an enterprise to leave its accounting policies unchanged when more relevant and
reliable alternatives exist.
Users wish to compare the financial position, performance and cash flows of an enterprise over time.
Hence, it is important that the financial statements show corresponding information for the preceding
period(s).
The four principal qualitative characteristics are understandability, relevance, reliability and
comparability.
5. Materiality: The relevance of information is affected by its materiality. Information is material if its
misstatement (i.e., omission or erroneous statement) could influence the economic decisions of users
taken on the basis of the financial information. Materiality depends on the size and nature of the item
or error, judged in the particular circumstances of its misstatement. Materiality provides a threshold or
cut-off point rather than being a primary qualitative characteristic which the information must have if
it is to be useful.
4. Faithful Representation: To be reliable, information must represent faithfully the transactions and
other events it either purports to represent or could reasonably be expected to represent. Thus, for
example, a balance sheet should represent faithfully the transactions and other events that result in
assets, liabilities and equity of the enterprise at the reporting date which meet the recognition criteria.
Most financial information is subject to some risk of being less than a faithful representation of
that which it purports to portray. This is not due to bias, but rather to inherent difficulties either in
identifying the transactions and other events to be measured or in devising and applying measurement
and presentation techniques that can convey messages that correspond with those transactions and
events. In certain cases, the measurement of the financial effects of items could be so uncertain that
enterprises generally would not recognise them in the financial statements; for example, although
most enterprises generate goodwill internally over time, it is usually difficult to identify or measure that
goodwill reliably. In other cases, however, it may be relevant to recognise items and to disclose the risk
of error surrounding their recognition and measurement.
7. Substance Over Form: If information is to represent faithfully the transactions and other events that
it purports to represent, it is necessary that they are accounted for and presented in accordance with
their substance and economic reality and not merely their legal form. The substance of transactions
or other events is not always consistent with that which is apparent from their legal or contrived
form. For example, where rights and beneficial interest in an immovable property are transferred but
the documentations and legal formalities are pending, the recording of acquisition/disposal (by the
transferee and transferor respectively) would in substance represent the transaction entered into.
8. Neutrality: To be reliable, the information contained in financial statements must be neutral, that is,
free from bias. Financial statements are not neutral if, by the selection or presentation of information,
they influence the making of a decision or judgement in order to achieve a predetermined result or
outcome.
9. Prudence: The preparers of financial statements have to contend with the uncertainties that inevitably
surround many events and circumstances, such as the collectability of receivables, the probable useful
life of plant and machinery, and the warranty claims that may occur. Such uncertainties are recognised
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
by the disclosure of their nature and extent and by the exercise of prudence in the preparation of the
financial statements. Prudence is the inclusion of a degree of caution in the exercise of the judgments
needed in making the estimates required under conditions of uncertainty, such that assets or income
are not overstated and liabilities or expenses are not understated. However, the exercise of prudence
does not allow, for example, the creation of hidden reserves or excessive provisions, the deliberate
understatement of assets or income, or the deliberate overstatement of liabilities or expenses, because
the financial statements would then not be neutral and, therefore, not have the quality of reliability.
10. Full, fair and adequate disclosure: The financial statement must disclose all the reliable and relevant
information about the business enterprise to the management and also to their external users for
which they are meant, which in turn will help them to take a reasonable and rational decision. For it, it
is necessary that financial statements are prepared in conformity with generally accepted accounting
principles i.e the information is accounted for and presented in accordance with its substance and
economic reality and not merely with its legal form. The disclosure should be full and final so that users
can correctly assess the financial position of the enterprise.
The principle of full disclosure implies that nothing should be omitted while principle of fair disclosure
implies that all the transactions recorded should be accounted in a manner that financial statement
purports true and fair view of the results of the business of the enterprise and adequate disclosure
implies that the information influencing the decision of the users should be disclosed in detail and
should make sense.
This principle is widely used in corporate organizations because of separation in management and
ownership. The Companies Act in pursuant of this principle has came out with the format of balance
sheet and profit and loss account. The disclosures of all the major accounting policies and other
information are to be provided in the form of footnotes, annexures etc. The practice of appending
notes to the financial statements is the outcome of this principle.
11. Completeness: To be reliable, the information in financial statements must be complete within the
bounds of materiality and cost. An omission can cause information to be false or misleading and thus
unreliable and deficient in terms of its relevance.
Thus, if accounting information is to present faithfully the transactions and other events that it purports to
represent, it is necessary that they are accounted for and presented in accordance with their substance and
economic reality, not by their legal form. For example, if a business enterprise sells its assets to others but
still uses the assets as usual for the purpose of the business by making some arrangement with the seller,
it simply becomes a legal transaction. The economic reality is that the business is using the assets as usual
for deriving the benefit. Financial statement information should contain the substance of this transaction
and should not only record going by legality. In order to be reliable the financial statements information
should be neutral i.e., free from bias. The prepares of financial statements however, have to contend with
the uncertainties that inevitably surround many events and circumstances, such as the collectability of
doubtful receivables, the probable useful life of plant and equipment and the number of warranty claims
that many occur. Such uncertainties are recognised by the disclosure of their nature and extent and by
exercise of prudence in the preparation of financial statements. Prudence is the inclusion of a degree
of caution in the exercise of judgement needed in making the estimates required under condition of
uncertainty such that assets and income are not overstated and loss and liability are not understated.
SUMMARY
w Accounting concepts define the assumptions on the basis of which financial statements of a business
entity are prepared.
The following are the widely accepted accounting concepts:
(a) Entity concept (b) Money measurement concept
(c) Periodicity concept (d) Accrual concept
(e) Matching concept (f ) Going Concern concept
(g) Cost concept (h) Realisation concept
(i) Dual aspect concept (j) Conservatism
(k) Materiality
w Accounting principles are a body of doctrines commonly associated with the theory and procedures of
accounting serving as an explanation of current practices and as a guide for selection of conventions or
procedures where alternatives exist.”
w Accounting conventions emerge out of accounting practices, commonly known as accounting
principles, adopted by various organizations over a period of time.
w There are three fundamental accounting assumptions:
(i) Going Concern (ii) Consistency (iii) Accrual
w Qualitative characteristics are the attributes that make the information provided in financial
statements useful to users. Understandability, Relevance, Reliability, Comparability, Materiality, Faithful
Representation, Substance over Form, Neutrality, Prudence, Full, fair and adequate disclosure and
Completeness are the important qualitative characteristics of the financial statements.
(iv) A purchased a car for ` 5,00,000, making a down payment of ` 1,00,000 and signing a ` 4,00,000 bill
payable due in 60 days. As a result of this transaction
(a) Total assets increased by ` 5,00,000.
(b) Total liabilities increased by ` 4,00,000.
(c) Total assets increased by ` 4,00,000 with corresponding increase in liabilities by ` 4,00,000.
(v) Mohan purchased goods for `15,00,000 and sold 4/5th of the goods amounting `18,00,000 and
met expenses amounting ` 2,50,000 during the year, 2020. He counted net profit as ` 3,50,000.
Which of the accounting concept was followed by him?
(a) Entity. (b) Periodicity.
(c) Matching.
(vi) A businessman purchased goods for ` 25,00,000 and sold 80% of such goods during the accounting
year ended 31st March, 2020. The market value of the remaining goods was ` 4,00,000. He valued
the closing Inventory at cost. He violated the concept of
(a) Money measurement. (b) Conservatism.
(c) Cost.
(vii) Capital brought in by the proprietor is an example of
(a) Increase in asset and increase in liability.
(b) Increase in liability and decrease in asset.
(c) Increase in asset and decrease in liability.
2. (i) Assets are held in the business for the purpose of
(a) Resale. (b) Conversion into cash.
(c) Earning revenue.
(ii) Revenue from sale of products, is generally, realized in the period in which
(a) Cash is collected. (b) Sale is made.
(c) Products are manufactured.
(iii) The concept of conservatism when applied to the balance sheet results in
(a) Understatement of assets. (b) Overstatement of assets.
(c) Overstatement of capital.
(iv) Decrease in the amount of trade payables results in
(a) Increase in cash. (b) Decrease in bank over draft account.
(c) Decrease in assets.
(v) The determination of expenses for an accounting period is based on the principle of
(a) Objectivity. (b) Materiality.
(c) Matching.
(vi) Economic life of an enterprise is split into the periodic interval to measure its performance is as per
(a) Entity. (b) Matching.
(c) Periodicity.
3. (i) If an individual asset is increased, there will be a corresponding
(a) Increase of another asset or increase of capital.
(b) Decrease of another asset or increase of liability.
(c) Decrease of specific liability or decrease of capital.
(ii) Purchase of machinery for cash
(a) Decreases total assets. (b) Increases total assets.
(c) Retains total assets unchanged.
(iii) Consider the following data pertaining to Alpha Ltd.:
Particulars
`
Cost of machinery purchased on 1st April, 2019 10,00,000
Installation charges 1,00,000
Market value as on 31st March, 2020 12,00,000
While finalizing the annual accounts, if the company values the machinery at ` 12,00,000. Which of
the following concepts is violated by the Alpha Ltd.?
(a) Cost. (b) Matching.
(c) Accrual.
Theoretical Questions
1. Write short notes on:
(i) Fundamental accounting assumptions.
(ii) Periodicity concept.
(iii) Accounting conventions.
2. Distinguish between:
(i) Money measurement concept and matching concept
(ii) Going concern and cost concept
3. Briefly explain the qualitative characteristics of the financial statements:
ANSWERS / HINTS
Multiple Choice Questions
1.(i) (b) (ii) (b) (iii) (c) (iv) (c) (v) (c) (vi) (b)
(vii) (a) 2.(i) (c) (ii) (b) (iii) (a) (iv) (c) (v) (c)
(vi) (c) 3.(i) (b) (ii) (c) (iii) (a)
Theoretical Questions
1. (i) Fundamental accounting assumptions: There are three fundamental accounting assumptions:
Going Concern; Consistency and Accrual. If nothing has been written about the fundamental
accounting assumption in the financial statements then it is assumed that they have already been
followed in their preparation of financial statements.
(ii) Periodicity concept: According to this concept accounts should be prepared after every period &
not at the end of the life of the entity. For details, refer para 2.5.
(iii) Accounting conventions: Accounting conventions emerge out of accounting practices, commonly
known as accounting principles, adopted by various organizations over a period of time. For details,
refer para 2.4.
2. (i) Distinction between Money measurement concept and matching concept
As per Money Measurement concept, only those transactions, which can be measured in terms of
money are recorded. Since money is the medium of exchange and the standard of economic value,
this concept requires that those transactions alone that are capable of being measured in terms of
money be only to be recorded in the books of accounts. Transactions and events that cannot be
expressed in terms of money are not recorded in the business books.
In Matching concept, all expenses matched with the revenue of that period should only be taken
into consideration. In the financial statements of the organization if any revenue is recognized then
expenses related to earn that revenue should also be recognized.
(ii) Distinction between Going concern and cost concept
Going Concern Concept
The financial statements are normally prepared on the assumption that an enterprise is a going
concern and will continue in operation for the foreseeable future.
Cost Concept
By this concept, the value of an asset is to be determined on the basis of historical cost, in other
words, acquisition cost. For details refer para 2.5.
3. Qualitative characteristics are the attributes that make the information provided in financial statements
useful to users. For details, refer para 2.7.
w Understand the application of these accounting terms while recording transactions and events.
Accrued Revenue
Revenue which has been earned in an accounting period but in respect of which no enforceable claim has
become due in that period by the enterprise. It may arise from the rendering of services (including the use
of money) which at the date of accounting have been partly performed, and are not yet billable.
Accumulated Depletion
The total to date of the periodic depletion charges on wasting assets.
Accumulated Depreciation
The total to date of the periodic depreciation charges on depreciable assets.
Advance
Payment made on account of, but before completion of, a contract, or before acquisition of goods or receipt
of services.
Amortised Value
The amortizable amount less any portion already provided by way of amortization.
Annual Report
The information provided annually by the management of an enterprise to the owners and other interested
persons concerning its operations and financial position. It includes the information statutorily required,
e.g., in the case of a company, the balance sheet, profit and loss statement and notes on accounts, the auditor’s
report thereon, and the report of the Board of Directors. It also includes other information voluntarily
provided e.g., value added statement, graphs, charts, etc.
Appropriation Account
An account sometimes included as a separate section of the profit and loss statement showing application of
profits towards dividends, reserves, etc.
Assets
Tangible objects or intangible rights owned by an enterprise and carrying probable future benefits.
Authorised Share Capital
The number and par value, of each class of shares that an enterprise may issue in accordance with its
instrument of incorporation. This is sometimes referred to as nominal share capital.
Average Cost
The cost of an item at a point of time as determined by applying an average of the cost of all items of the
same nature over a period. When weightages are also applied in the computation, it is termed as weighted
average cost.
Bad Debts
Debts owed to an enterprise which are considered to be irrecoverable.
Balance Sheet
A statement of the financial position of an enterprise as at a given date, which exhibits its assets, liabilities,
capital, reserves and other account balances at their respective book values.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK 1.45
Bill of Exchange
An instrument in writing containing an unconditional order, signed by the maker, directing a certain person
to pay a certain sum of money only, to or to the order of a certain person or to the bearer of the instrument.
Bonus Shares
Shares allotted by capitalization of the reserves or surplus of a corporate enterprise.
Book Value
The amount at which an item appears in the books of account or financial statements. It does not refer to
any particular basis on which the amount is determined e.g., cost, replacement value, etc.
Borrowing costs
Borrowing costs are interest and other costs incurred by an enterprise in connection with the borrowing of
funds.
Bond/Debenture
A formal document constituting acknowledgment of a debt by an enterprise usually given under its common
seal and normally containing provisions regarding payment of interest, repayment of principal and security,
if any. It is transferable in the appropriate manner.
Call
A demand pursuant to terms of issue to pay a part or whole of the balance remaining payable on shares or
debentures after allotment.
Called-up Share Capital
That part of the subscribed share capital which shareholders have been required to pay.
Capital
Generally refers to the amount invested in an enterprise by its owners e.g. paid-up share capital in a corporate
enterprise. It is also used to refer to the interest of owners in the assets of an enterprise.
Capital Assets
Assets, including investments not held for sale, conversion or consumption in the ordinary course of business.
Capital Commitment
Future liability for capital expenditure in respect of which contracts have been made.
Capital Employed
The finances deployed by an enterprise in its net fixed assets, investments and working capital. Capital
employed in an operation may, however, exclude investments made outside that operation.
Capital Profit/Capital Loss
Excess of the proceeds realised from the sale, transfer, or exchange of the whole or a part of a capital asset
over its cost. When the result of this computation is negative, it is referred to as capital loss.
Capital Reserve
A reserve of a corporate enterprise which is not available for distribution as dividend.
Capital Work-in-progress
Expenditure on capital assets which are in the process of construction or completion.
Cash
Cash comprises cash on hand and demand deposits with banks
Cash equivalents
Cash equivalents are short term, highly liquid investments that are readily convertible into known amounts
of cash and which are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value.
Cash Basis of Accounting
The method of recording transactions by which revenues and costs and assets and liabilities are reflected in
the accounts in the period in which actual receipts or actual payments are made.
Cash Discount
A reduction granted by a supplier from the invoiced price in consideration of immediate payment or
payment within a stipulated period.
Cash Profit
The net profit as increased by non-cash costs, such as depreciation, amortization, etc. When the result of the
computation is negative, it is termed as cash loss.
Carrying amount
Carrying amount is the amount at which an asset is recognized in the balance sheet, net of any accumulated
amortization and accumulated impairment losses thereon.
Charge
An encumbrance on an asset to secure an indebtedness or other obligations. It may be fixed or floating.
Cheque
A bill of exchange drawn upon a specified banker and not expressed to be payable otherwise than on
demand.
Collateral Security
Security which is given in addition to the principal security against the same liability or obligation.
Costs of disposal
Costs of disposal are incremental costs directly attributable to the disposal of an asset, excluding finance
costs and income tax expense.
Contingency
A contingency is a condition or situation, the ultimate outcome of which, gain or loss, will be known or
determined only on the occurrence, or non-occurrence, of one or more uncertain future events.
Contingent Asset
An asset the existence, ownership or value of which may be known or determined only on the occurrence
or non-occurrence of one or more uncertain future events.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK 1.47
Contingent Liability
An obligation relating to an existing condition or situation which may arise in future depending on the
occurrence or non-occurrence of one or more uncertain future events.
Contra Account
One or two or more accounts which partially or wholly off-set another or other accounts.
Cost
The amount of expenditure incurred on or attributable to a specified article, product or activity.
Cost of Purchase
The purchase price including duties and taxes, freight inwards and other expenditure directly attributable to
acquisition, less trade discounts, rebates, duty drawbacks, and subsidies in respect of such purchase.
Cost of Goods Sold
The cost of goods sold during an accounting period. In manufacturing operations, it includes (i) cost of
materials; (ii) labour and factory overheads; selling and administrative expenses are normally excluded.
Conversion Cost
Cost incurred to convert raw materials or components into finished or semi-finished products. This normally
includes costs which are specifically attributable to units of production, i.e., direct labour, direct expenses
and subcontracted work, and production overheads as applicable in accordance with either the direct cost or
absorption costing method. Production overheads exclude expenses which relate to general administration,
finance, selling and distribution.
Convertible Debenture
A debenture which gives the holder a right to its conversion, wholly or partly, in shares in accordance with
the terms of issue.
Cumulative Dividend
A dividend payable on cumulative preference shares which, if unpaid, accumulates as a claim against the
earnings of a corporate enterprise, before any distribution is made to the other shareholders.
Cumulative Preference Shares
A class of preference shares entitled to payment of cumulative dividends. Preference shares are always
deemed to be cumulative, unless they are expressly made non-cumulative.
Current Assets
Cash and other assets that are expected to be converted into cash or consumed in the production of goods
or rendering of services in the normal course of business.
Current Liability
Liability including loans, deposits and bank overdraft which falls due for payment in a relatively short period,
normally not more than twelve months.
Deferral
Postponement of recognition of a revenue or expense after its related receipt or payment (or incurrence of a
liability) to a subsequent period to which it applies. Common examples of deferrals include prepaid rent and
taxes, unearned subscriptions received in advance by newspapers and magazine selling companies, etc.
Deficiency
The excess of liabilities over assets of an enterprise at a given date. The debit balance in the profit and loss
statement.
Deficit
The debit balance in the profit and loss statement.
Depletion
A measure of exhaustion of a wasting asset represented by periodic write off of cost or other substituted
value.
Depreciation
Depreciation is a measure of the wearing out, consumption or other loss of value of a depreciable asset
arising from use, effluxion of time or obsolescence through technology and market changes. Depreciation
is allocated so as to charge a fair proportion of the depreciable amount in each accounting period during
the expected useful life of the asset. Depreciation includes amortisation of assets whose useful life is
predetermined.
Depreciable amount
Depreciable amount of a depreciable asset is its historical cost, or other amount substituted for historical
cost in the financial statements, less the estimated residual value.
Depreciable assets
Depreciable assets are assets which
(i) are expected to be used during more than one accounting period; and
(ii) have a limited useful life; and
(iii) are held by an enterprise for use in the production or supply of goods and services, for rental to others,
or for administrative purposes and not for the purpose of sale in the ordinary course of business.
Depreciation Method
Any method of calculating depreciation for an accounting period.
Depreciation Rate
A percentage applied to the historical cost or the substituted amount of a depreciable asset (or in case of
diminishing balance method, the historical cost or the substituted amount less accumulated depreciation).
Diminishing Balance Method
A method under which the periodic charge for depreciation of an asset is computed by applying a fixed
percentage to its historical cost or substituted amount less accumulated depreciation (net book value). This
is also referred to as written down value method.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK 1.49
Discount
A reduction from a list price, quoted price or invoiced price. It also refers to the price for obtaining payment
on a bill before its maturity.
Dividend
A distribution to shareholders out of profits or reserves available for this purpose.
Entity Concept
The view of the relationship between the accounting entity and its owners which regards the entity as a
separate person, distinct and apart from its owners.
Equity Share
A share which is not a preference share. Also sometimes called ordinary share.
Exchange difference
Exchange difference is the difference resulting from reporting the same number of units of a foreign currency
in the reporting currency at different exchange rates.
Expenditure
Incurring a liability, disbursement of cash or transfer of property for the purpose of obtaining assets, goods
or services.
Expense
A cost relating to the operations of an accounting period or to the revenue earned during the period or the
benefits of which do not extend beyond that period.
Expired Cost
That portion of an expenditure from which no further benefit is expected. Also termed as expense.
Extraordinary items
Extraordinary items are income or expenses that arise from events or transactions that are clearly distinct
from the ordinary activities of the enterprise and, therefore, are not expected to recur frequently or regularly.
Fair value
Fair value is the amount for which an asset could be exchanged or a liability settled between knowledgeable,
willing parties in an arm’s length transaction.
Fair Market Value
The price that would be agreed to in an open and unrestricted market between knowledgeable and willing
parties dealing at arm’s length who are fully informed and are not under any compulsion to transact.
First Charge
A charge having priority over other charges.
First In, First Out (FIFO)
Computation of the cost of items sold or consumed during a period as though they were sold or consumed
in order of their acquisition.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
1.50 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
Fixed asset
Asset held with the intention of being used for the purpose of producing or providing goods or services and
is not held for sale in the normal course of business.
Fixed Cost
That cost of production which by its very nature remains relatively unaffected in a defined period of time by
variations in the volume of production.
Fixed Deposit
Deposit for a specified period and at specified rate of interest.
Fixed or Specific Charge
A charge which attaches to a particular asset which is identified when the charge is created, and the identity
of the asset does not change during the subsistence of the charge.
Floating Charge
A general charge on some or all assets of an enterprise which are not attached to specific assets and are
given as security against a debt.
Financial Instrument
A financial instrument is any contract that gives rise to both a financial asset of one enterprise and a financial
liability or equity shares of another enterprise.
Foreign currency
Foreign currency is a currency other than the reporting currency of an enterprise.
Forfeited Share
A share to which title is lost by a member for non-payment of call money or default in fulfilling any
engagement between members or expulsion of members where the articles specifically provide therefor.
Free Reserve
A reserve the utilization of which is not restricted in any manner.
Functional Classification
A system of classification of expenses and revenues and the corresponding assets and liabilities to each
function or activity, rather than by reference to their nature.
Fund
An account usually of the nature of a reserve or a provision which is represented by specifically earmarked
assets.
Fundamental Accounting Assumptions
Basic accounting assumptions which underlie the preparation and presentation of financial statements.
They are going concern, consistency and accrual. Usually, they are not specifically stated because their
acceptance and use are assumed. Disclosure is necessary if they are not followed.
Gain
A monetary benefit, profit or advantage resulting from a transaction or group of transactions.
General Reserve
A revenue reserve which is not earmarked for a specific purpose.
Going Concern Assumption
An accounting assumption according to which an enterprise is viewed as continuing in operation for the
foreseeable future. It is assumed that the enterprise has neither the intention nor the necessity of liquidation
or of curtailing materially the scale of its operations.
Goodwill
An intangible asset arising from business connections or trade name or reputation of an enterprise.
Gross Margin or Gross Profit
The excess of the proceeds of goods sold and services rendered during a period over their cost, before
taking into account administration, selling, distribution and financing expenses. When the result of this
computation is negative it is referred to as gross loss.
Government
Government refers to government, government agencies and similar bodies whether local, national or
international.
Government grants
Government grants are assistance by government in cash or kind to an enterprise for past or future compliance
with certain conditions. They exclude those forms of government assistance which cannot reasonably have
a value placed upon them and transactions with government which cannot be distinguished from the
normal trading transactions of the enterprise.
Gross book value
Gross book value of a fixed asset is its historical cost or other amount substituted for historical cost in the
books of account or financial statements. When this amount is shown net of accumulated depreciation, it is
termed as net book value.
Income and Expenditure Statement
A financial statement, often prepared by non-profit making enterprises like clubs, associations etc. to present
their revenues and expenses for an accounting period and to show the excess of revenues over expenses (or
vice versa) for that period. It is similar to profit and loss statement and is also called revenue and expense
statement.
Intangible Asset
Asset which does not have a physical identity e.g. goodwill, patents, copyright etc.
Inventories are assets:
(a) held for sale in the ordinary course of business;
(b) in the process of production for such sale; or
(c) in the form of materials or supplies to be consumed in the production process or in the rendering of
services.
Investment
Expenditure on assets held to earn interest, income, profit or other benefits.
Investments
Assets held not for operational purposes or for rendering services i.e. assets other than fixed assets or current
assets (e.g. securities, shares, debentures, immovable properties).
Issued Share Capital
That portion of the authorized share capital which has actually been offered for subscription. This includes
any bonus shares allotted by the corporate enterprise.
Joint venture
A joint venture is a contractual arrangement whereby two or more parties undertake an economic activity,
which is subject to joint control.
Last In, First Out (LIFO)
Computation of the cost of items sold or consumed during a period on the basis that the items last acquired
were sold or consumed first.
Liability
The financial obligation of an enterprise other than owners’ funds.
Lien
Right of one person to satisfy a claim against another by holding or retaining possession of that other’s
assets/property.
Long-term Liability
Liability which does not fall due for payment in a relatively short period, i.e., normally a period not more than
twelve months.
Lease
A lease is an agreement whereby the lessor conveys to the lessee in return for a payment or series of
payments the right to use an asset for an agreed period of time.
Materiality
An accounting concept according to which all relatively important and relevant items, i.e., items the
knowledge of which might influence the decisions of the user of the financial statements are disclosed in
the financial statements.
Mortgage
A transfer of interest in specific immovable property for the purpose of securing a loan advanced, or to
be advanced, an existing or future debt or the performance of an engagement which may give rise to a
pecuniary liability. The security is redeemed when the loan is repaid or the debt discharged or the obligations
performed.
Net Assets/Shareholders’ funds/Net Worth
The excess of the book value of assets (other than fictitious assets) of an enterprise over its liabilities. This is
also referred to as net worth or shareholders’ funds.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK 1.53
of enterprise resources yielding interest, royalties and dividends. Revenue is measured by the charges
made to customers or clients for goods supplied and services rendered to them and by the charges and
rewards arising from the use of resources by them. In an agency relationship, the revenue is the amount of
commission and not the gross inflow of cash, receivables or other consideration.
Revenue Reserve
Any reserve other than a capital reserve.
Right Share
An allotment of shares on the issue of fresh capital by a corporate enterprise to which a shareholder is
entitled on payment, by virtue of his holding certain shares in the enterprise in proportion to the number of
shares already held by him. (Shares allotted to certain categories of debenture holders pursuant to the rights
enjoyed by them are sometimes called right shares)
Sales Turnover/Gross Turnover/Gross Sales
The aggregate amount for which sales are effected or services rendered by an enterprise. The terms gross
turnover and net turnover (or gross sales and net sales) are sometimes used to distinguish the sales
aggregate before and after deduction of returns and trade discounts.
Secured Loan
Loan secured wholly or partly against an asset.
Share Capital
Aggregate amount of money paid or credited as paid on the shares and/ or stocks of a corporate enterprise.
Share Discount
The excess of the face value of shares over their issue price.
Shareholders’ Equity
The interest of the shareholders in the net assets of a corporate enterprise. However, in the case of liquidation
it is represented by the residual assets after meeting prior claims.
Share Issue Expenses
Costs incurred in connection with the issue and allotment of shares. These include legal and professional
fees, advertising expenses, printing costs, underwriting commission, brokerage, and also expenses in
connection with the issue of prospectus and allotment of shares.
Share warrants
Share warrants or options are financial instruments that give the holder the right to acquire equity shares.
Securities Premium
The excess of the issue price of shares over their face value.
Sinking Fund
A fund created for the repayment of a liability or for the replacement of an asset.
Straight Line Method
The method under which the periodic charge for depreciation is computed by dividing the depreciable
amount
© The depreciable
of a Institute asset by the
of Chartered estimatedofnumber
Accountants India of years of its useful life.
1.56 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
2. Amortisation
The gradual and systematic writing off of an asset or an account over an appropriate period.
3. Contingent Asset
An asset the existence, ownership or value of which may be known or determined only on the occurrence
or non-occurrence of one or more uncertain future events.
4. Contingent Liability
An obligation relating to an existing condition or situation which may arise in future depending on the
occurrence or non-occurrence of one or more uncertain future events.
Capital • Payments
• Receipts
UNIT OVERVIEW
Revenue • Payments
• Receipts
4.1 INTRODUCTION
Accounting aims in ascertaining and presenting the results of the business for an accounting period. For
ascertaining the periodical business results, the nature of transactions should be analyzed whether they are
of capital or revenue nature. The Revenue Expense relates to the operations of the business of an accounting
period or to the revenue earned during the period or the items of expenditure, benefits of which do not
extend beyond that period. Capital Expenditure, on the other hand, generates enduring benefits and helps
in revenue generation over more than one accounting period. Revenue Expenses must be associated with
a physical activity of the entity. Therefore, whereas production and sales generate revenue in the earning
process, use of goods and services in support of those functions causes expenses to occur. Expenses are
recognised in the Profit & Loss Account through matching principal which tells us when and how much of
the expenses to be charged against revenue. A part of the expenditure can be capitalised only when these
can be traced directly to definable streams of future benefits.
The distinction of transaction into revenue and capital is done for the purpose of placing them in Profit
and Loss account or in the Balance Sheet. For example: revenue expenditures are shown in the profit and
loss account as their benefits are for one accounting period i.e. in which they are incurred while capital
expenditures are placed on the asset side of the balance sheet as they will generate benefits for more than
one accounting period and will be transferred to profit and loss account of the year on the basis of utilisation
of that benefit in particular accounting year. Hence, both capital and revenue expenditures are ultimately
transferred
© The to profit and
Institute loss account.
of Chartered Accountants of India
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK 1.59
Revenue expenditures are transferred to profit and loss account in the year of spending while capital
expenditures are transferred to profit and loss account of the year in which their benefits are utilised.
Therefore we can conclude that it is the time factor, which is the main determinant for transferring the
expenditure to profit and loss account. Also expenses are recognized in profit and loss account through
matching concept which tells us when and how much of the expenses to be charged against revenue.
However, distinction between capital and revenue creates a considerable difficulty. In many cases borderline
between the two is very thin.
expenditure may represent acquisition of any tangible or intangible fixed assets for enduring future benefits.
Therefore, the benefits arising out of capital expenditure last for more than one accounting period whereas
those arising out of revenue expenses expire in the same accounting period.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
State with reasons whether the following statements are ‘True’ or ‘False’.
(1) Overhaul expenses of second-hand machinery purchased are Revenue Expenditure.
(2) Money spent to reduce working expenses is Revenue Expenditure.
(3) Legal fees to acquire property is Capital Expenditure.
(4) Amount spent as lawyer’s fee to defend a suit claiming that the firm’s factory site belonged to the plaintiff’s
land is Capital Expenditure.
(5) Amount spent for replacement of worn out part of machine is Capital Expenditure.
(6) Expense incurred on the repairs and white washing for the first time on purchase of an old building are
Revenue Expenses.
(7) Expenses in connection with obtaining a license for running the cinema is Capital Expenditure.
(8) Amount spent for the construction of temporary huts, which were necessary for construction of the Cinema
House and were demolished when the cinema house was ready, is Capital Expenditure.
SOLUTION
(1) False: Overhaul expenses are incurred to put second-hand machinery in working condition to derive
endurable long-term advantage. So it should be capitalised.
(2) False: It may be reasonably presumed that money spent for reducing revenue expenditure would have
generated long-term benefits to the entity. It becomes part of intangible fixed assets if it is in the form
of technical know-how and tangible fixed assets if it is in the form of additional replacement of any of
the existing tangible fixed assets. So this is capital expenditure.
(3) True: Legal fee paid to acquire any property is part of the cost of that property. It is incurred to possess
the ownership right of the property and hence a capital expenditure.
(4) False: Legal expenses incurred to defend a suit claiming that the firm’s factory site belongs to the
plaintiff is maintenance expenditure of the asset. By this expense, neither any endurable benefit can
be obtained in future in addition to that what is presently available nor the capacity of the asset will be
increased. Maintenance expenditure in relation to an asset is revenue expenditure.
(5) False: Amount spent for replacement of any worn out part of a machine is revenue expense since it is
part of its maintenance cost.
(6) False: Repairing and white washing expenses for the first time of an old building are incurred to put the
building in usable condition. These are the part of the cost of building. Accordingly, these are capital
expenditure.
(7) True: The Cinema Hall could not be started without license. Expenditure incurred to obtain the license
is pre-operative expense which is capitalised. Such expenses are amortised over a period of time.
(8) True: Cost of temporary huts constructed which were necessary for the construction of the cinema
house is part of the construction cost of the cinema house. Therefore such costs are to be capitalised.
? ILLUSTRATION 2
State with reasons whether the following are Capital or Revenue Expenditure:
(1) Expenses incurred in connection with obtaining a license for starting the factory for ` 10,000.
(2) ` 1,000 paid for removal of Inventory to a new site.
(3) Rings and Pistons of an engine were changed at a cost of ` 5,000 to get fuel efficiency.
(4) Money paid to Mahanagar Telephone Nigam Ltd. (MTNL) ` 8,000 for installing telephone in the office.
(5) A factory shed was constructed at a cost of ` 1,00,000. A sum of ` 5,000 had been incurred in the construction
of temporary huts for storing building material.
SOLUTION
(1) Money paid ` 10,000 for obtaining license to start a factory is a capital expenditure. This is an item of
expenditure incurred to acquire the right to carry on business.
(2) ` 1,000 paid for removal of Inventory to a new site is revenue expenditure. This is neither bringing
enduring benefit nor enhancing the value of the asset.
(3) ` 5,000 spent in changing Rings and Pistons of an engine to get fuel efficiency is capital expenditure.
This is an expenditure on improvement of a fixed asset. It results in increasing profit-earning capacity of
the business by cost reduction.
(4) Money deposited with MTNL for installation of telephone in office is not expenditure. This is treated as
an asset and the same is adjusted over a period of time against actual telephone bills.
(5) Cost of construction of building including cost of temporary huts is capital expenditure. Building is
fixed asset which will generate enduring benefit to the business over more than one accounting period.
Construction of temporary huts is incidental to the main construction. Such cost is also capitalised with
the cost of building.
? ILLUSTRATION 3
Good Pictures Ltd., constructs a cinema house and incurs the following expenditure during the first year ending
31st March, 2020.
(i) Second-hand furniture worth ` 9,000 was purchased; repainting of the furniture costs ` 1,000. The furniture
was installed by own workmen, wages for this being ` 200.
(ii) Expenses in connection with obtaining a license for running the cinema worth ` 20,000. During the course
of the year the cinema company was fined ` 1,000, for contravening rules. Renewal fee ` 2,000 for next year
also paid.
(iii) Fire insurance, ` 1,000 was paid on 1st October, 2019 for one year.
(iv) Temporary huts were constructed costing ` 1,200. They were necessary for the construction of the cinema.
They were demolished when the cinema was ready.
Point out how you would classify the above items.
SOLUTION
1. The total cost of the furniture should be treated as ` 10,200 i.e., all the amounts mentioned should be
capitalised since without such expenditure the furniture would not be available for use. If ` 1,000 and `
200 have been respectively debited to the Repairs Account and the Wages Account, these accounts will
be credited to the Furniture Account.
2. License for running the cinema house is necessary, hence its cost should be capitalised. But the fine of `
1,000 is revenue expenditure. The renewal fee for the next year is also revenue expenditure but pertains
to the next year; hence, it is a prepaid expense.
3. Half of the insurance premium pertains to the year beginning on 1st April, 2020. Hence such amount
should be treated as prepaid expense. The remaining amount is revenue expense for the current year.
4. Since the temporary huts were necessary for the construction, their cost should be added to the cost of
the cinema hall and thus capitalised.
? ILLUSTRATION 4
State with reasons, how you would classify the following items of expenditure:
1. Overhauling expenses of ` 25,000 for the engine of a motor car to get better fuel efficiency.
2. Inauguration expenses of ` 25 lacs incurred on the opening of a new manufacturing unit in an existing
business.
3. Compensation of ` 2.5 crores paid to workers, who opted for voluntary retirement.
SOLUTION
1. Overhauling expenses are incurred for the engine of a motor car to derive better fuel efficiency. These
expenses will reduce the running cost in future and thus the benefit is in form of endurable long-term
advantage. So this expenditure should be capitalised.
2. Inauguration expenses incurred on the opening of a new unit may help to explore more customers This
expenditure is in the nature of revenue expenditure, as the expenditure may not generate any enduring
benefit to the business over more than one accounting period.
3. The amount paid to workers on voluntary retirement is in the nature of revenue expenditure. Since the
magnitude of the amount of expenditure is very significant, it may be better to defer it over future years.
? ILLUSTRATION 5
SOLUTION
(i) Capital expenditure.
(ii) Revenue receipt.
(iii) Capital expenditure.
(iv) Capital receipt.
? ILLUSTRATION 6
SOLUTION
(i) Renovation of cabins increased the number of cabins. This has an effect on the future revenue generating
capability of the business. Thus the renovation expense is capital expenditure in nature.
(ii) Expense incurred to recover installments due from customer do not increase the revenue generating
capability in future. It is a normal recurring expense of the business. Thus the legal expenses incurred in
this case is revenue expenditure in nature.
(iii) Expenses incurred on account of transportation of fixed asset is capital expenditure in nature.
SUMMARY
w Revenue expenditures are shown in the profit and loss account while capital expenditures are placed
on the asset side of the balance sheet since they generate benefits for more than are accounting period.
w Prepaid expenses are future expenses that have been paid in advance. These are shown in the balance
sheet as an asset.
w Receipts obtained should be classified between revenue receipts and capital receipts.
8. Revenue from sale of products, ordinarily, is reported as part of the earning in the period in which
(a) The sale is made. (b) The cash is collected.
(c) The products are manufactured.
9. If repair cost is ` 25,000, whitewash expenses are ` 5,000, (both these expenses relate to presently used
building) cost of extension of building is ` 2,50,000 and cost of improvement in electrical wiring system
is ` 19,000; the amount to be expensed is
(a) ` 2,99,000. (b) ` 44,000.
(c) ` 30,000.
Theory Questions
1. What are the basic considerations in distinguishing between capital and revenue expenditures?
2. Define revenue receipts and give examples. How are these receipts treated?
ANSWERS/HINTS
MCQs
1: (a), 2 (b), 3 (a), 4(b), 5(a), 6 (b), 7(c), 8 (a), 9 (c)
Theoretical Questions
1. The basic considerations in distinction between capital and revenue expenditures are:
(a) Nature of business.
(b) Recurring nature of expenditure.
(c) Purpose of expenses.
(d) Effect on revenue generating capacity of business.
(e) Materiality of the amount involved.
2. Receipts which are obtained in course of normal business activities are revenue receipts (e.g. receipts
from sale of goods or services, interest income etc.).
Revenue receipts should not be equated with the actual cash receipts. Revenue receipts are credited to
the Profit and Loss Account.
w Understand the meaning of the terms 'Contingent Assets' and 'Contingent Liabilities'.
•
Contingent A possible asset arises from past events and
their existence will be confirmed only after
UNIT OVERVIEW
As per the concept of prudence as well as the present accounting standards, an enterprise should not
recognise a contingent asset. These assets are uncertain and may arise from a claim which an enterprise
pursues through a legal proceeding. There is uncertainty in realisation of claim. It is possible that recognition
of contingent assets may result in recognition of income that may never be realised. However, when the
realisation of income is virtually certain, then the related asset no longer remains as contingent asset.
A contingent asset need not be disclosed in the financial statements. A contingent asset is usually disclosed
in the report of the approving authority (Board of Directors in the case of a company, and the corresponding
approving authority in the case of any other enterprise), if an inflow of economic benefits is probable.
Contingent assets are assessed continually and if it has become virtually certain that an inflow of economic
benefits will arise, the asset and the related income are recognised in the financial statements of the period
in which theInstitute
© The change ofoccurs.
Chartered Accountants of India
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK 1.67
“(a) a possible obligation that arises from past events and the existence of which will be confirmed only by
the occurrence or non-occurrence of one or more uncertain future events not wholly within the control
of the enterprise; or
(b) a present obligation that arises from past events but is not recognised because:
(i) it is not probable that an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits will be required to
settle the obligation; or
A contingent liability is a possible obligation arising from past events and may arise in future depending
on the occurrence or non-occurrence of one or more uncertain future events [part (a) of the definition]. A
contingent liability may also be a present obligation that arises from past events [(part (b) of the definition)].
An enterprise should not recognise a contingent liability in balance sheet, however it is required to be disclosed
in the notes to accounts, unless possibility of outflow of a resource embodying economic benefits is remote. These liabilities ar
assessed continually to determine whether an outflow of resources embodying economic benefits has
become probable. If it becomes probable that an outflow or future economic benefits will be required for
an item previously dealt with as a contingent liability, a provision is recognised in financial statements of
the period in which the change in probability occurs except in the extremely rare circumstances where no
reliable estimate can be made.
Let us take an example to understand the distinction between provisions and contingent liabilities. The
Central Excise Officer imposes a penalty on Alpha Ltd. for violation of a provision in the Central Excise Act.
The company goes on an appeal. If the management of the company estimates that it is probable that the
company will have to pay the penalty, it recognises a provision for the liability. On the other hand, if the
management anticipates that the judgement of the appellate authority will be in its favour and it is less
likely that the company will have to pay the penalty, it will disclose the obligation as a contingent liability
instead of recognising a provision for the same.
(iii) In the case of ___________, either outflow of resources to settle the obligation is not probable or
the amount expected to be paid to settle the liability cannot be measured with sufficient reliability.
(a) Liability (b) Provision
(c) Contingent liabilities
(iv) Present liability of uncertain amount, which can be measured reliably by using a substantial degree
of estimation is termed as ________.
(a) Provision. (b) Liability.
(c) Contingent liability.
(v) In the financial statements, contingent liability is
(a) Recognised. (b) Not recognised.
(c) Adjusted.
Theoretical Questions
1. Differentiate between:
(i) Provision and Contingent Liability.
(ii) Liability and Contingent liability.
ANSWERS/HINTS
Multiple Choice Questions
(i) (a) (ii) (b) (iii) (c) (iv) (a) (v) (b)
Theoretical Questions
1. Provision is a present liability of uncertain amount, which can be measured reliably by using a substantial
degree of estimation. On the other hand, a Contingent liability is a possible obligation that may or may
not crystallize depending on the occurrence or non-occurrence of one or more uncertain future events.
2. A liability is defined as the present financial obligation of an enterprise, which arises from past events.
On the other hand, in the case of contingent liability, either outflow of resources to settle the obligation
is not probable or the amount expected to be paid to settle the liability cannot be measured with
sufficient reliability.
Based
on
This list should not be taken as exhaustive but is only illustrative. As the course will progress, students will
see the intricacies of the various accounting policies.
Suppose an enterprise holds some investments in the form of shares of a company at the end of an accounting
period. For valuation of shares, the enterprise may adopt FIFO, average method etc. The method selected
by that enterprise for valuation is called an accounting policy. Different enterprises may adopt different
accounting policies. Likewise, different methods of providing depreciation on fixed assets, i.e. Straight line,
written down, etc. are available to the business enterprises which will lead to different depreciation amounts.
For Example, Omega Enterprises revised its accounting policy relating to valuation of inventories to include
applicable production overheads.
SUMMARY
w Accounting Policies refer to specific accounting principles and methods of applying these principles
adopted by the enterprise in the preparation and presentation of financial statements. Policies are
based on various accounting concepts, principles and conventions.
w Three major characteristics which should be considered for the purpose of selection and application of
accounting policies. viz., Prudence, Substance over form, and Materiality.
w A change in accounting policies should be made in the following conditions:
(a) It is required by some statute or for compliance with an Accounting Standard.
(b) Change would result in more appropriate presentation of financial statement.
LEARNING OUTCOMES
After studying this unit, you will be able to:
w Know how far accounting is a measurement discipline if considered from the standpoint of the basic
elements of measurement.
w Learn the different measurement bases namely historical cost, realizable value and present value.
w Understand the measurement bases which can give objective valuation to transactions and events.
w Understand that the traditional accounting system mostly uses historical cost as measurement base
although in some cases other measurement bases are also used.
Elements of Measurement
UNIT OVERVIEW
Evaluation of
Identification Selection of Dimension of
of Objects and Standards or Measurement
Events Scale Standards or Scale
Valuation
Principles
Money as a measurement scale has no universal denomination. It takes the shape of currency ruling in a
country. For example, in India the scale of measurement is Rupee, in the U.K. Pound-Sterling (£), in Germany
Deutschmark (DM), in the United States Dollar ($) and so on. Also there is no constant exchange relationship
among the currencies.
If one businessman in India took loan $5,000 from a businessman of the U.S.A., he would enter the transaction
in his books in terms of ` Suppose at the time of loan agreement exchange rate was US $ = ` 50. Then loan
amounted to ` 2,50,000. Afterwards the exchange rate has been changed to $ 1 = ` 55. At the changed
exchange rate the loan amount becomes` 2,75,000. So money as a unit of measurement lacks universal
applicability across the boundary of a country unless a common currency is in vogue. Since the rate of
exchange fluctuates between two currencies over the time, money as a measurement scale also becomes
volatile.
Year 1 Year 2
Qty. ` Qty. `
5,000 pcs 5,00,000 4,500 pcs 5,40,000
Looking at the monetary figures one may be glad for 8% sales growth. In fact there was 10% production and
sales decline. The growth envisaged through monetary figures is only due to price change. Let us suppose
further that the cost of production for the above mentioned two years is as follows:
Year 1 Year 2
Qty. ` Qty. `
5,000 pcs 4,00,000 4,500 pcs 4,50,000
Take Gross profit = Sales – Cost of Production. Then in the first year profit was ` 1,00,000 while in the second
year the profit was ` 90,000. There was 10% decline in gross profit.
So money as a unit of measurement is not stable in the dimension.
Thus Accounting measures information mostly in money terms which is not a stable scale having universal
applicability and also not stable in dimension for comparison over the time. So it is not an exact measurement
discipline.
for generating information suitable for users’ judgments and decisions. But generation of such information
is preceded by recording, classifying and summarising data. By that process it measures performance
of the business entity by way of profit or loss and shows its financial position. Thus measurement is an
important part of accounting discipline. But a set of theorems governs the whole measurement sub-
system. These theorems should be carefully understood to know how the cogs of the ‘accounting-wheel’
work. Now-a-days accounting profession earmarked three theorems namely going concern, consistency
and accrual as fundamental accounting assumptions, i.e. these assumptions are taken for granted. Also
while measuring, classifying, summarising and also presenting, various policies are adopted. Recording,
classifying summarising and communication of information are also important part of accounting, which
do not fall within the purview of measurement discipline. Therefore we cannot simply say that accounting
is a measurement discipline.
But in accounting money is the unit of measurement. So, let us take one thing for granted that all transactions
and events are to be recorded in terms of money only. Quantitative information is also required in many
cases but such information is only supplementary to monetary information.
the bank announces 1% prepayment penalty on the loan amount if it is paid within 15 days starting
from that day. As per historical cost the liability is recorded at ` 5,00,000 at the amount or proceeds
received in exchange for obligation and asset is recorded at ` 7,00,000.
Current cost gives an alternative measurement base. Assets are carried out at the amount of cash or
cash equivalent that would have to be paid if the same or an equivalent asset was acquired currently.
Liabilities are carried at the undiscounted amount of cash or cash equivalents that would be required
to settle the obligation currently.
So as per current cost base, the machine value is ` 25,00,000 while the value of bank loan is ` 5,05,000.
(iii) Realisable Value: Suppose Mr. X found that he can get ` 20,00,000 if he would sell the machine purchased,
on 1.1.2011 paying ` 7,00,000 and which would cost ` 25,00,000 in case he would buy it currently. Take
also that Mr. X found that he had no money to pay off the bank loan of ` 5,00,000 currently.
As per realisable value, assets are carried at the amount of cash or cash equivalents that could currently
be obtained by selling the assets in an orderly disposal. Haphazard disposal may yield something less.
Liabilities are carried at their settlement values; i.e. the undiscounted amount of cash or cash equivalents
expressed to be paid to satisfy the liabilities in the normal course of business.
So the machine should be recorded at ` 20,00,000 the realisable value in an orderly sale while the bank
loan should be recorded at ` 5,00,000 the settlement value in the normal course of business.
(iv) Present Value: Suppose we are talking as on 1.1.2020 - take it as time for reference. Now think the machine
purchased by Mr. X can work for another 10 years and is supposed to generate cash @ ` 1,00,000 p.a.
Also take that bank loan of ` 5,00,000 taken by Mr. X is to be repaid as on 31.12.2026. Annual interest is
` 90,000.
As per present value, an asset is carried at the present discounted value of the future net cash inflows
that the item is expected to generate in the normal course of business. Liabilities are carried at the
present discounted value of future net cash outflows that are expected to be required to settle the
liabilities in the normal course of business.
The term ‘discount’, ‘cash inflow’ and ‘cash outflow’ need a little elaboration. ` 100 in hand as on 1.1.2020
is not equivalent to ` 100 in hand as on 31.12.2020. There is a time gap of one year. If Mr. X had ` 100 as
on 1.1.2020 he could use it at that time. If he received it only on 31.12.2020, he had to sacrifice his use for
a year. The value of this sacrifice is called ‘time value of money’. Mr. X would sacrifice i.e. he would agree
to take money on 31.12.2020 if he had been compensated for the sacrifice. So a rational man will never
exchange ` 100 as on 1.1.2020 with ` 100 to be received on 31.12.2020. Then ` 100 of 1.1.2020 is not
equivalent to ` 100 of 31.12.2020. To make the money receivable at a future date equal with the money
of the present date it is to be devalued. Such devaluation is called discounting of future money.
Perhaps you know the compound interest rule: A = P (1+ i)n
A = Amount
P = Principal
i = interest / 100
n = Time
This equation gives the relationship between present money, principal and the future money amount.
If A, i and n are given, to find out P, the equation is to be changed slightly.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK 1.79
A
P=
(1 + i)n
Using the equation one can find out the present value if he knows the values of A, i and n.
Suppose i = 20%, now what is the present value of ` 1,00,000 to be received as on 31.12.2020 (Take
1.1.2020 as the time of reference).
P = 1,00,000 = ` 83,333
(1 + 20)1
Similarly,
Time of Receipt Money Value Present Value
` `
31.12.2021 1,00,000 69,444
31.12.2022 1,00,000 57,870
31.12.2023 1,00,000 48,225
31.12.2024 1,00,000 40,188
31.12.2025 1,00,000 33,490
31.12.2026 1,00,000 27,908
31.12.2027 1,00,000 23,257
31.12.2028 1,00,000 19,381
31.12.2029 1,00,000 16,150
Total of all these present values is ` 4,19,246. Since the machine purchased by Mr. X will produce cash
equivalent to ` 4,19,246 in terms of present value, it is to be valued at such amount as per present value
measurement basis.
Here, Mr. X will receive ` 1,00,000 at different points of time-these are cash inflows. In the other example,
he has to pay interest and principal of bank loan-these are cash outflows.
Perhaps you also know the annuity rule:
Present value of an Annuity or Re. A for n periods is
A = Annuity
i = interest
t = time 1, 2, 3, ..........n.
A 1
1–
i (1 + i)n
Applying this rule one can derive the present value of ` 1,00,000 for 10 years @ 20% p.a.
1,00,000 1
1 – (1 + 0.20)10 = `4,19,246
0.20
90,000 1 5,00,000
1– 5
+
0.20 (1 + 0.20) (1 + 0.20)5
determining the bad debts, useful life and residual value of an item of plant and machinery and inventory
obsolescence. The process of estimation involves judgements based on the latest information available.
An estimate may require revision if changes occur regarding circumstances on which the estimate was based,
or as a result of new information, more experience or subsequent developments. Change in accounting
estimate means difference arises between certain parameters estimated earlier and re-estimated during the
current period or actual result achieved during the current period.
Few examples of situations wherein accounting estimates are needed can be given as follows:
(1) A company incurs expenditure of ` 10,00,000 on development of patent. Now the company has to
estimate that for how many years the patent would benefit the company. This estimation should be
based on the latest information and logical judgement.
(2) A company dealing in long-term construction contracts, uses percentage of completion method for
recognizing the revenue at the end of the accounting year. Under this method the company has to make
adequate provisions for unseen contingencies, which can take place while executing the remaining
portion of the contract. Since provisioning for unseen contingencies requires estimation, there may be
excess or short provisioning, which is to be adjusted in the period when it is recognised.
(3) Company has to provide for taxes which is also based on estimation as there can be some interpretational
differences on account of which tax authorities may either accept the expenditure or refuse it. This will
ultimately lead to different tax liability.
SUMMARY
w Measurement is vital aspect of accounting. Primarily transactions and events are measured in terms of
money.
w There are three elements of measurement:
(i) Identification of objects and events to be measured;
(ii) Selection of standard or scale to be used;
(iii) Evaluation of dimension of measurement standard or scale.
w There are four generally accepted measurement bases or valuation principles. These are:
(i) Historical Cost; (ii) Current Cost;
(iii) Realizable Value; (iv) Present Value.
2. Mohan purchased a machinery amounting ` 10,00,000 on 1st April, 2001. On 31st March, 2019, similar
machinery could be purchased for ` 20,00,000 but the realizable value of the machinery (purchased
on 1.4.2001) was estimated at ` 15,00,000. The present discounted value of the future net cash inflows
that the machinery was expected to generate in the normal course of business, was calculated as
` 12,00,000.
Theoretical Questions
2. Describe in brief, the alternative measurement bases, for determining the value at which an element
can be recognized in the balance sheet or statement of profit and loss.
ANSWER/HINTS
Multiple Choice Questions
1.(i) (c) (ii) (c) (iii) (c) 2.(i) (b) (ii) (c) (iii) (a)
(iv) (c)
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK 1.83
Theoretical Questions
1. Measurement is vital aspect of accounting. Primarily transactions and events are measured in terms of
money. Three elements of measurement are: (1) Identification of objects and events to be measured;
(2) Selection of standard or scale to be used;(3)Evaluation of dimension of measurement standard or
scale.
2. Alternative measurement bases are: (i)Historical Cost; (ii)Current cost (iii) Realizables (Settlement) Value
and (iv) Present Value. Refer para 7.6 for details.
Issue of AS
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
THEORETICAL FRAMEWORK 1.85
(i) eliminate the non-comparability of financial statements and thereby improving the reliability of
financial statements; and
(ii) provide a set of standard accounting policies, valuation norms and disclosure requirements.
Accounting standards reduce the accounting alternatives in the preparation of financial statements within
the bounds of rationality, thereby ensuring comparability of financial statements of different enterprises.
(i) Standards reduce to a reasonable extent or eliminate altogether confusing variations in the accounting
treatments used to prepare financial statements.
(ii) There are certain areas where important information are not statutorily required to be disclosed.
Standards may call for disclosure beyond that required by law.
(iii) The application of accounting standards would, to a limited extent, facilitate comparison of financial
statements of companies situated in different parts of the world and also of different companies situated
in the same country. However, it should be noted in this respect that differences in the institutions,
traditions and legal systems from one country to another give rise to differences in accounting standards
adopted in different countries.
Standardisation of
alternative accounting
treatments
Benefits of
Accounting
Standards
(ii) Restricted scope: Accounting standards cannot override the statute. The standards are required to be
framed within the ambit of prevailing statutes.
Difficulties in
Limitations
making choice
of accounting Restricted scope
between different
standards
treatments
2. Accounting Standards
(a) Harmonise accounting policies.
(b) Eliminate the non-comparability of financial statements.
(c) Improve the reliability of financial statements.
(d) All the three.
Theoretical Questions
1. Explain the objective of “Accounting Standards” in brief.
2. State the advantages of setting Accounting Standards.
ANSWERS/HINTS
Multiple Choice Questions
1. (c), 2. (d), 3. (d),
Theoretical Questions
1. Accounting Standards are selected set of accounting policies or broad guidelines regarding the
principles and methods to be chosen out of several alternatives. The main objective of Accounting
Standards is to establish standards which have to be complied with, to ensure that financial statements
are prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Accounting Standards seek
to suggest rules and criteria of accounting measurements. These standards harmonize the diverse
accounting policies and practices at present in use in India.
2. The main advantage of setting accounting standards is that the adoption and application of accounting
standards ensure uniformity, comparability and qualitative improvement in the preparation and
presentation of financial statements. The other advantages are: Reduction in variations; Disclosures
beyond that required by law and Facilitates comparison.
reported numbers, depending on the system of standards that are being used, then it is self-evident that
accounting will be increasingly discredited in the eyes of those using the numbers. It creates confusion,
encourages error and facilitates fraud. The cure for these ills is to have a single set of global standards, of the
highest quality, set in the interest of public. Global Standards facilitate cross border flow of money, global
listing in different bourses and comparability of financial statements.
The convergence of financial reporting and accounting standards is a valuable process that contributes to
the free flow of global investment and achieves substantial benefits for all capital market stakeholders. It
improves the ability of investors to compare investments on a global basis and thus lowers their risk of errors
of judgment. It facilitates accounting and reporting for companies with global operations and eliminates
some costly requirements say reinstatement of financial statements. It has the potential to create a new
standard of accountability and greater transparency, which are values of great significance to all market
participants including regulators. It reduces operational challenges for accounting firms and focuses their
value and expertise around an increasingly unified set of standards. It creates an unprecedented opportunity
for standard setters and other stakeholders to improve the reporting model. For the companies with joint
listings in both domestic and foreign country, the convergence is very much significant.
company listing requirements or statutory reporting. Many lenders and regulatory and government bodies
are looking to IFRS to fulfil local financial reporting obligations related to financing or licensing.
Theoretical Questions
1. Explain the need of convergence rather adoption of IFRS as Global Standards.
2. What is the significance of issue of Indian Accounting Standards? Explain in brief.
ANSWERS/HINTS
Multiple Choice Questions
1. (d); 2. (b); 3. (d)
Theoretical Questions
1. The Government of India in consultation with the ICAI decided to converge and not to adopt IFRSs
issued by the IASB. The decision of convergence rather than adoption was taken after the detailed
analysis of IFRSs requirements and extensive discussion with various stakeholders. Accordingly, while
formulating IFRS-converged Indian Accounting Standards (Ind AS), efforts have been made to keep
these Standards, as far as possible, in line with the corresponding IAS/IFRS and departures have been
made where considered absolutely essential.
2. Global Standards facilitate cross border flow of money, global listing in different bourses and
comparability of financial statements. The convergence of financial reporting and accounting standards
is a valuable process that contributes to the free flow of global investment and achieves substantial
benefits for all capital market stakeholders. It improves the ability of investors to compare investments
on a global basis and thus lowers their risk of errors of judgment. It facilitates accounting and reporting
for companies with global operations and eliminates some costly requirements say reinstatement of
financial statements.
5. Fixed assets less interest on obligations undertaken to purchase asset less accumulated depreciation
thereon up-to-date are called Net Fixed Assets.
6. The credit balance in the profit and loss statement is called a deficit.
Unit -4
1. The nature of business is not an important criteria in separating an expenditure between capital and
revenue.
2. Expenditure incurred for major repair of the asset so as to increase its productive capacity is Revenue in
nature
3. Amount spent as lawyer’s fee to defend a suit claiming that the firm’s factory site belonged to the
plaintiff ’sland is Capital Expenditure.
4. Amount spent for replacement of worn out part of machine is Capital Expenditure.
5. Legal fees to acquire property is Capital Expenditure.
6. Amount spent for the construction of temporary huts, which were necessary for construction of the
cinema house and were demolished when the cinema house was ready, is Capital Expenditure.
Unit -5
1. A contingent liability need not be disclosed in the financial statements.
2. A Provision fails to meet the recognition criteria.
3. A claim that an enterprise is pursuing through legal process, where the outcome is uncertain, is a
contingent liability.
4. When it is probable that the firm will need to pay off the obligation, this gives rise to Contingent liability.
Unit -6
1. There is a single list of accounting policies, which are applicable to all enterprises in all circumstances.
2. Selection of accounting policy doesn’t impact financial performance and financial position of the
business
3. A change in accounting policies should be made as and when business like to show result as per their
choice.
4. Choosing FIFO or weighted average method for inventory valuation is an accounting policy choice.
5. Selection of an inappropriate accounting policy decision will overstate the performance and financial
position of a business entity every time.
Unit -7
1. There are four generally accepted measurement bases or valuation principles
(i) Historical Cost; (ii) Current Cost;
(iii) Realizable Value; (iv) Future Value.
2. Historical Cost means price paid at time acquisition.
3. As per future value, assets are carried at the amount of cash or cash equivalents that could currently be
ANSWERS/HINTS
Unit-1
1. False : book-keeping and accounting are differentfrom each other. Accounting is a broad subject. It
calls for a greater understanding of records obtained from book-keeping and an ability to analyse and
interpret the information provided by book-keeping records.
Book-keeping is the recording phase while accounting is concerned with the summarising phase
of an accounting system.
2. False : Financial accounting covers the preparation and interpretation of financial statements and
communication to the users of accounts.
3. False : Management accounting is concerned with internal reporting to the managers of a business
unit.
4. False : Customers are also concerned with the stability and profitability of the enterprise because their
functioning is more or less dependent on the supply of goods
5. False : Recording is the basic function of accounting. Summarising is concerned with the preparation
and presentation of the classified data in a manner useful to the internal as well as the external users of
financial statements
6. True : Balance Sheet is a statement of the financial position of an enterprise at a given date.
7. True : Book-keeping is concerned with complete recording and combined effect of transactions made
during the accounting period.
Unit-2
1. False : Under matching concept all expenses matched with the revenue of that period should only be
taken into consideration. In the financial statements of the organization if any revenue is recognized
then expenses related to earn that revenue should also be recognized.
2. True : Since the owner invested capital, he has claim on the profits of the enterprise.
3. False : Under accrual concept, the effects of transactions and other events are recognised on mercantile
basis i.e., when they occur (and not as cash or a cash equivalent is received or paid) and they are recorded
in the accounting records and reported in the financial statements of the periods to which they relate.
4. False : The Realisation Concept also states that no change should be counted unless it has materialised.
5. False : The concept of consistency does not imply non-flexibility as not to allow the introduction of
improved method of accounting.
6. True : As per materiality principle, all the items having significant economic effect on the business of the
enterprise should be should be disclosed in the financial statements.
Unit-3
1. False : The drawee’s signed assent on bill of exchange, to the order of the drawer. This term is also used
to describe a bill of exchange that has been accepted.
2. False : Unexpired Cost - That portion of an expenditure whose benefit has not yet been exhausted.
3. False : Cash Basis of Accounting is the method of recording transactions by which revenues and costs
and assets and liabilities are reflected in the accounts in the period in which actual receipts or actual
payments are made.
4. True : Authorised share capital is number and par value of each class of shares that an enterprise may
issue in accordance with its instrument of incorporation and is sometimes referred as nominal share
capital.
5. False : Net Fixed Assets - Fixed assets less accumulated depreciation thereon up-to-date.
6. False : The debit balance in the profit and loss statement is deficit.
Unit-4
1. False : For a trader dealing in furniture, purchase of furniture is revenue expenditure but for any other
trade, the purchase of furniture should be treated as capital expenditure and shown in the balance
sheet as asset. Therefore, the nature of business is a very important criteria in separating an expenditure
between capital and revenue.
2. False : Expenditure incurred for major repair of the asset so as to increase its productive capacity is
capital in nature
3. False : Legal expenses incurred to defend a suit claiming that the firm’s factory site belongs to the
plaintiff is maintenance expenditure of the asset. By this expense, neither any endurable benefit can
be obtained in future in addition to that what is presently available nor the capacity of the asset will be
increased. Maintenance expenditure in relation to an asset is revenue expenditure.
4. False : Amount spent for replacement of any worn out part of a machine is revenue expense since it is
part of its maintenance cost.
5. False : Legal fee paid to acquire any property is a part of cost of that property. It is incurred to possess
the ownership right of the property and hence a capital expenditure.
6. True : Since temporary huts were necessary for the construction, their cost should be added to the cost
of the cinema hall and thus capitalised.
Unit-5
1. False : A Contingent liability is required to be disclosed unless possibility of outflow of a resource
embodying economic benefits is remote.
2. False : A contingent liability fails to meet the recognition criteria.
3. False : A claim that an enterprise is pursuing through legal process, where the outcome is uncertain, is
a contingent asset
4. False : When it is probable that the firm will need to pay off the obligation, this gives rise to provision.
Unit-6
1. False : There cannot be single list of accounting policies, which are applicable to all enterprises in all
circumstances. There would always be different policies chosen by different industries under different
circumstances.
2. False : Accounting policy has big impact on value of items goes under financial statements, hence it
impacts financial performance and financial position of the business.
Unit-9
1. False : The Government of India in consultation with the ICAI decided to converge and not to adopt
IFRSs issued by the IASB. The decision of convergence rather than adoption was taken after the detailed
analysis of IFRS requirements and extensive discussion with various stakeholders.
2. True : Major beneficiaries of convergence with IFRS’s are economy,investors and industry.
3. False : Since India is going global, there was huge demand of global standards for better comparison.
4. False : International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRSs) are considered a “principles-based” set of
standards.
5. False : Government of India has taken ASB support to develop Ind AS standards.
6. False : IASC stands for International Accounting Standards Committee.
UNIT Source • All documents in books which contain financial records and
OVERVIEW Documents act as evidence of transactions.
Accounts
Personal Impersonal
Accounts Accounts
1.3 ACCOUNT
We have seen how the accounting equation becomes true in all cases. A person starts his business with
say, ` 10,00,000; capital and cash are both ` 10,00,000. Transactions entered into by the firm will alter the
cash balance in two ways, one will increase the cash balance and other will reduce it. Payment for goods
purchased, for salaries and rent, etc., will reduce it; sales of goods for cash and collection from customers
will increase it.
We can change the cash balance with every transaction but this will be cumbersome. Instead it would be
better if all the transactions that lead to an increase are recorded in one column and those that reduce
the cash balance in another column; then the net result can be ascertained. If we add all increases to the
opening balance of cash and then deduct the total of all decreases we shall know the closing balance. In this
manner, significant information will be available relating to cash.
The two columns which we referred above are put usually in the form of an account, called the ‘T’ form. This
is illustrated below by taking imaginary figures:
Cash
Increase Decrease
(Receipt) (Payment)
` `
Opening Balance (1) 10,00,000 (7) 1,00,000
(2) 2,50,000 (8) 3,00,000
(3) 2,00,000 (9) 2,00,000
(4) 5,00,000 (10) 5,00,000
(5) 1,35,000
(6) 4,00,000 (11) 12,00,000
New or Closing Balance 1,85,000
24,85,000 24,85,000
Since, each T-account shows only amounts and not transaction descriptions, we key each transaction in
some way, such as by numbering used in this illustration. However, one can use date also for this purpose.
What we have done is to put the increase of cash on the left hand side and the decrease on the right hand
side; the closing balance has been ascertained by deducting the total of payments, ` 23,00,000 from the
total of the left - hand side. Such a treatment of receipts and payments of cash is very convenient.
Here we talked about only one account namely cash, now let us see how to make T-accounts when asset as
well as liabilities are effected from a particular transaction.
Now, let us take some more examples:-
Transaction 1 :
Initial investment by owners ` 25,00,000 in cash.
This will effect two accounts namely cash and capital. The asset cash increases and the stock holders’ equity
paid up capital also increases.
CASH
Increase Decrease
(1) 25,00,000
CAPITAL
Decrease Increase
(1) 25,00,000
Transaction 2:-
Paid cash to the creditors ` 14,00,000
This will effect cash account which will decrease and creditors account which is a liability will also decrease.
CASH
Increase Decrease
(2) 14,00,000
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
2.4 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
CREDITORS
Decrease Increase
(2) 14,00,000
The columns are self-explanatory except that the column for reference (Ref.) is meant to indicate the sources
where information about the entry is available.
Assets = Liabilities + ( contributed capital + beginning retained earnings + revenue - expense - dividends)
Here,
Contributed capital = the original capital introduced by the owner.
Beginning retained earnings = previous earnings not distributed to the shareholders.
Revenue = generated from the ongoing activities of the business
Expenses = cost incurred for the operations of the company.
Dividends = earnings distributed to the shareholders of the company
We have also seen that if there is any change on one side of the equation, there is bound to be similar
change on the other side of the equation or amongst items covered by it or an opposite change on the same
side of the equation. This is illustrated below:
amount. Suppose later the firm sells furniture to the extent of ` 3,00,000 the reduction will be recorded
by crediting the furniture account by ` 3,00,000.
FURNITURE
Increase Decrease
(1) 8,00,000 (2) 3,00,000
Balance 5,00,000
ii) If the amount of a liability increases, the increase will be entered on the credit side of the liability account,
i.e. the account will be credited: similarly, a liability account will be debited if there is a reduction in the
amount of the liability. Suppose a firm borrows ` 5,00,000 from Mohan; Mohan’s account will be credited
since ` 5,00,000 is now owing to him. If, later, the loan is repaid, Mohan’s account will be debited since
the liability no longer exists.
MOHAN
Decrease Increase
(2) 5,00,000 (1) 5,00,000
(iii) An increase in the owner’s capital is recorded by crediting the capital account: Suppose the proprietor
introduces additional capital, the capital account will be credited. If the owner withdraws some money,
i.e., makes a drawing, the capital account will be debited.
(iv) Profit leads to an increase in the capital and a loss to reduction: According to the rule mentioned in (iii)
above, profit & incomes may be directly credited to the capital account and losses & expenses may be
similarly debited.
However, it is more useful to record all incomes, gains, expenses and losses separately. By doing so, very
useful information will be available regarding the factors which have contributed to the year’s profits
and losses. Later the net result of all these is ascertained and adjusted in the capital account.
(v) Expenses are debited and Incomes are credited: Since incomes and gains increase capital, the rule is to
credit all gains and incomes in the accounts concerned and since expenses and losses decrease capital,
the rule is to debit all expenses and losses. Of course, if there is a reduction in any income or gain, the
account concerned will be debited; similarly, for any reduction in an expenses or loss the concerned
account will be credited.
The rules given above are summarised below:
(i) Increases in assets are debits; decreases are credits;
(ii) Increases in liabilities are credits; decreases are debits;
(iii) Increases in owner’s capital are credits; decreases are debits;
(iv) Increases in expenses are debits; decreases are credits; and
(v) Increases in revenue or incomes are credits; decreases are debits.
The terms debit and credit should not be taken to mean, respectively, favourable and unfavourable things.
They merely describe the two sides of accounts.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Following are the transactions entered into by R after he started his business. Show how various accounts will be
affected by these transactions:
2020 (` in 000)
April
1. R started business with 5,000
2. He purchased furniture for 1,200
3. Paid salary to his clerk 1,100
4. Paid rent 1,150
5. Received interest 2,000
SOLUTION
2020 Explanation Accounts Nature of How Debit Credit
April Involved Accounts affected (` in 000) (` in 000)
1. ` 5,000 cash Bank and R’s Asset Increased 5,000
invested in business Capital Capital Increased 5,000
2. Purchased furniture Furniture and Asset Increased 1,200
for ` 1,200 Bank Asset Decreased 1,200
3. Paid ` 1,100 to Salary & Bank Expense Increased 1,100
employee for salary Asset Decreased 1,100
4. Paid Rent ` 1,150 Rent & Bank Expense Increased 1,150
Asset Decreased 1,150
5. Received interest Cash & Interest Asset Increased 2,000
` 2,000 Income Increased 2,000
1.5 TRANSACTIONS
In the system of book-keeping, students can notice that transactions are recorded in the books of accounts. A
transaction is a type of event, which is generally external in nature and can be determined in terms of money.
In an accounting period, every business has huge number of transactions which are analysed in financial
terms and then recorded individually, followed by classification and summarisation process, to know their
impact on the financial statements. A transaction is a two way process in which value is transferred from
one party to another. In it either a party receives a value in terms of goods etc. and passes the value in terms
of money or vice versa. Therefore, one can easily make out that in a transaction, a party receives as well as
passes the value to other party. For recording transaction it is very important that they are supported by a
substantial document like purchasing invoices, bills, pay-slips, cash-memos, passbook etc.
Transactions analysed in terms of money and supported by proper documents are recorded in the books of
accounts under double entry system. To analyse the dual aspect of each transaction, two approaches can
be followed:
(1) Accounting Equation Approach.
(2) Traditional Approach.
Equity ` 5,000
Long–term Liabilities ` 1,000
Current Liabilities ` 1,000
` 7,000
R.H.S.
Fixed Assets:
Furniture ` 1,000
Current Assets:
Inventory ` 5,000
Cash ` 1,000
` 7,000
? ILLUSTRATION 2
Develop the accounting equation from following information available at the beginning of accounting period:
Particulars (` in 000)
Capital 51,000
Loan 11,500
Trade payables 5,700
Fixed Assets 12,800
Inventory 22,600
Trade receivables 17,500
Cash and Bank 15,300
At the end of the accounting period the balances appear as follows:
`
Capital ?
Loan 11,500
Trade payables 5,800
Fixed Assets 12,720
Inventory 22,900
Trade receivables 17,500
Cash at Bank 15,600
(a) Reset the equation and find out profit.
(b) Prepare Balance Sheet at the end of the accounting period.
SOLUTION
(All the figures in solution are in ‘000)
(a) Accounting equation is given by
Equity + Liabilities = Assets
Let us use E0, L0 and A0 to mean equity, liabilities and assets respectively at the beginning of the accounting
period.
E0 = ` 51,000
L0 = Loan + Trade payables
= ` 11,500 + ` 5,700
= ` 17,200
A0 = Fixed Assets + Inventories + Trade receivables + Cash at Bank
= ` 12,800 + ` 22,600 + ` 17,500 + ` 15,300
= ` 68,200
So, at the beginning of accounting period
E0 + L0 = A0
i.e., ` 51,000 + ` 17,200 = ` 68,200
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING PROCESS 2.11
Let us use E1, L1, A1 to mean equity, liabilities and assets respectively at the end of the accounting period.
L1 = Loan + Trade payables
= ` 11,500 + ` 5,800
= ` 17,300
A1 = Fixed Assets + Inventories + Trade receivables + Cash at Bank
= ` 12,720 + ` 22,900 + ` 17,500 + ` 15,600
= ` 68,720
E1 = A1 - L1 = ` 68,720 - ` 17,300 = ` 51,420
Profit = E1 - E0 = ` 51,420 - ` 51,000 = ` 420
(b) Balance Sheet
Liabilities ` ` Assets `
Capital Fixed Assets 12,720
Balance 51,000 Inventories 22,900
Add: Profit 420 51,420 Trade receivables 17,500
Loan 11,500 Cash at Bank 15,600
Trade payables 5,800
68,720 68,720
? ILLUSTRATION 3
Mr. Dravid. has provided following details related to his financials. Find out the missing figures:
Particulars (` in’000)
Profits carved during the year 5,000
Assets at the beginning of year A
Liabilities at the beginning of year 12,000
Assets at the end of the year B
Liabilities at the end of the year C
Closing capital 35,000
Total liabilities including capital at the end of the year 50,000
SOLUTION
SOLUTION
1.9 JOURNAL
Transactions are first entered in this book to show which accounts should be debited and which credited.
Journal is also called subsidiary book. Recording of transactions in journal is termed as journalizing the
entries. It is the book of original entry in which transactions are entered on a daily basis in a chronological
order.
1.9.1Journalising Process
All transactions may be first recorded in the journal as and when they occur; the record is chronological;
otherwise it would be difficult to maintain the records in an orderly manner. Debits and credits are listed
along with the appropriate explanations. There are basically two types of journals:-
1. General journal
2. Specialized journal
The latter is used when there are many repetitive transactions of the same nature. The form of the
journal is given below:
JOURNAL
Dr. Cr.
Date Particulars L.F. Amount Amount
` ` ` `
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5)
The columns have been numbered only to make clear the following but otherwise they are not numbered.
The following points should be noted:
(i) In the first column the date of the transaction is entered-the year is written at the top, then the month
and in the narrow part of the column the particular date is entered.
(ii) In the second column, the names of the accounts involved are written; first the account to be debited,
with the word “Dr” written towards the end of the column. In the next line, after leaving a little space,
the name of the account to be credited is written preceded by the word “To” (the modern practice
shows inclination towards omitting “Dr.” and “To”). Then in the next line the explanation for the entry
together with necessary details is given-this is called narration.
(iii) In the third column the number of the page in the ledger on which the account is written up is entered.
(iv) In the fourth column the amounts to be debited to the various accounts concerned are entered.
(v) In the fifth column, the amount to be credited to various accounts is entered.
1.9.2 Points to be taken into care while recording a Transaction in the Journal
1. Journal entries can be single entry (i.e. one debit and one credit) or compound entry (i.e. one debit and
two or more credits or two or more debits and one credit or two or more debits and credits). In such
cases, it is important to check that the total of both debits and credits are equal.
2. If journal entries are recorded in several pages then both the amount column of each page should be
totalled and the balance should be written at the end of that page and also that the same total should
be carried forward at the beginning of the next page.
An entry in the journal may appear as follows:
` `
May 5 Bank Account Dr. 14,50,000
To Mohan 14,50,000
(Being the amount received from
Mohan in payment of the amount due
from him)
We will now consider some individual transactions.
(i) Mohan commences business with ` 50,00,000 in his bank account. This means that the firm has
` 50,00,000 in bank. According to the rules given above, the increase in an asset has to be debited to it.
The firm also now owes ` 50,00,000 to the proprietor, Mohan as capital. The rule given above also shows
that the increase in capital should be credited to it. Therefore, the journal entry will be:
Note: There are two views on classification of “Purchase Account” and “Sales Account”. One view is that
they represents “flow of goods”, so they should be classified as ‘Real A/c’. However, others are of the
opinion that only nominal a/cs are closed by transferring to ‘Trading or Profit and Loss A/c’. Therefore,
purchases and sales shall be classified as Nominal A/cs. However, in both the views, there will be debit
balance of Purchase A/c and credit balance of Sales A/c.
(viii) Received cheque from Ramesh ` 13,00,000. The amount of bank increased therefore the bank account
has to be debited. Ramesh’s liability towards firm has decreased infact in this case he no longer owes
any amount to the firm, i.e., this particular form of assets has disappeared; therefore, the account of
Ramesh should be credited. The entry is:
(x) Paid rent ` 1,00,000. The bank balance has decreased and therefore, the bank account should be
credited. No asset has come into existence because the payment is for services enjoyed and is an
expense. Expenses are debited. Therefore, the entry should be:
? ILLUSTRATION 4
Analyse transactions of M/s Sahil & Co. for the month of March, 2020 on the basis of double entry system by
adopting the following approaches:
(A) Accounting Equation Approach.
(B) Traditional Approach.
Transactions for the month of March, 2020 were as follows (figures are in ‘000):
1. Sahil introduced capital through bank of ` 4,000.
2. Cash withdrawn from the City Bank ` 200.
3. Loan of ` 500 taken from Mr. Y.
4. Salaries paid for the month of March, 2020, ` 300 and ` 100 is still payable for the month of March, 2020.
5. Furniture purchased ` 500.
Required
What conclusions one can draw from the above analysis?
SOLUTION
Loan from Y Bank receives the Bank–Personal Debit the receiver Debit Bank
` 500 amount :Y pays
Y’s Loan–Personal Credit the giver Credit Y’s Loan
through bank
Salary paid ` 300 Cost of services Salary Nominal Debit all expenses Debit Salary (` 400)
and still payable used ` 400; Bank
Bank–Personal Credit the giver Credit Bank (`3,00)
` 100 gives out `300;
Still payable or Salary Outstanding Credit the giver Credit Salary
outstanding for Personal outstanding
services received (` 100)
` 100
Furniture Furniture is Furniture Real Debit what comes Debit Furniture
purchased purchased; in Credit the giver
Bank–Personal Credit Bank
` 500 Bank gives out
money
Conclusion:
It is evident from above analysis that procedure for analysis of transactions, classification of accounts and
rules for recording business transactions under accounting equation approach and traditional approach are
different. But the accounts affected and entries in affected accounts remain same under both approaches.
Thus, the recording of transactions in affected accounts on the basis of double entry system is independent
of the method of analysis followed by a business enterprise. In other words, accounts to be debited and
credited to record the dual aspect remain same under both the approaches.
? ILLUSTRATION 5
Journalise the following transactions. Also state the nature of each account involved in the Journal entry.
Following figures are given in (‘00)
1. December 1, 2020, Ajit started business with capital ` 4,00,000
2. December 3, he withdrew cash for business from the Bank ` 2,000.
3. December 5, he purchased goods making payment through bank` 15,000.
4. December 8, he sold goods` 16,000 and received payment through bank.
5. December 10, he purchased furniture and paid by cheque ` 2,500.
6. December 12, he sold goods to Arvind ` 2,400.
7. December 14, he purchased goods from Amrit ` 10,000.
8. December 15, he returned goods to Amrit ` 500.
9. December 16, he received from Arvind ` 2,300 in full settlement.
10. December 18, he withdrew goods for personal use ` 1,000.
11. December 20, he withdrew cash from business for personal use ` 2,000.
12. December 24, he paid telephone charges ` 110.
13. December 26, amount paid to Amrit in full settlement ` 9,450.
14. December 31, paid for stationery ` 200, rent `5,000 and salaries to staff ` 2,000.
15. December 31, goods distributed by way of free samples ` 2,000.
SOLUTION
JOURNAL (` in ‘00)
Dr. Cr.
Sl. Date Particulars Nature of L.F. Debit Credit
No Account (`) (`)
1. Dec. 1 Bank Account Dr. Personal A/c 4,00,000
To Capital Account Personal A/c 4,00,000
(Being commencement
of business)
2. Dec. 3 Cash Account Dr. Real A/c 2,000
To Bank Account Personal A/c 2,000
(Being cash withdrawn
from the Bank)
3. Dec. 5 Purchases Account Dr. Real A/c 15,000
To Bank Account Personal A/c 15,000
(Being purchase of
goods for cash)
4. Dec. 8 Bank Account Dr. Personal A/c 16,000
To Sales Account Real A/c 16,000
(Being goods sold for cash)
5. Dec. 10 Furniture Account Dr. Real A/c 2,500
To Bank Account Personal A/c 2,500
(Being purchase of
furniture, paid by cheque)
6. Dec. 12 Arvind Dr. Personal A/c 2,400
To Sales Account Real A/c 2,400
(Being sale of goods)
7. Dec. 14 Purchases Account Dr. Real A/c 10,000
To Amrit Personal A/c 10,000
(Being purchase of
goods from Amrit )
8. Dec. 15 Amrit Dr. Personal A/c 500
To Purchases
Returns Account Real A/c 500
(Being goods
returned to Amrit)
? ILLUSTRATION 6
Show the classification of the following Accounts under traditional and accounting equation approach:
(a) Building; (b) Purchases; (c) Sales; (d) Bank Fixed Deposit; (e) Rent; (f) Rent Outstanding; (g) Cash; (h) Adjusted
Purchases; (i) Closing Inventory; (j) Investments; (k) Trade receivables; (l) Sales Tax Payable, (m) Discount Allowed;
(n) Bad Debts; (o) Capital; (p) Drawings; (q) Interest Receivable account; (r) Rent received in advance account;
(s) Prepaid salary account; (t) Bad debts recovered account; (u) Depreciation account, (v) Personal income-tax
account.
SOLUTION
Nature of Account
Sl. Title of Account Traditional Approach Accounting Equation Approach
No.
(a) Building Real Asset
(b) Purchases Real Asset
(c) Sales Real Revenue
(d) Bank Fixed Deposit Personal Asset
(e) Rent Nominal (Expense) Expense
(f ) Rent Outstanding Personal Liability
(g) Cash Real Asset
(h) Adjusted Purchases Nominal (Expense) Expense
(i) Closing Inventory Real Asset
(j) Investment Real Asset
(k) Trade receivables Personal Asset
(l) Sales Tax Payable Personal Liability
(m) Discount Allowed Nominal (Expense) Temporary Capital (Expense)
(n) Bad Debts Nominal (Expense) Temporary Capital (Expense)
(o) Capital Personal Capital
(p) Drawings Personal Temporary Capital (Drawings)
(q) Interest receivable Personal Asset
(r) Rent received in advance Personal Liability
(s) Prepaid salary Personal Asset
(t) Bad debts recovered Nominal (Gain) Temporary Capital (Gain)
(u) Depreciation Nominal (Expense) Temporary Capital (Expense)
(v) Personal Income Tax Personal (Drawing) Temporary Capital (Drawings)
? ILLUSTRATION 7
2020 `
April 1 Ramesh started business with 10,00,000
“ 3 Bought goods for cash 50,000
“ 5 Drew cash from bank 10,000
“ 13 Sold to Krishna- goods on credit 1,50,000
“ 20 Bought from Shyam goods on credit 2,25,000
“ 24 Received from Krishna 1,45,000
“ Allowed him discount 5,000
“ 28 Paid Shyam cash 2,15,000
“ Discount allowed 10,000
“ 30 Cash sales for the month 8,00,000
Paid Rent 50,000
Paid Salary 1,00,000
SOLUTION
JOURNAL
Dr. Cr.
Date Particulars L.F. Amount Amount
2020
April 1 Bank Account Dr. 1 10,00,000
To Capital Account 4 10,00,000
(Being the amount invested by Ramesh in
the business as capital)
“3 Purchases Account Dr. 7 50,000
To Bank Account 1 50,000
(Being goods purchased for cash)
“5 Cash Account Dr. 5 10,000
To Bank Account 1 10,000
(Being cash withdrawn from bank)
“ 13 Krishna Dr. 9 1,50,000
To Sales Account 11 1,50,000
(Being goods sold to Krishna on credit)
“ 20 Purchases Account Dr. 7 2,25,000
To Shyam 10 2,25,000
(Being goods bought from Shyam on credit)
“ 24 Bank Account Dr. 1 1,45,000
Discount Account Dr. 12 5,000
To Krishna 9 1,50,000
(Being cash received from Krishna and
discount allowed to him)
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
2.24 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
SUMMARY
• The accounting process starts with the recording of transactions in the form of journal entries.
• The recording is based on double entry system. This book or register called journal is the book of first
or original entry.
• Next step is to post the entries in the ledger covered in the next unit.
8. Asset side of balance sheet contains all the personal & nominal accounts.
9. Capital account is a personal account.
10. Journal is also known as the book of original entry.
Multiple Choice Question
1. The rent paid to landlord is credited to
(a) Landlord’s account.
(b) Rent account.
(c) Cash account.
2. In case of a debt becoming bad, the amount should be credited to
(a) Trade receivables account.
(b) Bad debts account.
(c) Cash account.
3. A Ltd. has a ` 35,000 account receivable from Mohan. On January 20, Mohan makes a partial payment
of ` 21,000 to A Ltd. The journal entry made on January 20 by A Ltd. to record this transaction includes:
(a) A credit to the cash received account of ` 21,000.
(b) A credit to the Accounts receivable account of ` 21,000.
(c) A debit to the cash account of ` 14,000.
4. Which financial statement represents the accounting equation -
Assets = Liabilities + Owner’s equity:
(a) Income Statement
(b) Statement of Cash flows
(c) Balance Sheet.
5. Which account is the odd one out?
(a) Office furniture & Equipment.
(b) Freehold land and Buildings.
(c) Inventory of materials.
6. The debts written off as bad, if recovered subsequently are
(a) Credited to Bad Debts Recovered Account
(b) Credited to Trade receivables Account.
(c) Debited to Profit and Loss Account.
7. In Double Entry System of Book-keeping every business transaction affects:
(a) Two accounts
(b) Two sides of the same account.
(c) The same account on two different dates.
8. A sale of goods to Ram for cash should be debited to:
(a) Ram
(b) Cash
(c) Sales
Theory Questions
1. Write short note on classification of accounts.
2. Distinguish between Real account and nominal account.
Practical Questions
1. Show the classification of the following Accounts under traditional and accounting equation approach:
a Rent outstanding g Capital
b Closing Inventory h Sales Tax Payable
c Sales i Trade receivables
d Bank Fixed Deposit j Depreciation
e Cash k Drawings
f Bad Debts
2. Pass Journal Entries for the following transactions in the books of Gamma Bros.
(i) Employees had taken inventory worth ` 1,00,000 (Cost price ` 75,000) on the eve of Deepawali and
the same was deducted from their salaries in the subsequent month.
(ii) Wages paid for erection of Machinery ` 18,000.
(iii) Income tax liability of proprietor ` 1,17000 was paid out of petty cash.
(iv) Purchase of goods from Naveen of the list price of ` 2,00,000. He allowed 10% trade discount, `
5,000 cash discount was also allowed for quick payment.
3. Calculate the missing amount for the following.
Particulars ` Particulars `
Machinery 12,00,000 Trade Receivables B
Accounts Payable 1,00,000 Loans C
Inventory 60,000 Closing Capital D
Total Liabilities including 14,15,000 Opening Capital 10,00,000
capital
Cash A Loss incurred during the 35,000
year
Bank 80,000 Capital Introduced during 1,00,000
the year
Additional Information: During the year sales of Rs. 15,55,000 was made of which Rs. 15,00,000 have
been received.
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. True: as per the modern accounting equation approach- it is the basic formula in the accounting process
2. False: In the traditional approach a debtor becomes giver.
3. False: The rule of nominal account states that all expenses & losses are recorded on debit side.
4. True: it is one of the book where in the transactions not entered in the other books are entered in this
book
5. False: Capital account has a credit balance.
6. True: as it is considered as an expense.
7. False: All the personal & real account are recorded in balance sheet.
8. False: Asset side of balance sheet contains all the personal & real accounts.
9. True: as it is in the name of the proprietor who is bringing in the capital to the business
10. True: as the transactions are entered first in this book as a first hand record.
MCQs
Answer 2
Journal Entries in the books of Gamma Bros.
Answer 4
Particulars `
Total Assets 14,15,000
Less: Machinery (12,00,000)
Less: Inventory (60,000)
Less: Bank (80,000)
Less: Receivables (55,000)
Particulars `
Opening Capital 10,00,000
Add: Introduced during the year 1,00,000
Less: Loss incurred during the year (35,000)
Closing Capital 10,65,000
So, Loan amount (C) = Total Liabilities and capital - Closing Capital - Trade Payables
= ` (14,15,000 - 10,65,000 - 1,00,000)
= ` 2,50,000
UNIT 2 : LEDGERS
LEARNING OUTCOMES
After studying this unit, you will be able to :
w Learn the technique of opening accounts each year taking closing balances of the previous year. Note
also the use of ‘balance c/d’ and ‘balance b/d’.
Process of
transferring
journal entries
in the accounts
Difference
between the Ledger Remaining
totals of debits known as are carried
UNIT OVERVIEW and credit sides is principle forward to the
found out as the books of next year
balance account
Some of the
balances are
transferred to
the profit and
loss account
2.1 INTRODUCTION
After recording the transactions in the journal, recorded entries are classified and grouped into by preparation
of accounts. The book which contains all set of accounts (viz. personal, real and nominal accounts), is known
as Ledger. It is known as principal books of account in which account-wise balance of each account is
determined.
2.3 POSTING
The process of transferring the debit and credit items from journal to classified accounts in the ledger is
known as posting.
2.1 RULES REGARDING POSTING OF ENTRIES IN THE LEDGER
1. Separate account is opened in ledger book for each account and entries from ledger posted to respective
account accordingly.
2. It is a practice to use words ‘To’ and ‘By’ while posting transactions in the ledger. The word ‘To’ is used in
the particular column with the accounts written on the debit side while ‘By’ is used with the accounts
written in the particular column of the credit side. These ‘To’ and ‘By’ do not have any meanings but are
used to the account debited and credited.
3. The concerned account debited in the journal should also be debited in the ledger but reference should
be of the respective credit account.
is bigger than the debit side, it is a credit balance. In the other case it is a debit balance. The credit balance
is written on the debit side as, “To Balance c/d”; c/d means “carried down”. By doing this, two sides will be
equal. The totals are written on the two sides opposite one another.
Then the credit balance is written on the credit side as “By balance b/d (i.e., brought down)”. This is the
opening balance for the new period. The debit balance similarly is written on the credit side as “By Balance
c/d”, the totals then are written on the two sides as shown above as then the debit balance written on the
debit side as, “To Balance b/d”, as the opening balance of the new period.
It should be noted that nominal accounts are not balanced; the balance in the end are transferred to the
profit and loss account. Only personal and real accounts ultimately show balances. In the illustrations given,
you will have notice that the capital account, the purchases account, sales account, the discount account,
the rent account and the salary account have not been balanced. The capital account will have to be adjusted
for profit or loss and that is why it has not been balanced yet.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Prepare the Stationery Account of a firm for the year ended 31.12.2020 duly balanced off, from the following
details:
2020 `
Jan. 1 Inventory of stationery 480
April 5 Purchase of stationery by cheque 800
Nov. 15 Purchase of stationery on credit from Five Star Stationery Mart 1,280
SOLUTION
? ILLUSTRATION 2
Prepare the ledger accounts on the basis of following transactions in the books of a trader.
Debit Balances on January 1, 2020:
Cash in Hand ` 8,000, Cash at Bank ` 25,000, inventory of Goods ` 20,000, Building ` 10,000. Trade receivables:
Vijay ` 2,000 and Madhu ` 2,000.
Credit Balances on January 1, 2020:
? ILLUSTRATION 3
The following data is given by Mr. S, the owner, with a request to compile only the two personal accounts of Mr. H
and Mr. R, in his ledger, for the month of April, 2020.
1 Mr. S owes Mr. R ` 15,000; Mr. H owes Mr. S ` 20,000.
4 Mr. R sold goods worth ` 60,000 @ 10% trade discount to Mr. S.
5 Mr. S sold to Mr. H goods prices at ` 30,000.
17 Record a purchase of ` 25,000 net from R, which were sold to H at a profit of `15,000.
18 Mr. S rejected 10% of Mr. R’s goods of 4th April.
19 Mr. S issued a cash memo for `10,000 to Mr. H who came personally for this consignment of goods, urgently
needed by him.
22 Mr. H cleared half his total dues to Mr. S, enjoying a ½% cash discount (of the payment received,
` 20,000 was by cheque).
26 R’s total dues (less `10,000 held back) were cleared by cheque, enjoying a cash discount of `1,000 on the
payment made.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
2.38 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
29 Close H’s Account to record the fact that all but ` 5,000 was cleared by him, by a cheque, because he was
declared bankrupt.
30 Balance R’s Account.
SOLUTION
In the books of Mr. S
Dr. Mr. H Account Cr.
Date Particulars ` Date Particulars `
1.4.2020 To Balance b/d 20,000 22.4.2020 By Bank A/c 20,000
5.4.2020 To Sales A/c 30,000 22.4.2020 By Cash A/c (Note 2) 24,775
17.4.2020 To Sales A/c 40,000 29.4.2020 By Discount Allowed A/c 225
29.4.2020 By Bank A/c 40,000
29.4.2020 By Bad Debts A/c 5,000
90,000 90,000
Working Notes:
(1) Sale of `10,000 on 19th April is a cash sales, therefore, it will not be recorded in the Personal Account of
Mr. H; and (2) On 22nd April, Mr. H owes Mr. S ` 90,000, amount paid by Mr. H ½ of ` 90,000 less ½% discount
i.e., ` 45,000– ` 225 = ` 44,775. Out of this amount, ` 20,000 paid by cheque and the balance of ` 24,775 in
cash.
SUMMARY
w Process of transferring journal entries in the accounts opened in Ledger is called posting.
w Ledger is known as principal books of accounts and it provides full information regarding all the
transactions pertaining to any individual account.
w The difference between the totals of debits and credit sides is found out as the balance. Some of these
balances are transferred to the profit and loss account and some are carried forward to the next year i.e.,
shown in the balance sheet, depending upon the nature of the account.
December.
1. X started business with a capital of ` 20,000
2. He purchased goods from Y on credit ` 4,000
3. He paid cash to Y ` 2,000
4. He sold goods to Z ` 4,000
5. He received cash from Z ` 6,000
6. He further purchased goods from Y ` 4,000
7. He paid cash to Y ` 2,000
8. He further sold goods to Z ` 4,000
9 He received cash form Z ` 2,000
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. True: since it classifies all the amounts related to a particular account and then it is used as the base for
preparing the Trial balance
2. True: being an asset under the modern equation approach.
3. False: Posting is the process of transferring the balances from journal to ledger.
4. False: At the end of the accounting year, all the nominal accounts of the ledger book are totaled and
transferred to P&L A/c.
5. False: Ledger records the transactions in analytical order. But journal records the transactions in a
chronological order.
6. False: IF the total debit side is greater than the total of credit side, we get a debit balance as the opening
balance.
7. True: the increase to an asset shall be debited since the original balance is also debit.
MCQ’s
1. (a) 2. (c) 3. (a) 4. (b) 5. (c)
Theoretical Questions
1. Ledger is known as principal books of accounts and it provides full information regarding all the
transactions pertaining to any individual account. Ledger contains all set of accounts (viz. personal,
real and nominal accounts).
2. Rules regarding posting of entries in the ledger:
a. Separate account is opened in ledger book for each account and entries from ledger posted to
respective account accordingly.
b. It is a practice to use words ‘To’ and ‘By’ while posting transactions in the ledger. The word ‘To’ is
used in the particular column with the accounts written on the debit side while ‘By’ is used with
the accounts written in the particular column of the credit side. These ‘To’ and ‘By’ do not have any
meanings but are used to the account debited and credited.
c. The concerned account debited in the journal should also be debited in the ledger but reference
should be of the respective credit account.
Practical Questions
Answer 1
Journal
Particulars L.F. Debit ` Credit `
Cash Account Dr. 20,000
To Capital Account 20,000
(Being commencement of business)
Purchase Account Dr. 4,000
To Y 4,000
(Being purchase of goods on credit)
Y 2,000
To Cash Dr. 2,000
(Being payment of cash to Y)
Z Dr. 4,000
To Sales 4,000
(Being goods sold to Z)
Cash Account Dr. 6,000
To Z 6,000
(Being cash received form Z)
Purchase Account Dr. 4,000
To Y 4,000
(Being payment of goods from Y)
Y Dr. 2,000
To Cash Account 2,000
(Being payment of cash to Y)
Z Dr. 4,000
To Sales Account 4,000
(Being goods sold to Z)
Cash Account Dr. 2,000
To Z 2,000
(Being cash received from Z)
TOTAL 48,000 48,000
Phase of
the accounting
process
Basis for
Ledger balances
Preparing final Trial
on a particular
UNIT OVERVIEW accounts i.e. P& L A/c Balance
date
and Balance sheet
Checks
arithmetical
accuracy of the
books
Trial balance contains various ledger balances on a particular date. It forms the basis for preparing final
statement i.e. profit and loss statement and balance sheet. If it tallies, it means that the accounts are
arithmetically accurate but certain errors may still remain undetected. Therefore, it is very important to
carefully journalise and post the entries, following the rules of accounting.
3.1 INTRODUCTION
Preparation of trial balance is the third phase in the accounting process. After posting the accounts in the
ledger, a statement is prepared to show separately the debit and credit balances. Such a statement is known
as the trial balance. It may also be prepared by listing each and every account and entering in separate
columns the totals of the debit and credit sides. Whichever way it is prepared, the totals of the two columns
should agree. An agreement indicates reasonable accuracy of the accounting work; if the two sides do not
agree, then there is simply an arithmetic error(s).
This follows from the fact that under the Double Entry System, the amount written on the debit sides of
various accounts is always equal to the amounts entered on the credit sides of other accounts and vice
versa. Hence the totals of the debit sides must be equal to the totals of the credit sides. Also total of the
debit balances will be equal to the total of the credit balances. Once this agreement is established, there is
reasonable confidence that the accounting work is free from clerical errors, though it is not proof of cent
per cent accuracy, because some errors of principle and compensating errors may still remain. Generally,
to check the arithmetic accuracy of accounts, trial balance is prepared at monthly intervals. But because
double entry system is followed, one can prepare a trial balance any time. Though a trial balance can be
prepared any time but it is preferable to prepare it at the end of the accounting year to ensure the arithmetic
accuracy of all the accounts before the preparation of the financial statements. It may be noted that trial
balance is a statement and not an account.
Trial Balance
as at.......................
(ii) A wrong amount has been written in both columns of the journal.
Still, the preparation of the trial balance is very useful; without it, the preparation of financial statement, the
profit and loss account and the balance sheet, would be difficult.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Given below is a ledger extract relating to the business of X and Co. as on March, 31, 2020. You are required to
prepare the Trial Balance by the Total Amount Method.
Dr. Cash Account Cr.
Particulars ` Particulars `
35,500 35,500
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Cash A/c 3,000 By Balance c/d 3,000
3,000 3,000
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Cash A/c 2,500 By Balance c/d 2,500
2,500 2,500
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Cash A/c 21,000 By Purchases A/c 25,000
To Purchase Returns A/c 500 (Credit Purchases)
To Balance c/d 3,500 –
25,000 25,000
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Cash A/c (Cash Purchases) 1,000 By Balance c/d 26,000
To Sundries as per Purchases Book
(Credit Purchases) 25,000 –
26,000 26,000
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Balance c/d 500 By Sundries as per Purchases Return Book 500
500 500
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Sales A/c (Credit Sales) 30,000 By Sales Returns A/c 100
By Cash A/c 25,000
By Balance c/d 4,900
30,000 30,000
SOLUTION
Trial Balance of X and Co. as at 31.03.2020
Sl. Name of Account Total Debit Total
No. Items Credit Items
` `
1. Cash A/c 35,500 28,000
2. Furniture A/c 3,000
3. Salaries A/c 2,500
4. Shyam’s A/c 21,500 25,000
5. Purchases A/c 26,000
6. Purchases Returns A/c 500
7. Ram’s A/c 30,000 25,100
8. Sales A/c 30,500
9. Sales Returns A/c 100
10. Capital A/c 500 10,000
1,19,100 1,19,100
2. BALANCE METHOD
Under this method, every ledger account is balanced and those balances only are carried forward to the trial
balance. This method is used commonly by the accountants and helps in the preparation of the financial
statements. Financial statements are prepared on the basis of the balances of the ledger accounts.
? ILLUSTRATION 2
Taking the same information as given in Illustration 1, prepare the Trial Balance by Balance Method.
SOLUTION
Trial Balance of X and Co. as at 31.03.2020
? ILLUSTRATION 3
From the following ledger balances, prepare a trial balance of Anuradha Traders as on 31st March, 2020:
Account Head `
Capital 1,00,000
Sales 1,66,000
Purchases 1,50,000
Sales return 1,000
Discount allowed 2,000
Expenses 10,000
Trade receivables 75,000
Trade payables 25,000
Investments 15,000
Cash at bank and in hand 37,000
Interest received on investments 1,500
Insurance paid 2,500
SOLUTION
Trial Balance of Anuradha Traders as on 31.03.2020
? ILLUSTRATION 4
One of your clients, Mr. Singhania has asked you to finalise his accounts for the year ended 31st March, 2020.
Till date, he himself has recorded the transactions in books of accounts. As a basis for audit, Mr. Singhania
furnished you with the following statement.
SOLUTION
Corrected Trial Balance of Mr. Singhania as on 31st March, 2020
Particulars Dr. Cr.
Amount Amount
` `
Singhania’s Capital 1,556
Singhania’s Drawings 564
Leasehold premises 750
Sales 2,750
Due from customers 530
Purchases 1,259
Purchases returns 264
Loan from Bank 256
Creditor/Suppliers 528
Trade expenses 700
Cash at Bank 226
Bills payable 100
Salaries and Wages 600
Inventory (1.4.2019) 264
Rent and rates 463
Sales return 98
5,454 5,454
Reasons:
1. Due from customers is an asset, so its balance will be a debit balance.
2. Purchases return account always shows a credit balance because assets go out.
3. Balance in Creditors Account is a liability, so its balance will be a credit balance.
4. Bills payable is a liability, so its balance will be a credit balance.
5. Inventory (opening) represents assets, so it will have a debit balance.
6. Sales return account always shows a debit balance because assets come.
SUMMARY
w Trial balance contains various ledger balances on a particular date.
w It forms the basis for preparing final statement i.e. profit and loss statement and balance sheet.
w If it tallies, it means that the accounts are arithmetically accurate but certain errors may still remain
undetected.
w It is very important to carefully journalize and post the entries, following the rules of accounting.
3. False: Agreement of Trial balance gives only arithmetical accuracy, there can still be errors in preparing
the trail balance
4. True: since compensating errors cancel out due to their compensating nature of the amounts, hence
here is no problem in the Trial balance
5. False: A Trial balance cannot find the missing entry from the journal.
6. False: Suspense account opened in a trial balance is a temporary account
7. True: as purchases is debited, any returns shall be credited (treated in opposite way)
MCQs
Practical Question
ANSWER 1
Trial Balance as on 30th June, 2020
Heads of Accounts Debit ` Credit `
Provision for Doubtful Debts – 200
Bank overdraft – 1,654
Capital – 4,591
Trade payables – 1,637
Trade receivables 2,983 –
Discount Received – 252
Discount allowed 733 –
Drawings 1,200 –
Office furniture 2,155 –
General Expenses 829 –
Purchases 10,923 –
Returns Inward 330 –
Rent & Rates 314 –
Salaries 2,520 –
Inventory 2,418 –
Provision for Depreciation on Furniture – 364
Sales – 16,882
Suspense Account (Balancing figure) 1,175 –
Total 25,580 25,580
w Understand the techniques of recording transactions in Purchase Book, Sales Book; Returns Inward Book
and Returns Outward Book; Bills Receivable and Bills Payable Book.
w Understand that even if subsidiary books are maintained, journalisation is required for many other
transactions and events.
w Learn the difference between the subsidiary books and principal books.
Principle • Ledger
UNIT OVERVIEW
4.1 INTRODUCTION
In a business, most of the transactions generally relate to receipts and payments of cash, sale of goods and
their purchase. It is convenient to keep a separate register for each such class of transactions one for receipts
and payments of cash, one for purchase of goods and one for sale of goods. A register of this type is called
a book of original entry or of prime entry. For transactions recorded in such books there will be no journal
entry. The system by which transactions of a class are first recorded in the book, specially meant for it and
on the basis of which ledger accounts are then prepared is known as the Practical System of Book keeping
or even the English System. It should be noted that in this system, there is no departure from the rules of
the double entry system.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING PROCESS 2.57
These books of original or prime entry are also called subsidiary books since ledger accounts are prepared on
their basis and, without the further process of ledger posting, a trial balance cannot be taken out. Normally,
the following subsidiary books are used in a business:
(i) Cash book to record receipts and payments of cash, including receipts into and payments out of the
bank.
(ii) Purchases book to record credit purchases of goods dealt in or of the materials and stores required in
the factory.
(iii) Purchase Returns Books to record the returns of goods and materials previously purchased.
(iv) Sales Book to record the sales of the goods dealt in by the firm.
(v) Sale Returns Book to record the returns made by the customers.
(vi) Bills Receivable Books to record the receipts of promissory notes or hundies from various parties.
(vii) Bills Payable Book to record the issue of the promissory notes or hundies to other parties.
(viii) Journal (proper) to record the transactions which cannot be recorded in any of the seven books
mentioned above.
It may be noted that in all the above cases the word “Journal” may be used for the word “book”
Advantages of Subsidiary Books
The use of subsidiary books affords the undermentioned advantages:
(i) Division of work: Since in the place of one journal there will be so many subsidiary books, the
accounting work may be divided amongst a number of clerks.
(ii) Specialization and efficiency: When the same work is allotted to a particular person over a period of
time, he acquires full knowledge of it and becomes efficient in handling it. Thus the accounting work
will be done efficiently.
(iii) Saving of the time: Various accounting processes can be undertaken simultaneously because of the
use of a number of books. This will lead to the work being completed quickly.
(iv) Availability of information: Since a separate register or book is kept for each class of transactions, the
information relating to each transactions will be available at one place.
(v) Facility in checking: When the trial balance does not agree, the location of the error or errors is
facilitated by the existence of separate books. Even the commission of errors and frauds will be checked
by the use of various subsidiary books.
Principal Ledger
Books
Financial
Books For Credit
Purchase Purchase Book
For Credit
Sales Sales Book
For Credit
Purchase Return Book
Purchases
Returns
For Credit
Sales Return Book
Sales Returns
For Bills
Bill Receivable Book
Receivable
Subsidiary
Received
Books
For Bills Bill Payable Book
Accepted
For record of
transactions Journal Paper
not recorded
elsewhere
? ILLUSTRATION 1
The Rough Book of M/s. Narain & Co. contains the following :
2020
Feb. 1. Purchased from Brown & Co. on credit :
5 gross pencils @ `100 per gross,
1 gross registers @ ` 240 per doz.
Less : Trade Discount @ 10%
2. Purchased for cash from the Stationery Mart;
10 gross exercise books @ ` 300 per doz.
3. Purchased computer for office use from M/s. office
Goods Co. on credit for ` 30,000.
4. Purchased on credit from The Paper Co.
5 reams of white paper @ `100 per ream.
10 reams of ruled paper @ `150 per ream.
Less : Trade Discount @ 10%
5. Purchased one dozen gel pens @ `15 each from
M/s. Verma Bros. on credit.
Make out the Purchase Book of M/s. Narain & Co.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
2.60 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
SOLUTION
Purchases Book
Date Particulars L.F. Amount
2020 ` `
Feb. 1 M/s. Brown & Co.
5 gross pencils @ `100 per gross 500.00
1 gross registers @ `240 per doz. 2880.00
3380.00
Less : 10% trade discount (338) 3,042
“4 The Paper Co.
5 reams white paper @ `100 per ream 500.00
10 reams ruled paper @ `150 per ream 1500.00
2,000.00
Less : 10% trade discount (200.00) 1,800
5 M/s. Verma Bros.
1 doz. gel pens @ `15 each 180 180
Total 5022
Note : Purchases of cash and purchase of computer cannot be entered in the Purchase Book.
? ILLUSTRATION 2
Enter the following transactions in Purchase Book and post them into ledger.
2020
April 4 Purchased from Ajay Enterprises, Delhi
100 Doz. Rexona Hawai Chappal
@ `120 per doz.
200 Doz. Palki Leather Chappal
@ `300 per Doz.
Less : Trade discount @ 10%
Freight charged `150.
April 15 Purchased from Balaji Traders, Delhi
50 doz. Max Shoes
@ `400 per doz.
100 pair Sports Shoes.
@ `140 per paid.
Less : Trade discount @ 10%.
Freight charged `200.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING PROCESS 2.61
SOLUTION
Purchase Book
Ledgers
Dr. Purchases A/c Cr.
2020 ` 2020 `
April 30 To amount as per purchase book 1,26,000
2020 ` 2020 `
April 30 To amount as per purchase book 450
2020 ` 2020 `
April 30 By Purchase A/c 64,800
By Freight A/c 150
2020 ` 2020 `
April 15 By Purchase A/c 30,600
By Freight A/c 200
2020 ` 2020 `
April 28 By Purchase A/c 30,600
By Freight A/c 100
? ILLUSTRATION 3
The following are some of the transaction of M/s Kishore & Sons of the year 2020 as per their Waste Book.
Make out their Sales Book.
Sold to M/s. Gupta & Verma on credit:
30 shirts @ ` 800 per shirt.
20 trousers @ `1,000 per trouser.
Less : Trade Discount @ 10%
Sold furniture to M/s. Sehgal & Co. on credit `8,000.
Sold 50 shirts of M/s. Jain & Sons @ `800 per shirt.
Sold 13 shirts to Cheap Stores @ `750 each for cash.
Sold on credit to M/s. Mathur & Jain.
100 shirts @ `750 per shirt
10 overcoats @ `5,000 per overcoat.
Less: Trade Discount @ 10%
SOLUTION
Sales Book
? ILLUSTRATION 5
Post the following into the ledger
Returns Outward Book
SOLUTION
Ledger
Dr. Rajindra Parkash & Sons Cr.
Date Particulars Folio Amount Date Particulars Folio Amount
2020
(i) Opening entries : When books are started for the new year, the opening balance of assets and liabilities
are journalised.
(ii) Closing entries : At the end of the year the profit and loss account has to be prepared. For this purpose,
the nominal accounts are transferred to this account. This is done through journal entries called closing
entries.
(iii) Rectification entries : If an error has been committed, it is rectified through a journal entry.
(iv) Transfer entries : If some amount is to be transferred from one account to another, the transfer will be
made through a journal entry.
(v) Adjusting entries : At the end of the year the amount of expenses or income may have to be adjusted
for amounts received in advance or for amounts not yet settled in cash. Such an adjustment is also
made through journal entries. Usually, the entries pertain to the following:
(a) Outstanding expenses, i.e., expenses incurred but not yet paid;
(b) Prepared expenses, i.e., expenses paid in advance for some period in the future;
(c) Interest on capital, i.e., the interest on proprietor’s investment in the business entity investment; and
(d) Depreciation, i.e., fall in the value of the assets used on account of wear and tear.
For all these, journal entries are necessary.
(vi) Entries on dishonour of Bills : If someone who accepted a promissory note (or bill) is not able to pay
in on the due date, a journal entry will be necessary to record the non-payment or dishonour.
(vii) Miscellaneous entries : The following entries will also require journalising:
(a) Credit purchase of things other than goods dealt in or materials required for production of goods
e.g. credit purchase of furniture or machinery will be journalised.
(b) An allowance to be given to the customers or a charge to be made to them after the issue of the
invoice.
(c) Receipt of promissory notes or issue to them if separate bill books have not been maintained.
(d) On an amount becoming irrecoverable, say, because, of the customer becoming insolvent.
(e) Effects of accidents such as loss of property by fire.
(f ) Transfer of net profit to capital account.
? ILLUSTRATION 6
From the following transactions, prepare the Purchases Returns Book of Alpha & Co., a saree dealer and post
them to ledger :
SOLUTION
SUMMARY
w Instead of recording all journal entries in one register, it is better to categorize the entries on the basis
of type of transactions.
w Various subsidiary books are maintained so as to record transactions of one type in each register. These
are also called books of original entry or prime entry.
w Example of subsidiary books are purchases book, sales book, purchase returns books, sales returns
book, bills receivable book etc. On the basis of these subsidiary books, the ledger accounts are prepared.
6. In which book of original entry, will you record an allowance of `50 was offered for an early payment of
cash of `1,050 ___________________________.
(a) Sales Book
(b) Cash Book
(c) Journal Proper (General Journal)
7. A second hand motor car was purchased on credit from B Brothers for `10,000 will be recorded in
___________________________.
(a) Journal Proper (General Journal)
(b) Sales Book
(c) Cash Book
(d) Purchase Book
8. In which book of original entry, will you record a bills receivable of `1,000, which was received from a
debtor in full settlement for a claim of `1,100, is dishonoured ____________________.
(a) Purchases Return Book
(b) Bills Receivable Book
(c) Journal Proper (General Journal)
Theory Questions
1 Which subsidiary books are normally used in a business?
2. What are the advantages of subsidiary books?
Practical Questions
1. Enter the following transactions in Sales Book of M/s. Pranat Engineers Ltd., Delhi.
2020
Jan. 2. Sold to M/s. Ajanta Electricals, Delhi 5 pieces of Ovens @ `6,000/- each less Trade discount
@ 10%.
8 Sold to M/s. Ajanta Electricals Plaza, 10 pieces of Tablets @ ` 8,000/- each less trade discount
5%.
15 Sold to M/s. Haryana Traders, 5 pieces of Juicers @ `3,500/- each less trade discount @ 10%.
2. Post into the ledger the entries of Sales Book prepared in Question1.
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. True: since cash purchases are taken to the cash book , it is only credit transactions that are recorded in
the purchases book
2. False: Transactions regarding the purchase of fixed asset are not recorded in the purchase book, only
the credit purchases of goods are recorded in it.
3. False: Credit sales are recorded in the sales book.
4. True: they are maintained as an alternate to the journal.
5. True: yes it is one of the subsidiary book
6. False: Return inward book is also known as sales return book.
7. False: Purchase of a second hand machinery will not be recorded in purchase book.
8. True: since it is reduction from the total sales value, it is debited in the sales account
9. True: yes when there are numerous transactions then there are subsidiary books like the sales book
where there are recorded instead of regular journal entries.
MCQs
Theoretical Questions
1. Normally, the following subsidiary books are used in a business:
(i) Cash Book to record receipts and payments of cash, including receipts into and payments out of
the bank.
(ii) Purchases Book to record credit purchases of goods dealt in or of the materials and stores required
in the factory.
(iii) Purchase Returns Books to record the returns of goods and materials previously purchased.
(iv) Sales Book to record the sales of the goods dealt in by the firm.
(v) Sale Returns Book to record the returns made by the customers.
(vi) Bills Receivable Books to record the receipts of promissory notes or hundies from various parties.
(vii) Bills Payable Book to record the issue of the promissory notes or hundies to other parties.
(viii) Journal (proper) to record the transactions which cannot be recorded in any of the seven books
mentioned above.
2. For advantages of Subsidiary Books, refer para 4.1.
PRACTICAL PROBLEMS
ANSWERS 1
Sales Book
ANSWERS 2
Ledger
Ajanta Electricals
Electronics Plaza
Haryana Traders
Sales Account
Subsidiary
book as well as
Principal book
UNIT OVERVIEW
Simple Cash Three column
cash book
Book cash book
Two column
cash book
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Enter the following transactions in a Simple Cash Book:
2020 `
Jan.1 Cash in hand 1,200
“5 Received from Ram 300
“7 Paid Rent 30
“8 Sold goods for cash 300
“10 Paid to Shyam 700
“27 Purchased Furniture 200
“31 Paid Salaries 100
“31 Rent due, not yet paid, for January 30
SOLUTION
Dr. Cash Book Cr.
? ILLUSTRATION 2
Ganesh commenced business on 1st April, 2020 with ` 2,000 as capital. He had the following cash transactions
in the month of April 2020:
` `
April 1 Purchased furniture April 7 Paid for petty expenses 15
and paid cash 250 “ 8 Cash purchases 150
“2 Purchased goods 500
“4 Sold goods for cash 950
13 Paid for labour 1,000
“5 Paid cash to Ram Mohan 560
“6 He allowed discount 10 “” Paid Ali & Sons 400
“6 Received cash from They allowed discount 8
Krishna & Co. 600 “”
Allowed discount 20
Make out the two-column Cash Book (Cash and discount column) for the month of April, 2020.
SOLUTION
Cash Book
Dr. Receipts L.F. Discount Amount Date Payments L.F. Discount Cr.
Date ` ` 2020 ` Amount
2020 `
April 1 To Capital A/c 2,000 April 1 By Furniture A/c 250
“4 To Sales A/c 950 “ 2 By Purchases A/c 500
“6 To Krishna A/c 20 600
“5 By Ram Mohan 10 560
“7 By Petty
Expenses A/c 15
“8 By Purchases A/c 150
“ 13 By wages A/c 1,000
“ 13 By Ali & Sons 8 400
“ 30 By Balance c/d 675
20 3,550 18 3,550
May 1 To Balance b/d 675
To summarise:
(i) the discount columns in the cash book are totalled;
(ii) they are not balanced; and
(iii) their totals are entered in the discount received/paid account in the ledger.
Note: The person who pays, is credited by both the cash paid by him and the discount allowed to him.
Similarly, the person to whom payment is made, is debited with both the amount paid and the discount
allowed by him.
? ILLUSTRATION 3
Enter the following transactions in Cash Book with Discount and Bank Columns. Cheques are first treated as cash
receipt.
2020 `
Jan.1 Chandrika commences business with Cash 20,000
“ 3 He paid into Current A/c 19,000
“ 4 He received cheque from Kirti & Co. on account 600
“ 7 He pays in bank Kirty & Co.’s cheque 600
“ 10 He pays Rattan & Co. by cheque and is allowed discount ` 20 330
“ 12 Tripathi & Co. pays into his Bank A/c 475
“ 15 He receives cheque from Warshi and allows him discount ` 35 450
“ 20 He receives cash ` 75 and cheque ` 100 for cash sale
“ 25 He pays into Bank, including cheques received on 15th and 20th 1,000
“ 27 He pays for cash purchase 275
“ 30 He pays sundry expenses in cash 50
SOLUTION
Date Receipts L.F. Discount Cash Bank Date Payments L.F. Discount Cash Bank
` ` ` ` ` `
2020 2020
Jan. 1 To Capital A/c 20,000 Jan. 3 By Bank A/c C 19,000
3 To Cash C 19,000 7 By Bank A/c C 600
25 To Cash C 1,000
31 By Balance c/d 300 20,745
35 21,225 21,075 20 21,225 21,075
Feb. 1 To Balance b/d 300 20,745
? ILLUSTRATION 4
Prepare a Petty Cash Book on the imprest System from the following:
2020 `
Jan. 1 Received `100 for petty cash
“ 2 Paid bus fare .50
“ 2 Paid cartage 2.50
“ 3 Paid for Postage & Telegrams 5.00
“ 3 Paid wages for casual labourers 6.00
“ 4 Paid for stationery 4.00
“ 4 Paid tonga charges 2.00
“ 5 Paid for the repairs to chairs 15.00
“ 5 Bus fare 1.00
“ 5 Cartage 4.00
“ 6 Postage and Telegrams 7.00
“ 6 Tonga charges 3.00
“ 6 Cartage 3.00
“ 6 Stationery 2.00
“ 6 Refreshments to customers 5.00
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
2.82 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
SOLUTION
Petty Cash Book
Receipts Date V. Particulars Total Con- Cartage Statio- Postage & Wages Sundries
` 2020 No. ` veyance ` nery Telegrams ` `
` ` `
100 Jan.1 To Cash
2 1 By Conveyance .50 .50
2 By Cartage 2.50 2.50
3 3 By Postage and 5.00 5.00
Telegrams
4 By Wages 6.00 6.00
4 5 By Stationery 4.00 4.00
6 By Conveyance 2.00 2.00
5 7 By Repairs to 15.00 15.00
Furniture
8 By Conveyance 1.00 1.00
9 By Cartage 4.00 4.00
6 10 By Postage and 7.00 7.00
Telegrams
“ 11 By Conveyance 3.00 3.00
“ 12 By Cartage 3.00 3.00
“ 13 By Stationery 2.00 2.00
“ 14 By General 5.00 5.00
Expenses
60.00 6.50 9.50 6.00 12.00 6.00 20.00
By Balance c/d 40.00
100 100.00
40.00 To Balance b/d
60.00 8 To Cash
(ii) A journal entry may first be prepared on the basis of the petty cash book, debiting the accounts shown
by the various analysis columns, and crediting the total of the payment of the petty cash accounts.
For Illustration 4 the journal entry and relevant accounts are as follows:
2020 ` `
Jan. 6 Conveyance Account Dr. 6.50
Cartage account Dr. 9.50
Stationery account Dr. 6.00
Postage and Telegrams account Dr. 12.00
Wages Account Dr. 6.00
Repairs Account Dr. 15.00
General Expenses Account Dr. 5.00
To Petty Cash Account 60.00
(Being the analysis of the Petty Cash Book for
the week ending Jan. 6)
Entry for cash handed over to the Petty Cashier
Petty Cash Account Dr. 60
To Cash Account 60
(Being Cash received)
the bank can also be used as Debit Card. This card would contain an embossed 16 digit number and also
the name of the cardholder.
2. Generally Bank charges annual subscription fees from the credit card holder. No fee is charged in case
of Debit Card, though some banks charge a nominal fee on Debit Card.
3. When the Card holder intends to buy some goods or services through Credit or Debit Card, the seller
fills in a form, generally in triplicate, the details of the goods a with the amount of sales and uses
the embossed card with the help of the Credit Card machine to print the data on that form. Also the
customer has to countersign the form. One carbon copy of the form is given to the customer for the
record.
4. The seller sums up the different amounts sold like this and submits, generally everyday, to his bank all
the forms. The amount is credited by the bank to the seller’s account and debited to the account of the
Bank or the company issuing the Credit/Debit Card.
5. The bank issuing the Card, charges commission for each such transaction, which varies between 1% to
4% and is immediately debited to seller’s bank account.
6. The bank sends a monthly statement to the card holder. In case of Debit Card the account is immediately
debited to the card holder’s account, whereas in case of Credit Card, card holder has to pay the amount
in full or part. However, if not paid in full, the interest is charged.
ACCOUNTING FOR CREDIT/DEBIT CARD SALE
From the seller’s point of view, this type of sale is equivalent to a cash sale. Commission charged by the
bank will be treated as selling expenses. The following journal entries will be made in the seller’s books of
accounts.
1. Bank A/c Dr.
To Sales Account
(Sales made through Credit/Debit Card)
? ILLUSTRATION 5
Enter the following transaction in Cash Bank with Discount and Bank columns. Cheques are first treated as cash
receipts -
2020 `
March 1 Cash in Hand 15,000
Overdraft in Bank 500
2 Cash Sales 3,000
3 Paid to Sushil Bros. by cheque 3,400
Discount received 100
5 Sales through credit card 2,800
6 Received cheque from Srijan 6,200
SOLUTION
Dr. Cash Book Cr.
Date Particulars L.F. Discount Cash Bank Date Particulars L.F. Discount Cash Bank
` ` ` ` ` `
2020 2020
March 1 To Balance b/d 15,000 March 1 By Balance b/d 500
2 To Sales 3,000 3 By Sushil Bros. 100 3,400
5 To Sales 2,800 7 By Adit 6,200
6 To Srijan 6,200 9 By Bank C 6,800
9 To Cash A/c C 6,800 12 By Adit 6,200
10 To Aviral 50 3,600 24 By Cash A/c C 1,800
12 To Srijan 6,200 28 By Sanchit 3,000
15 To Sales A/c 3,200 30 By Commission 60
24 To Bank A/c C 1,800 31 By Balance c/d 19,200 1,440
50 26,000 22,600 100 26,000 22,600
SUMMARY
w Cash book contains cash transactions and also bank transactions, if it has a separate book column. It is
both a subsidiary book and a principal book.
w Cash book can be prepared adding discount column also.
w For small payments, petty cash book is maintained separately recording the particulars of payment and
its amount. The fixed amount is given to the petty cashier for making small payments in the beginning
of the period. The amount spent is replenished so that he will have again the fixed sum in the beginning
of the next period. This system is known as imprest system of petty cash book.
Practical Problems
Answer 1
Petty Cash Book
Date Receipts Amount Date Payments Total Stationery Travelling Misc Repairs
2020 ` 2020 Amount ` ` Exps. `
` `
Sept. 7 To Balance b/d 134.90 7 By Stationery 49.80 49.80
To Reimbursement 365.10 8 By Misc. Expenses 20.90 20.90
9 By Repairs 156.70 156.70
10 By Travelling 68.50 68.50
11 By Stationery 71.40 71.40
12 By Misc. Expenses 6.30 6.30
By Repairs 48.30 48.30
421.90 121.20 68.50 27.20 205.00
By Balance c/d 78.10
500.00 500.00
13 To Balance b/d 78.10
Errors of
Principle
Compensating
Errors
6.1 INTRODUCTION
Unintentional omission or commission of amounts and accounts in the process of recording the transactions
are commonly known as errors. These various unintentional errors can be committed at the stage of
collecting financial information/data on the basis of which financial statements are drawn or at the stage of
recording this information. Also errors may occur as a result of mathematical mistakes, mistakes in applying
accounting policies, misinterpretation of facts, or oversight. To check the arithmetic accuracy of the journal
and ledger accounts, trial balance is prepared. If the trial balance does not tally, then it can be said that
there are errors in the accounts which require rectification thereof. Some of these errors may affect the Trial
Balance and some of these do not have any impact on the Trial Balance although such errors may affect the
determination of profit or loss, assets and liabilities of the business.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING PROCESS 2.91
Jan. 6 To M/s. Scindia & Bros. A/c 42,420 By Wages A/c 12,200
Jan. 7 To Sales A/c 27,200 By Bank A/c 34,500
Jan. 8 To Sales A/c 37,370 By Balance c/d 19,070 71,420
Wrong entries and wrong casting are shown in bold prints. However, errors of cash entries generally are not
carried. Usually cash balances are tallied daily. So errors are identified at an early stage. But bank balance
cannot be checked daily and thus errors may be carried until bank reconciliation is made. In the above
example, there are four wrong entries and one wrong casting. Bank and cash balances are affected by these
errors.
(d) Wrong posting from subsidiary books: In this case, the wrong amount may be posted to the ledger
account or the amount may posted to the wrong side or to the wrong account. For example, purchases
from A may be posted to B’s account.
(e) Wrong casting of ledger balances: Likewise Cash Book, any ledger account balance may be cast
wrongly. Obviously wrong postings make the balance wrong; but that is not wrong casting of balances.
Whenever there arises independent casting error as in the case of bank column in the Cash Book of
example (4), that is called wrong casting of ledger balances.
Example 4: The following are the credit purchases of M/s. Ballav Bros.:
2021
Jan. 1 Purchases from M/s. Saurabh & Co.- gross `1,00,000 less 1% trade discount.
Jan. 3 Purchases from M/s. Netai & Co.- gross ` 70,000 less 1% trade discount.
Jan. 6 Purchases from M/s. Saurabh & Co.- gross ` 60,000 less 1% trade discount
Let us cast M/s. Saurabh & Co.’s Account:
Dr. M/s Saurabh & Co. Account Cr.
Trial Balance
On the above basis, we can classify the errors in four broad categories:
1. Errors of Principle,
2. Errors of Omission,
3. Errors of Commission,
4. Compensating Errors.
(b) The errors that do not affect the trial balance are the following:
(i) Omitting an entry altogether from the subsidiary book.
(ii) Making an entry with the wrong amount in the subsidiary book .
(iii) Posting an amount in a wrong account but on the correct side, e.g., an amount to be debited to A
is debited to B, the trial balance will still agree.
Errors
Writing the wrong Wrong casting of Posting the wrong Posting an amount on Wrong balancing of
amount in the subsidiary books. amount in the ledger. the wrong side. an account.
subsidiary books. Trial
Balance will agree.
(vi) If the difference is very big, the balance in various accounts should be compared with the corresponding
accounts in the previous period. If the figures differ materially the cases should be seen; it is possible
that an error has been committed. Suppose the sales account for the current year shows a balance of
` 32,53,000 whereas it was ` 36,45,000 last year; it is possible that there is an error in the Sales Account.
(vii) Postings of the amounts equal to the difference or half the difference should be checked. It is possible
that an amount has been omitted to be posted or has been posted on the wrong side.
(viii) If there is still a difference in the trial balance, a complete checking will be necessary. The posting of all
the entries including the opening entry should be checked. It may be better to begin with the nominal
accounts.
(iv) ` 50 was received from Mahesh and entered on the debit side of the cash book but was not posted to
his account. By the error, which affects only the account of Mahesh, ` 50 has been omitted from the
credit side of his account. The rectification will be by the entry. “By Omission of posting on the ` 50.”
(v) ` 51 paid to Mohan has been posted as `15 to the debit of his account. Mohan has been debited short
by ` 36. The rectifying entry is “To mistake in posting on ` 36”.
(vi) Goods sold to Ram for `1,000 was wrongly posted from sales day book to the debit of purchase account.
Ram has however been correctly debited. Here the error affects two accounts, viz., purchases account
and sales account but we cannot pass a journal entry for its rectification because both the accounts
need to be credited. The rectification will be by the entry “By wrong posting on ` 1,000” in the credit of
purchases account and also “By omission of posting on - ` 1,000” in the credit sales account.
(vii) Bills receivable from Mr. A of ` 500 was posted to the credit of Bills payable Account and also credited to
A account. Here also although two accounts are involved we cannot pass a complete journal entry for
rectification. The rectification will be by the entry “To wrong posting on ` 500” in debit of Bills payable
Account and also “To omission of posting on ` 500” in the debit of Bills Receivable Account.
(viii) Goods purchased from Vinod for ` 1,000 was wrongly credited to Vimal account by ` 100. Again we
cannot pass a complete journal entry for rectification even though two accounts are involved. The
rectification will be done by the entry “To wrong posting on `100” in the debit of Vimal account and “By
omission of posting on ` 1,000” in the credit of Vinod account.
Thus, from the above illustrations we are convinced that the general rule that errors affecting two accounts
can always be corrected by a journal entry is not always valid.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
How would you rectify the following errors in the book of Rama & Co.?
1. The total to the Purchases Book has been undercast by `100.
2. The Returns Inward Book has been undercast by ` 50.
3. A sum of ` 250 written off as depreciation on Machinery has not been debited to Depreciation Account.
4. A payment of ` 75 for salaries (to Mohan) has been posted twice to Salaries Account.
5. The total of Bills Receivable Book ` 1,500 has been posted to the credit of Bills Receivable Account.
6. An amount of `151 for a credit sale to Hari, although correctly entered in the Sales Book, has been posted as
` 115.
7. Discount allowed to Satish ` 25 has not been entered in the Discount Column of the Cash Book. the amount
has been postedcorrectly to the credit of his personal account.
SOLUTION
1. The Purchases Account should receive another debit of `100 since it was debited short previously:
“To Undercasting of Purchases Book for the month of --- `100.”
2. Due to this error the Returns Inward Account has been posted short by ` 50 : the correct entry will be:
“To Undercasting of Returns Inward Book for the month of --- `50.”
3. The omission of the debit to the Depreciation Account will be rectified by the entry:
“To Omission of posting on ` 250”.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
2.98 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
4. The excess debit will be removed by a credit in the Salaries Account by the entry:
“By double posting on ` 75”.
5. `1,500 should have been debited to the Bills Receivable Account and not credited. To correct the
mistake, the Bills Receivable Account should be debited by ` 3,000 by the entry:
“To Wrong posting of B/R received on ` 3,000”
6. Hari’s personal A/c is debited ` 36 short. The rectification entry will be:
“To Wrong posting ` 36”.
7. Due to this error, the discount account has been debited short by ` 25. The required entry is :
“To Omission of discount allowed to Satish on ` 25.”
So far we have discussed the correction of errors which affected only one Account or more than one account
but for which rectifying entries were not complete journal entries.We shall now take up the correction of
errors which affect more than one account in such a way that complete journal entries are possible for their
rectification. Read the following illustrations:
(i) The purchase of machinery for ` 2,000 has been entered in the purchases book. The effect of the entry
is that the account of the supplier Ram & Co. has been credited by ` 2,000 which is quite correct. But the
debit to the Purchases Account is wrong : the debit should be to Machinery Account. To rectify the error,
the debit in the purchases Account has to be transferred to the Machinery Account. The correcting
entry will be to Credit Purchases Account and debit the Machinery Account. Please see the three entries
made below: the last entry rectifies the error:
Wrong Entry: ` `
Purchases Account Dr. 2,000
To Ram & Co. 2,000
Correct Entry:
Machinery Account Dr. 2,000
To Ram & Co. 2,000
Rectifying Entry:
Machinery Account Dr. 2,000
To Purchases Account 2,000
(ii) `100 received from Kamal Kishore has been credited in the account of Krishan Kishore. The error is that
there is a wrong credit in the account of Krishan Kishore and omission of credit in the account of Kamal
Kishore; Krishan Kishore should be debited and Kamal Kishore be credited. The following three entries
make this clear:
Wrong Entry: ` `
Cash Account Dr. 100
To Krishan Kishore 100
Correct Entry:
Cash Account Dr. 100
To Kamal Kishore 100
Rectifying Entry:
Krishan Kishore Dr. 100
To Kamal Kishore 100
(iii) The sale of old machinery, `1,000 has been entered in the sales book. By this entry the account of
the buyer has been correctly debited by `1,000. But instead of crediting the Machinery Account. Sales
Account has been credited. To rectify the error this account should be debited and the Machinery
Account credited. See the three entries given below:
Wrong Entry: ` `
Buyer’s Account Dr. 1,000
To Sales Account 1,000
Correct Entry:
Buyer’s Account Dr. 1,000
To Machinery Account 1,000
Rectifying Entry:
Sales Account Dr. 1,000
To Machinery Account 1,000
? ILLUSTRATION 2
The following errors were found in the book of Ram Prasad & Sons. Give the necessary entries to correct them.
(1) ` 500 paid for furniture purchased has been charged to ordinary Purchases Account.
(2) Repairs made were debited to Building Account for ` 50.
(3) An amount of `100 withdrawn by the proprietor for his personal use has been debited to Trade Expenses
Account.
(4) `100 paid for rent debited to Landlord’s Account.
(5) Salary `125 paid to a clerk due to him has been debited to his personal account.
(6) `100 received from Shah & Co. has been wrongly entered as from Shaw & Co.
(7) ` 700 paid in cash for a typewriter was charged to Office Expenses Account.
SOLUTION
Journal
? ILLUSTRATION 3
Give journal entries to rectify the following:
(1) A purchase of goods from Ram amounting to `150 has been wrongly entered through the Sales Book.
(2) A Credit sale of goods amounting `120 to Ramesh has been wrongly passed through the Purchase Book.
(3) On 31st December, 2020 goods of the value of `300 were returned by Hari Saran and were taken inventory
on the same date but no entry was passed in the books.
(4) An amount of ` 200 due from Mahesh Chand, which had been written off as a Bad Debt in a previous year,
was unexpectedly recovered, and had been posted to the personal account of Mahesh Chand.
(5) A Cheque for `100 received from Man Mohan was dishonoured and had been posted to the debit of Sales
Returns Account.
SOLUTION
Journal
Particulars L.F. Dr. Cr.
` `
(1) Purchases A/c Dr. 150
Sales A/c Dr. 150
To Ram 300
(Correction of wrong entry in the sales Book for a purchases of
goods from Ram)
(2) Ramesh Dr. 240
To Purchases A/c 120
To Sales A/c 120
(Correction of wrong entry in the Purchases Book of a credit sale
of goods to Ram)
(3) Returns Inwards A/c Dr. 300
To Hari Saran 300
(Entry of goods returned by him and taken in inventory omitted
from records)
(4) Mahesh Chand Dr. 200
To Bad Debts Recovered A/c 200
(Correction of wrong credit to Personal A/c in respect of recovery
of previously written off bad debts)
(5) Man Mohan Dr. 100
To Sales Return A/c 100
(Correction of wrong debit to Sales Returns A/c for dishonour of
cheque received from Man Mohan)
Thus it can be said that errors detected before the preparation of trial balance can be rectified either through
rectification statements (not entries) or through rectification entries.
7.5.2 After Trial Balance but before Final Accounts
The method of correction of error indicated so far is appropriate when the errors have been located before
the end of the accounting period. After the corrections the trial balance will agree. Sometimes the trial
balance is artificially made to agree inspire of errors by opening a suspense account and putting the
difference in the trial balance to the account - the suspense account will be debited if the total of the credit
column in the trial balance exceeds the total of the debit column; it will be credited in the other case.
One must note that such agreement of the trial balance will not be real. Effort must be made to locate the
errors.
The rule of rectifying errors detected at this stage is simple. Those errors for which complete journal entries
were not possible in the earlier stage of rectification (i.e., before trial balance) can now be rectified by way
of journal entry(s) with the help of suspense account, for it these errors which gave rise to the suspense
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
2.102 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
account in the trial balance. The rectification entry for other type of error i.e. error affecting more than one
account in such a way that a complete journal entry is possible for its rectification, can be rectified in the
same way as in the earlier stage (i.e. before trial balance).
In a nutshell, it can be said that each and every error detected at this stage can only be corrected by a
complete journal entry. Those errors for which journal entries were not possible at the earlier stage will now
be rectified by a journal entry(s), the difference or the unknown side is being taken care of by suspense
account. Those errors for which entries were possible even at the first stage will now be rectified in the same
way.
Suppose, the sales book for November, 2019 is cast `100 short; as a consequence the trial balance will not
agree. The credit column of the trial balance will be `100 short and a Suspense Account will be credited by
`100. To rectify the error the Sales Account will be credited (to increase the credit to the right figure. Since
now one error remains, the Suspense Account must be closed- it will be debiting the Suspense Account. The
entry will be:
Suspense Account Dr. `100
To Sales Account `100
(Correction of error of undercasting the sales
Book for November 2019)
? ILLUSTRATION 4
Correct the following errors (i) without opening a Suspense Account and (ii) opening a Suspense Account:
(a) The Sales Book has been totalled `100 short.
(b) Goods worth `150 returned by Green & Co. have not been recorded anywhere.
(c) Goods purchased `250 have been posted to the debit of the supplier Gupta & Co.
(d) Furniture purchased from Gulab & Bros, `1,000 has been entered in Purchases Day Book.
(e) Discount received from Red & Black `15 has not been entered in the Discount Column of the Cash Book.
(f) Discount allowed to G. Mohan & Co. `18 has not been entered in the Discount Column of the Cash Book. The
account of G. Mohan & Co. has, however, been correctly posted.
SOLUTION
(c) Gupta & Co. have been debited `250 instead of being credited. This account should now be credited by
500 to remove the wrong debit and to give the correct debit. The entry will be on the credit side... “By
errors in posting `500”.
(d) By this error Purchases Account has to be debited by `1,000 whereas the debit should have been to the
Furniture Account. The correcting entry will be:
(e) The discount of `15 received from Red & Black should have been entered on the credit side of the cash
book. Had this been done, the Discount Account would have been credited (through the total of the
discount column) and Red & Black would have been debited. This entry should not be made:
(f ) In this case the account of the customer has been correctly posted; the Discount Account has been
debited `18 short since it has been omitted from the discount column on the debit side of the cash
book. The discount account should now be debited by the entry; “To Omission of entry in the Cash Book
`18.”
If a Suspense Account is opened :
Suspense Account
? ILLUSTRATION 5
Correct the following errors found in the books of Mr. Dutt. The Trial Balance was out by ` 493 excess credit. The
difference thus has been posted to a Suspense Account.
(a) An amount of `100 was received from D. Das on 31st December, 2020 but has been omitted to enter in the
Cash Book.
(b) The total of Returns Inward Book for December has been cast `100 short.
(c) The purchase of an office table costing ` 300 has been passed through the Purchases Day Book.
(d) ` 375 paid for Wages to workmen for making show-cases had been charged to “Wages Account”.
(e) A purchase of ` 67 had been posted to the trade payables’ account as ` 60.
(f) A cheque for ` 200 received from P. C. Joshi had been dishonoured and was passed to the debit of “Allowances
Account”.
(g) ` 1,000 paid for the purchase of a motor cycle for Mr. Dutt had been charged to “Miscellaneous Expenses
Account”.
(h) Goods amounting to `100 had been returned by customer and were taken in to inventory, but no entry in
respect there of, was made into the books.
(i) A sale of ` 200 to Singh & Co. was wrongly credited to their account. Entry was made correctly made in sales
book.
SOLUTION
Particulars L.F. ` `
(a) Cash Account Dr. 100
To D. Das 100
(Being the amount received)
(b) Returns Inward Account Dr. 100
To Suspense Account 100
(Being the mistake in totalling the Returns Inward Book
corrected)
(c) Furniture Account Dr. 300
To Purchases Account 300
(Being the rectification of mistake by which purchase of
furniture was entered in Purchases book and hence debited
to Purchases Account)
(d) Furniture Account Dr. 375
To Wages Account 375
(Being the wages paid to workmen for making show-cases
which should be capitalised and not to be charged to Wages
Account)
(e) Suspense Account Dr. 7
To Creditors (personal) Account 7
(Being the mistake in crediting the Trade payables Account
less by ` 7, now corrected)
(f ) P.C. Joshi Dr. 200
To Allowances Account 200
(Being the cheque of P.C. Joshi dishonoured, previously
debited to Allowances Account)
Suspense Account
Dr. Cr.
Date Particulars Amount Date Particulars Amount
2020 ` 2020 `
Dec.31 To Difference in Dec. 31 By Returns
Trial Balance 493 Inwards A/c 100
““ To Trade Payables A/c 7 ““ By Singh & Co. 400
500 500
? ILLUSTRATION 6
The following errors, affecting the account for the year 2020 were detected in the books of Jain Brothers, Delhi:
(1) Sale of old Furniture `150 treated as sale of goods.
(2) Receipt of ` 500 from Ram Mohan credited to Shyam Sunder.
(3) Goods worth `100 brought from Mohan Narain have remained unrecorded so far.
(4) A return of `120 from Mukesh posted to his debit.
(5) A return of ` 90 to Shyam Sunder posted as ` 9 in his account.
(6) Rent of proprietor’s residence, ` 600 debited to rent A/c.
(7) A payment of ` 215 to Mohammad Sadiq posted to his credit as `125.
(8) Sales Book added ` 900 short.
(9) The total of Bills Receivable Book ` 1,500 left unposted.
You are required to pass the necessary rectifying entries and show how the trial balance would be affected by the
errors.
SOLUTION
Journal
? ILLUSTRATION 7
Write out the Journal Entries to rectify the following errors, using a Suspense Account.
(1) Goods of the value of `100 returned by Mr. Sharma were entered in the Sales Day Book and posted therefrom
to the credit of his account;
(2) An amount of `150 entered in the Sales Returns Book, has been posted to the debit of Mr. Philip, who returned
the goods;
(3) A sale of ` 200 made to Mr. Ghanshyam was correctly entered in the Sales Day Book but wrongly posted to
the debit of Mr. Radheshyam as ` 20;
(4) Bad Debts aggregating `450 were written off during the year in the Sales ledger but were not adjusted in the
General Ledger; and
(5) The total of “Discount Allowed” column in the Cash Book for the month of September, 2020 amounting to
` 250 was not posted.
SOLUTION
Journal
Particulars L.F. Dr. Cr.
` `
(1) Sales Account Dr. 100
Sales Returns Account Dr. 100
To Suspense Account 200
(The value of goods returned by Mr. Sharma
wrongly posted to Sales and omission of debit to
Sales Returns Account, now rectified)
(2) Suspense Account Dr. 300
To Mr. Philip 300
(Wrong debit to Mr. Philip for goods returned by
him, now rectified)
(3) Mr. Ghanshyam Dr. 200
To Mr. Radheshyam 20
To Suspense Account 180
(Omission of debit to Mr. Ghanshyam and wrong
credit to Mr. Radhesham for sale of ` 200, now
rectified)
(4) Bad Debts Account Dr. 450
To Suspense Account 450
(The amount of Bad Debts written off not adjusted
in General Ledger, now rectified)
(5) Discount Account Dr. 250
To Suspense Account 250
(The total of Discount allowed during September,
2020 not posted from the Cash Book; error now
rectified)
? ILLUSTRATION 8
Mr. Roy was unable to agree the Trial Balance last year and wrote off the difference to the Profit and Loss Account
of that year. Next Year, he appointed a Chartered Accountant who examined the old books and found the
following mistakes:
(1) Purchase of a scooter was debited to conveyance account `3,000.
(3) A credit purchase of goods from Mr. P for `2,000 entered as a sale.
(4) Receipt of cash from Mr. A was posted to the account of Mr. B `1,000.
(5) Receipt of cash from Mr. C was posted to the debit of his account, `500.
(6) ` 500 due by Mr. Q was omitted to be taken to the trial balance.
Mr. Roy used 10% depreciation on vehicles. Suggest the necessary rectification entries.
SOLUTION
Journal Entries in the books of Mr. Roy
Date Particulars Dr. Cr.
` `
(1) Motor Vehicles Account Dr. 2,700
To Profit and Loss Adjustment A/c 2,700
(Purchase of scooter wrongly debited to conveyance
account now rectified-capitalisation of ` 2,700, i.e.,
` 3,000 less 10% depreciation)
(2) Suspense Account Dr. 10,000
To Profit & Loss Adjustment A/c 10,000
(Purchase Account overcast in the previous year; error
now rectified).
(3) Profit & Loss Adjustment A/c Dr. 4,000
To P’s Account 4,000
(Credit purchase from P ` 2,000, enteredas sales last
year; now rectified)
(4) B’s Account Dr. 1,000
To A’s Account 1,000
(Amount received from A wrongly posted to the
account of B; now rectified)
(5) Suspense Account Dr. 1,000
To C’s Account 1,000
(` 500 received from C wrongly debited to his account;
now rectified)
(6) Trade receivables Dr. 500
To Suspense Account 500
(` 500 due by Q not taken into trialbalance; now
rectified)
(7) R’s Account Dr. 2,000
To Profit & Loss Adjustment A/c 2,000
(Sales to R omitted last year; now adjusted)
(8) Suspense Account Dr. 198
To Profit & Loss Adjustment A/c 198
(Excess posting to purchase account last year, ` 2,593,
instead of ` 2,395, now adjusted)
(9) Profit & Loss Adjustment A/c Dr. 10,898
To Roy’s Capital Account 10,898
(Balance of Profit & Loss Adjustment A/c transferred to
Capital Account)
(10) Roy’s Capital Account Dr. 10,698
To Suspense Account 10,698
(Balance of Suspense Account transferred to the
Capital Account)
Note : Entries No. (2) and (8) may even be omitted; but this is not advocated.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING PROCESS 2.111
Suspense Account
` `
To Profit & Loss Adjustment Account 10,000 By Trade Receivables (Q) 500
To C 1,000 By Roy’s Capital Account (Transfer) 10,698
To Profit & Loss Adjustment Account 198
11,198 11,198
SUMMARY
w Unintentional omission or commission of amounts and accounts in the process of recording the
transactions are commonly known as errors.
w Accounting errors are generally of four types-
(a) Errors of Principle;
(b) Errors of Omission;
(c) Errors of Commission;
(d) Compensating Errors.
w Some errors may affect the Trial Balance and some of these do not.
w The method of rectification of errors depends on the stage at which the errors are detected. If the error
is detected before the preparation of trial balance, rectification is carried out by making the statement
in the appropriate side of the concerned account.
w In case of the errors detected after the preparation of the trial balance, we open a suspense account
with the amount of difference in the trial balance. Then complete journal entries can be passed for
rectifying the errors.
w For rectifying the errors detected in the next accounting period, a special account ‘Profit and Loss
Adjustment Account’ is opened for correction of amounts relating to expenses and incomes.
5. On purchase of old furniture, the amount of `1,000 spent on its repair should be debited to
(a) Repair account.
(b) Furniture account.
(c) Cash account.
6. Goods worth `50 given as charity should be credited to
(a) Charity account.
(b) Sales account.
(c) Purchase account.
7. Goods worth `100 taken by proprietor for domestic use should be credited to
(a) Sales account.
(b) Proprietor’s personal expenses.
(c) Purchases account.
8. Sales of office furniture should be credited to
(a) Sales Account.
(b) Furniture Account.
(c) Purchase Account.
9. The preparation of a trial balance is for:
(a) Locating errors of commission.
(b) Locating errors of principle.
(c) Locating clerical errors.
10. `200 received from Smith whose account, was written off as a bad debt should be credited to:
(a) Bad Debts Recovered account.
(b) Smith’s account.
(c) Cash account.
11. Purchase of office furniture `1,200 has been debited to General Expense Account. It is:
(a) A clerical error.
(b) An error of principle.
(c) An error of omission.
Theory Questions
1. How does errors of omission differ from errors of commission?
2. What is error of principle and how does it affect Trial Balance?
3. When and how is Suspense account used to rectify errors?
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
2.114 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
Practical Questions
1. The trial balance of Mr. W & H failed to agree and the difference `20,570 was put into suspense pending
investigation which disclosed that:
(i) Purchase returns day book had been correctly entered and totalled at `6,160, but had been posted
to the ledger.
(ii) Discounts received `1,320 had been debited to discounts allowed.
(iii) The Sales account had been under added by `10,000.
(iv) A credit sale of `1,470 had been debited to a customer account at `1,740.
(v) A vehicle bought originally for `7,000 four years ago and depreciated to `1,200 had not been sold
for `1,500 in the beginning of the year but no entries, other than in the bank account had been
passed through the books.
(vi) An accrual of `560 for telephone charges had been completely omitted.
(vii) A bad debt of `1,560 had not been written off and provision for doubtful debts should have been
maintained at 10% of Trade receivables which are shown in the trial balance at `23,390 with a credit
provision for bad debts at `2,320.
(viii) Tools bought for `1,200 had been inadvertently debited to purchases.
(ix) The proprietor had withdrawn, for personal use, goods worth `1,960. No entries had been made in
the books.
You are required to give rectification entries without narration to correct the above errors before
preparing annual accounts.
2. On going through the Trial balance of Ball Bearings Co. Ltd. you find that the debit is in excess by `150.
This was credited to “Suspense Account”. On a close scrutiny of the books the following mistakes were
noticed:
(1) The totals of debit side of “Expenses Account” have beeen cast in excess by ` 50.
(2) The “Sales Account” has been totalled in short by `100.
(3) Supplier account has been overcast by 225.
(4) The sale return of `100 from a party has not been posted to that account though the Party’s account
has been credited.
(5) A cheque of `500 issued to the Suppliers’ account (shown under Trade payables) towards his dues
has been wrongly debited to the purchases.
(6) A credit sale of `50 has been credited to the Sales and also to the Trade receivables Account.
You are required to
(i) Pass necessary journal entries for correcting the above;
(ii) Show how they affect the Profits; and
(iii) Prepare the “Suspense Account” as it would appear in the ledger.
3. Mr. A closed his books of account on September 30, 2020 in spite of a difference in the trial balance.
The difference was `830 the credits being short; it was carried forward in a Suspense Account. In 2021
following errors were located:
(i) A sale of `2,300 to Mr. Lala was posted to the credit of Mrs. Mala.
(ii) The total of the Returns Inward Book for July, 2020 `1,240 was not posted in the ledger.
(iii) Freight paid on a machine `5,600 was posted to the Freight Account as `6,500. 10% Depreciation is
charge on this machines.
(iv) White carrying forward the total in the Purchases Account to the next page, `65,590 was written
instead of `56,950.
(v) A sale of machine on credit to Mr. Mehta for `9,000 on 30th sept. 2020 was not entered in the books
at all. The book value of the machine was `6,750.
Pass journal entries to rectify the errors. Have you any comments to make?
4. A merchant’s trial balance as on June 30, 2020 did not agree. The difference was put to a Suspense
Account. During the next trading period, the following errors were discovered:
(i) The total of the Purchases Book of one page, `4,539 was carried forward to the next page as `4,593.
(ii) A sale of `573 was entered in the Sales Book as `753 and posted to the credit of the customer.
(iii) A return to a creditor, `510 was entered in the Returns Inward Book; however, the creditor’s account
was correctly posted.
(iv) Cash received from C. Dass, `620 was posted to the debit of G. Dass.
(v) Goods worth `840 were despatched to a customer before the close of the year but no invoice was
made out.
(vi) Goods worth `1,000 were sent on sale or return basis to a customer and entered in the Sales Book.
At the close of the year, the customer still had the option to return the goods. The sale price was
25% above cost.
You are required to give journal entries to rectify the errors in a way so as to show the current year’s
profit or loss correctly.
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. True: there are 3 different stages when the mistakes are identified and then the rectification depends on
the stage of identification
2. False: In case of error of complete omission, the trial balance tallies.
3. True: to balance the difference of balances in the trial balance.
4. True: where the accounts being debited is principally incorrect it is termed as error of principle
5. True: compensating errors cancel out each other when Trial balance is prepared as the mistake pertains
to the same amount being credited and later debited on account of two different mistakes.
6. False: When amount is written on wrong side, it is known as an error of commission.
7. False: On purchase of furniture, the amount spent on repairs should be debited to furniture account as
it is a capital expense.
8. False: ‘Profit & Loss adjustment account’ is opened to rectify the errors detected in the next accounting
period.
9. False: Rent paid to land lord of the proprietors house, must be debited to ‘Drawings account’.
10. False: If the errors are detected after preparing trial balance, then all the errors are not rectified through
suspense account. There may be principal errors, which can be rectified without opening a suspense
account.
MCQs
Practical Questions
Answer 1
` `
To Return outward Account 6,160 By balance b/d 20,570
To Discount allowed Account 1,320
To Discount Received Account 1,320
To Sales Account 10,000
To Customers Account 270
To Vehicles Account 1,200
To Profit on Sale of Vehicle 300
20,570 20,570
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
2.118 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
Answer 2
Journal Entries
Suspense Account
Dr. ` Cr. `
To Expenses Account 50 By Difference in Trial Balance 150
To Sales Account 100 By Trade payables 225
To Balance c/d 425 By Sales Returns Account 100
By Trade receivables 100
575 575
By Balance b/d 425
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING PROCESS 2.119
Since the Suspense Account does not balance, it is clear that all the errors have not been traced. As a result
of the above corrections the Net Profit will be:
Increased by Decreased by
` `
Mistake in totalling in “Expenses” 50
Mistake in totalling in “Sales” 100
Mistake in posting from day book to Ledger under
“Purchases” 500
Omission in posting under “Sales Returns” 100
650 100
Net Increase 550
Dr. Cr.
Date Particulars Amount Date Particulars Amount
` `
2021 To Profit and Loss 2020 By Balance b/d 830
Adjustment A/c 900 Oct. 1 By Sundries
To Profit and Loss Mrs. Mala 2,300
Adjustment A/c 8,640 Mr. Lala 2,300
By Profit and Loss
Adjustment A/c 1,240
By balance c/d 2,870
9,540 9,540
Since the Suspense Account still shows a balance, it is obvious that there are still some errors left in the
books.
Profit & Loss Adjustment A/c
(For Prior Period Items)
Dr. Cr.
Date Particulars Amount Date Particulars Amount
2021 ` 2021 `
To Suspense A/c 1,240 By Machinery A/c 5,600
To Plant and Machinery A/c 560 By Suspense A/c 900
To Balance c/d 15,590 By Suspense A/c 8,640
By Mr. Mehta 2,250
17,390 17,390
Answer 4
Journal Entries
w Understand the reasons for difference between Cash Book balance and Pass Book balance and try to
ascertain the amount of such differences.
w Understand the purpose for preparing the bank reconciliation statement and its utility.
Timing Differences
differences arising due
to errors in
recording the
entries
1. INTRODUCTION
Banks are essential institutions in a modern society. With the increase in volume of trade, commerce and
business, business entities faced difficulty in transacting in cash for each business activity. They discovered
that dealing through bank, on regular basis, would be the better and safer option and finally large
business entities switched over to banking transactions instead of dealing in cash. Now-a-days, most of the
transactions of the business are done through bank whether it is a receipt or a payment. Rather, it is legally
necessary to operate the transactions through bank after a certain limit.
A Bank accepts from people, in general, deposits in various forms, and lends funds to those who need; it
also invests some funds in profitable investments. Thus, money which would have been otherwise idle is
put to use and is made available to those who need it. Those who deposit the money are able to withdraw
it according to the settled terms and conditions. Apart from receiving deposits from and handling cash
transactions on behalf of its customers, the bank also renders some other useful services as indicated below:
(i) The bank discounts promissory notes or hundies, i.e., it enables a customer to receive the cash before
the due date in consideration of a small charge called discount.
(ii) The bank allows overdraft to its good customers so that they can make payments even when they
do not have sufficient balance at the bank. Of course, the overdraft is generally secured and must be
cleared later.
(iii) The bank gives loans for a year or so, to its customers so that they can continue their operations. Such
financial assistance is of great help for business.
(iv) The bank on behalf of the customer collects the amount of dividend warrants or interest on securities
etc.
(v) On instruction of the customer, the bank makes payments of insurance premium, rent etc. on the due
dates.
(vi) The bank sells and purchases shares, debentures or government securities on behalf of its customers.
(vii) Money can be remitted to another place or persons through the bank at a low cost.
(viii) The bank in return, for a consideration, furnishes security or guarantee for its customers whose credit is
good.
(ix) The bank also issues letter of credit or travellers’ cheque to facilitate commerce or travel.
PASS BOOK
Messers.........................................
in account with
Punjab National Bank
Daryaganj, New Delhi-110002
Date Particulars Cheque No. Withdrawals Deposits Balance
Dr. Cr. Dr. or Cr.
` ` `
The bank statement of account also has a similar form except that it is on loose sheets or can be in an online
format. The bank itself sends the statements to customers but if the customer wants to maintain a passbook
then its is their duty to send the pass book to the bank periodically so that it is updated by the bank. These
days, many bank ATMs have the automated machines where one can get the passbook updated without
any manual intervention.
Business houses should also obtain at the end of the year a certificate from the bank duly stamped and
signed, showing the balance which the firm carries with the bank as of date. The bank balance shown in the
passbook is known as pass book balance for reconciliation purpose. The credit balance as per pass book at
a particular point of time is the deposit made by the customer while debit balance as per pass book is the
overdraft balance for the customer (i.e. customer owes to bank).
Students may note here that the nature of balance shown by pass book (in the books of bank) and cash
book (in the books of customer) is quite different. The debit balance in the pass book represents the credit
balance as per the cash book and vice-versa because the business enterprise treats the bank as a debtor/
Trade receivable and bank treats the business enterprise as a creditor/Trade payable.
10,000 10,000
Bank statement (pass book)
Date Particulars Dr. (withdrawn) Cr. (deposited) Balance
Balance b/f 10,000(cr.)
On the issue of aforesaid cheque, the bank account in Cash Book is credited by `2,000 and so balance is
reduced to `8,000. Whereas balance in the Pass Book remains `10,000 until the cheque is presented for
payment.
(ii) Cheques deposited with the bank but not cleared: As soon as cheques are sent to the bank (i.e.
deposited with bank), entries are made on the debit side of the bank column of the cash book. But
usually banks credit the customer’s account only when they have received the payment from the bank
concerned- in other words, when the cheques have been cleared. Again there will be some gap between
the depositing of the cheques and the credit given by the bank.
Example : The balance as per Cash book and Pass Book are ` 12,000. Cheque of ` 3,000 is deposited but
not cleared.
Cash book
Particulars ` Particulars `
To balance b/f 12,000 By balance c/f 15,000
To Vendor A/c 3,000
15,000 15,000
Cash book
Particulars ` Particulars `
To balance b/f 10,000 By balance c/f 10,000
10,000 10,000
Bank statement (pass book)
Date Particulars Dr. (withdrawn) Cr. (deposited) Balance
Balance b/f 10,000(cr.)
Interest 1,000 11,000(cr.)
Because of such interest balance of Pass Book is increased to `11,000. Whereas balance in the Cash Book
remains `10,000 until information reaches customer and he records such transaction.
(iv) Interest and expenses charged by the bank: Like (iii) above, the interest charged by the bank and
the amount of the bank charges are entered in the customer account and later in the pass book. The
customer makes the required entries only after he sees the pass book or bank statement. These are
debited to customer account by bank therefore till such entry is passed in cash book, bank balance as
per pass book is less than bank balance as per cash book.
(v) Interest and dividends collected by the bank: Sometimes investments are left with the bank in the
safe custody; the bank itself sees to it that the interest or the dividend is collected on the due dates.
Entries are made as indicated in (iii) above.
Example: The balance as per Cash Book and Pass Book are `15,000. The bank has collected dividend of
`2,000.
Cash book
Particulars ` Particulars `
To balance b/f 15,000 By balance c/f 15,000
15,000 15,000
Bank statement (pass book)
Date Particulars Dr. (withdrawn) Cr. (deposited) Balance
Balance b/f 15,000(cr.)
Dividend 2,000(Cr.) 17,000(cr.)
On collection of dividend bank credits the amount to customer’s account, so balance in Pass Book is
increased to `17,000. Whereas balance in the Cash Book remains `15,000 until the information of such
dividend collection reaches the customer and he records such transaction.
(vi) Direct payments by the bank: The bank may be given standing instructions for certain payments such
as for insurance premium. In this case also, the customer may come to know of the payment only on
seeing the pass book. The entries in the pass book and in the cash book may thus be on different dates.
Example: The balance as per Cash Book and Pass Book of Mr. X are `20,000. The bank has instruction to
pay insurance premium of `1,500 directly to insurance company at the end of each month
Cash book
Particulars ` Particulars `
To balance b/f 20,000 By balance c/f 20,000
20,000 20,000
Bank statement (pass book)
Date Particulars Dr. (withdrawn) Cr. (deposited) Balance
Balance b/f 20,000 (cr.)
Insurance premium 1,500 18,500 (cr.)
On payment of insurance premium bank debits the customer’s account by `1,500 so balance in Pass
Book is decreased to `18,500. Whereas balance in the Cash Book remains `20,000 until the information
of such payment reaches the customer and he records such transaction.
(vii) Direct payment into the bank by a customer: If such a payment is received by the bank, it will be
entered in the customer’s account and also in the pass book; the account holder may come to know of
the amount only when he sees the pass book.
(viii) Dishonour of a bill discounted with the bank: If the bank is not able to receive payment on promissory
notes discounted by it, it will debit the customer’s account together with the charges it may have
incurred. The customer will naturally make the entry only when he sees the pass book.
Example : The balances as per Cash Book and Pass Book of Mr. X are `20,000. Mr. X deposited a cheque
of `3,000 and debited to his bank account `3,000 immediately. But bank will credit X’s account on
realization of amount. Now the cheque is dishonoured for non-payment. Bank charges `100 in this
connection.
Cash book
Particulars ` Particulars `
To balance b/f 20,000 By balance c/f 23,000
To bank a/c 3,000
23,000 23,000
Bank statement (pass book)
Date Particulars Dr. (withdrawn) Cr. (deposited) Balance
Balance b/f 20,000 (cr.)
Bank charges 100 19,900 (cr.)
Thus, balance of Mr. X’s account in Pass Book stands `19,900 after this transaction while balance as per
Cash Book stand `23,000. So Mr. X should deduct `3,000 the amount of dishonoured cheque, plus `100
the amount of bank charges for reconciliation.
(ix) Bills collected by the bank on behalf of the customer: If goods are sold, the documents may be sent
through the bank. If the bank is able to collect the amount, it will credit the customer’s account. The
customer may make the entry only on receiving the pass book.
All these timing differences will lead to difference in balances as shown by the cash book and the pass
book.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Step: 2 Compare the credit side of the cash book with the withdrawal column of the pass book
We find that the following cheques are not recorded. Therefore, if we enter these two cheques on the
withdrawal side of the pass book the balance becomes: -
Existing balance 3,82,000
Less:- K Nagpal & Co. (73,000)
B Babu & Co. (78,000)
Total 2,31,000
There is an item Interest on Government Securities which appears on the deposit side of the pass book but
not in the debit side of the cash book, so this item should be deducted from pass book balance:-
Existing balance 2,31,000
Less:- Interest on govt. securities (20,000)
Total 2,11,000
Further, there are two items which appear on the withdrawal side of the pass book i.e. they have been
deducted from the bank balance but not on the credit side of the cash book, so these items should be
added in order to reconcile the balance:-
Existing balance:- 2,11,000
Add: Insurance premium 25,000
Add: Bank charges 1,000
Total 2,37,000
Therefore , we have arrived at the balance as per the cash book from the pass book.
This process shows that the difference between the two balance arise only because there are some entries made
in the cash-book but not in the pass book and some entries which are made in the pass book but not in the cash
book. A comparison of the two shows up such entries and then, on that basis, the reconciliation is prepared. To
illustrate it again, let us proceed from the cash book balance of `2,37,000. Since cheques totalling `1,39,000
have not been entered in the pass book, let us assume that they are also omitted from the cash book, this will
reduce the cash book balance to `98,000. Cheques totalling `1,51,000 have been entered on the credit side of
the cash book but not in the pass book their omission from the cash book will increase the cash book balance
to `2,49,000. Amounts totalling `26,000 have been entered in the withdrawals column of the pass book but
not in the cash book; an entry on the credit side of the cash book for these amounts will reduce the balance to
`2,23,000. The deposits column shows an entry of `20,000 not found on the debit side of the cash book; the
entry made in the cash book will increase balance to `2,43,000 as shown in the pass book.
(x) Errors: While recording the entries errors can occur both in the cash book and in the pass book. A bank
rarely makes and error but if does, the balance in the pass book will naturally differ from cash book.
Similarly if any error is committed in the cash book then it’s balance will be different from that of the
pass book.
Some of the errors include commission of entry, recording of an incorrect amount, recording of entry
on the wrong side of the book, wrong totalling of the account or wrong balancing of the book and
recording of transactions of other party.
TYPES OF PROBLEMS
When causes of differences are known then students can start reconciliation by taking any of the balance
stated above and proceed further with the causes. Given the causes of disagreement, the balance of the
other book can be either more or less on account of the said causes. If the balance of the other book is more
on account of the said causes then add the amount. If the balance of the other book is less on account of the
said causes then subtract the amount.
For example, if the reconciliation is initiated with Dr. balance as per the cash book and there is a cheque
deposited in the bank but not yet cleared, then on account of non-clearance of the cheque, the Cr. balance
of the pass book would be less. In this case, the amount of cheque should be subtracted from the cash book
balance to arrive at the balance as per the pass book. Similarly, after making all the adjustments the balance
as per the other book is obtained. It is necessary to note here that if a student starts from debit balance of
cash book and after all adjustments the balance arrived is positive then it is known as Cr. balance as per the
pass book and if the balance is negative then it is said to be Dr. balance as per the pass book and vice-versa.
But if causes of differences are not known then one has to compare the debit entries of cash book with the
credit entries of the pass-book and vice-versa. The entries, which do not tally in the course, are the causes of
difference in the balances of both the books. Once the causes are located their effects on both the books are
analysed and then reconciliation statement is prepared to arrive at the actual bank balance.
In this procedure students, should also take into care that whether opening balance of both the books at
particular point of time from where the books are compared, tallies or not. If opening balances are not same
then unticked items are divided into two categories i.e., one relating to reconciliation of opening balance
and other relating to reconciliation of closing balance.
Example: Jolly Ltd has following entries in its cash book and pass book:
CASH-BOOK (Bank column only)
Date Particulars Amount Date Particulars Amount
2019 ` 2019 `
May 1 To Balance b/d 70,000 May 15 By Richa Ltd. 20,000
May 9 To Avengers Ltd. 50,000
May13 To Cash A/c 80,000
May 30 By Balance c/d 1,80,000
2,00,000 2,00,000
PASS-BOOK
? ILLUSTRATION 2
From the following particulars, prepare a Bank Reconciliation Statement for Jindal offset Ltd.
(1) Balance as per cash book is ` 2,40,000
(2) Cheques issued but not presented in the bank amounts to ` 1,36,000.
(3) Cheques deposited in bank but not yet cleared amounts to ` 90,000.
(4) Bank charges amounts to ` 300.
(5) Interest credited by bank amounts to ` 1,250.
(6) The balance as per pass book is ` 2,86,950.
SOLUTION
Bank Reconciliation Statement
Particulars Amount
`
Balance as per cash book 2,40,000
Add : Cheque issued but not presented 1,36,000
Interest credited by bank 1,250
3,77,250
Less : Cheque deposited but not yet cleared (90,000)
Bank charges debited by bank (300)
Balance as per pass book 2,86,950
? ILLUSTRATION 3
On 31st March 2019, the Bank Pass Book of Namrata showed a balance of ` 1,50,000 to her credit while balance
as per cash book was ` 1,12,050. On scrutiny of the two books, she ascertained the following causes of difference:
i) She has issued cheques amounting to ` 80,000 out of which only ` 32,000 were presented for payment.
ii) She received a cheque of ` 5,000 which she recorded in her cash book but forgot to deposit in the bank.
iii) A cheque of ` 22,000 deposited by her has not been cleared yet.
iv) Mr. Gupta deposited an amount of ` 15,700 in her bank which has not been recorded by her in Cash Book yet.
v) Bank has credited an interest of ` 1,500 while charging ` 250 as bank charges.
Prepare a bank reconciliation statement.
SOLUTION
Bank Reconciliation Statement as on 31st March 2019
? ILLUSTRATION 4
From the following particulars ascertain the balance that would appear in the Bank Pass Book of A on
31st December, 2019.
(1) The bank overdraft as per Cash Book on 31st December, 2019 `6,340.
(2) Interest on overdraft for 6 months ending 31st December, 2019 `160 is entered in Pass Book.
(3) Bank charges of ` 400 are debited in the Pass Book only.
(4) Cheques issued but not cashed prior to 31st December, 2019, amounted to `11,68,000.
(5) Cheques paid into bank but not cleared before 31st December, 2019 were for ` 22,17,000.
(6) Interest on investments collected by the bank and credited in the Pass Book `12,00,000.
SOLUTION
Bank Reconciliation Statement
As on 31st December, 2019
Particulars Amount
`
Overdraft as per Cash Book 6,340
Add: Interest debited in the Pass Book but not yet entered in the Cash Book 160
Add: Bank charges debited in the Pass Book but not entered in the Cash Book 400
Add : Cheques deposited but not yet credited in the Pass Book 22,17,000
22,23,900
Less: Cheques issued but not yet presented (11,68,000)
Less: Interest collected and credited by bank but not yet entered in Cash Book (12,00,000)
Balance as per Pass Book (Credit/Favourable balance) (1,44,100)
The above illustration can also be presented with the column for “Plus” and “Minus.”
preparing the bank reconciliation statement is completely optional, if reconciliation is done during different
months. But if reconciliation is done at the end of the accounting year or financial year, the cash-book must
be adjusted so as to reflect the correct bank balance in the balance sheet.
While adjusting the cash-book the following adjustments are considered:-
1. All the errors (like incorrect amount recorded in the cash-book, entry posted twice in the cash-book,
over/undercasting of the balance etc.) and
2. Omissions (like bank charges recorded in the pass-book only, interest debited by the bank, direct receipt
or payment by the bank, dishonour of cheques/bills etc.) by the cash-book are taken into care
Only above transactions are considered for adjusting cash book. Apart from this, any delay in recording
in the pass-book due to difference in timing (like cheque issued but not presented for payment, cheque
deposited but not cleared) is taken to bank reconciliation statement. This adjusted cash-book balance
is taken to bank reconciliation statement.
Errors occurring in the pass-book are not to be adjusted in the cash book. All the adjustments
considered in the adjusted cash-book are not carried again to the bank reconciliation statement.
? ILLUSTRATION 5
On 30th September, 2019, the bank account of X, according to the bank column of the Cash- Book, was overdrawn
to the extent of `4,062. On the same date the bank statement showed a credit balance of `20,758 in favour of X.
An examination of the Cash Book and Bank Statement reveals the following:
1. A cheque for `13,14,000 deposited on 29th September, 2019 was credited by the bank only on 3rd October,
2019.
2. A payment by cheque for `16,000 has been entered twice in the Cash Book.
3. On 29th September, 2019, the bank credited an amount of `1,17,400 received from a customer of X, but the
advice was not received by X until 1st October, 2019.
4. Bank charges amounting to `580 had not been entered in the Cash Book.
5. On 6th September, 2019, the bank credited `20,000 to X in error.
6. A bill of exchange for `1,40,000 was discounted by X with his bank. This bill was dishonoured on 28th
September, 2019 but no entry had been made in the books of X.
7. Cheques issued upto 30th September, 2019 but not presented for payment upto that date totalled ` 13,26,000.
You are required :
(a) to show the appropriate rectifications required in the Cash Book of X, to arrive at the correct balance on 30th
September, 2019 and
(b) to prepare a bank reconciliation statement as on that date.
SOLUTION
Particulars Amount
`
Overdraft as per Cash Book 11,242
Add: Cheque deposited but not collected upto 30th September, 2019 13,14,000
13,25,242
Less: Cheques issued but not presented for payment upto 30th September, 2019 (13,26,000)
Credit by Bank erroneously on 6th September (20,000)
Credit balance as per bank statement 20,758
Note: Bank has credited X by 20,000 in error on 6th September, 2019. If this mistake is rectified in the bank
statement, then this will not be deducted in the above statement along with ` 13,26,000 resulting in credit
balance of ` 758 as per pass-book.
? ILLUSTRATION 6
On 30th December, 2019 the bank column of A. Philip’s cash book showed a debit balance of ` 4,610. On
examination of the cash book and bank statement you find that:
1. Cheques amounting to ` 6,30,000 which were issued to trade payables and entered in the cash book before
30th December, 2019 were not presented for payment until that date.
2. Cheques amounting to ` 2,50,000 had been recorded in the cash book as having been paid into the bank on
30th December, 2019, but were entered in the bank statement on1st January, 2020.
3. A cheque for ` 73,000 had been dishonoured prior to 30th December, 2019, but no record of this fact
appeared in the cash book.
4. A dividend of ` 3,80,000, paid direct to the bank had not been recorded in the cash book.
5. Bank interest and charges amounting to ` 4,200 had been charged in the bank statement but not entered in
the cash book.
6. No entry had been made in the cash book for a trade subscription of ` 10,000 paid vide banker’s order in
November, 2019.
7. A cheque for ` 27,000 drawn by B. Philip had been charged to A. Philip’s bank account by mistake in December,
2019.
You are required:
(a) to make appropriate adjustments in the cash book bringing down the correct balance, and
(b) to prepare a statement reconciling the adjusted balance in the cash book with the balance shown in the
bank statement.
SOLUTION
(a) A. Philip
Dr. Cash Book (Bank column) Cr.
Particulars Amount
`
Balance per cash book 2,97,410
Add: Cheques not yet presented 6,30,000
9,27,410
Deduct: Lodgement not yet recorded by bank (2,50,000)
6,77,410
Deduct: Cheque wrongly charged (27,000)
Balance as per the bank statement 6,50,410
? ILLUSTRATION 7
From the following information, prepare a Bank reconciliation statement as at 31st December, 2019 for Messrs
New Steel Limited :
`
(1) Bank overdraft as per Cash Book on 31st December, 2019 22,45,900
(2) Interest debited by Bank on 26th December, 2019 but no advice received 2,78,700
(3) Cheque issued before 31st December, 2019 but not yet presented to Bank 6,60,000
(4) Transport subsidy received from the State Government directly by the Bank but not
advised to the company 14,25,000
(5) Draft deposited in the Bank, but not credited till 31st December, 2019 13,50,000
(6) Bills for collection credited by the Bank till 31st December, 2019 but no advice received by
the company 8,36,000
(7) Amount wrongly debited to company account by the Bank, for which no details are
available 7,40,000
SOLUTION
M/s. New Steel Ltd.
Bank Reconciliation Statement as on 31st Dec. 2019
Overdraft as per Cash Book 22,45,900
Add : Interest charged by the bank 2,78,700
Draft deposited in bank but not yet credited 13,50,000
Wrong debit by the bank, under verification 7,40,000 23,68,700
46,14,600
Less: Cheque issued but not yet presented (6,60,000)
Transport subsidy not yet recorded in the Cash Book (14,25,000)
Bills for collection credited in the bank not yet entered in the cash book (8,36,000) (29,21,000)
Overdraft as per bank statement 16,93,600
? ILLUSTRATION 8
The Cash Book of Mr. Gadbadwala shows ` 8,36,400 as the balance at Bank as on 31st December, 2019, but
you find that it does not agree with the balance as per the Bank Pass Book. On scrutiny, you find the following
discrepancies:
(1) On 15th December, 2019 the payment side of the Cash Book was undercast by `10,000.
(2) A cheque for `1,31,000 issued on 25th December, 2019 was not taken in the bank column.
(3) One deposit of `1,50,000 was recorded in the Cash Book as if there is no bank column therein.
(4) On 18th December, 2019 the debit balance of `15,260 as on the previous day, was brought forward as credit
balance.
(5) Of the total cheques amounting to `11,514 drawn in the last week of December, 2019, cheques aggregating
`7,815 were encashed in December.
(6) Dividends of `25,000 collected by the Bank and subscription of `1,000 paid by it were not recorded in the
Cash Book.
(7) One out-going Cheque of `3,50,000 was recorded twice in the Cash Book. Prepare a Reconciliation Statement.
SOLUTION
(If the books are not closed on 31st December, 2019)
Bank Reconciliation Statement of Mr. Gadbadwala as on 31st Dec., 2019
Particulars Details Amount
` `
Balance as per the Cash Book 8,36,400
Add : Mistake in bringing forward `15,260 debit balance as credit 30,520
balance on 18th Dec., 2019
Cheques issued but not presented : `
Issued 11,514
Cashed 7,815 3,699
Dividends directly collected by bank but not yet
entered in the Cash Book 25,000
Cheque recorded twice in the Cash Book 3,50,000
Deposit not recorded in the Bank column 1,50,000 5,59,219
13,95,619
Less : Wrong casting in the Cash Book on 15th Dec. 10,000
Cheques issued but not entered in the Bank column 1,31,000
Subscription paid by the bank directly not yet recorded in
the Cash Book 1,000 (1,42,000)
Balance as per the Pass Book 12,53,619
If the books are to be closed on 31st December, then adjusted cash book will be prepared as given below:
ADJUSTED CASH BOOK
Particulars Amount (`) Particulars Amount (`)
To Balance b/d 8,36,400 By wrong casting 10,000
To error for wrong posting 30,520 By cheques not entered 1,31,000
To dividends collected by bank 25,000 By subscription 1,000
To cheques recorded twice 3,50,000 By balance c/d 12,49,920
To deposit not recorded 1,50,000
13,91,920 13,91,920
Bank Reconciliation Statement
Particulars `
Balance as per the Cash Book (corrected) 12,49,920
Add: Cheques issued but not yet presented 3,699
Balance as per the Pass Book 12,53,619
? ILLUSTRATION 9
The following are the Cash Book (bank column) and Pass Book of Jain for the months of March, 2019 and April,
2019:
SOLUTION
1. On scrutiny of the debit side of the Cash Book of March 2019 and receipt side of the Pass Book of April,
2019 reveals that two cheques deposited in Bank (Goyal ` 33,000 and Patel ` 65,000) in March were not
credited by the Bank till 31/3/2019.
2. On scrutiny of the credit side of the cash book and payment side of the Pass Book reveals that a
cheque issued to Ramesh for `1,50,000 in March 2019, had not been presented for payment in Bank till
31/3/2019. Therefore the Bank Reconciliation statement on 31/3/2019 will appear as follows :
Bank Reconciliation Statement as on 31/3/2019
Particulars Amount
`
Balance as per the Cash Book 3,13,000
Add : Cheque issued but not presented for payment 1,50,000
4,63,000
Less : Cheque deposited but not credited by Bank (98,000)
Balance as per the Pass Book 3,65,000
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
BANK RECONCILIATION STATEMENT 3.25
? ILLUSTRATION 10
When Nikki & Co. received a Bank Statement showing a favourable balance of `10,39,200 for the period ended on
30th June, 2019, this did not agree with the balance in the cash book.
An examination of the Cash Book and Bank Statement disclosed the following :
1. A deposit of `3,09,200 paid on 29th June, 2019 had not been credited by the Bank until 1st July, 2019.
2. On 30th March, 2019 the company had entered into hire purchase agreement to pay by bank order a sum
of `3,00,000 on the 10th of each month, commencing from April, 2019. No entries had been made in Cash
Book.
3. A customer of the firm, who received a cash discount of 4% on his account of `4,00,000 paid the firm a cheque
on 12th June. The cashier erroneously entered the gross amount in the bank column of the Cash Book.
4. Bank charges amounting to `3,000 had not been entered in Cash-Book.
5. On 28th June, a customer of the company directly deposited the amount in the bank ` 4,00,000, but no entry
had been made in the Cash Book.
6. `11,200 paid into the bank had been entered twice in the Cash Book.
7. A debit of ` 11,00,000 appeared in the Bank Statement for an unpaid cheque, which had been returned
marked ‘out of date’. The cheque had been re-dated by the customer and paid into Bank again on 5th July,
2019.
Prepare Bank Reconciliation Statement on 30 June, 2019.
SOLUTION
Bank Reconciliation Statement on 30 June, 2019
? ILLUSTRATION 11
The bank column of cash book of Mukesh was balanced on 31st March, 2019. It showed an overdraft of ` 5,000.
This did not agree with the balance shown by bank statement of Mukesh. You are required to prepare a bank
reconciliation statement taking the following into account :
(1) Cheques issued but not presented for payment till 31.3.2019 `12,00,000.
(2) Cheques deposited but not collected by bank till 31.3.2019 ` 20,00,000.
(3) Interest on term-loan ` 10,00,000 debited by bank on 31.3.2019 but not accounted in Mukesh’s book.
(4) Bank charges ` 2,500 was debited by bank during March, 2019 but accounted in the books of Mukesh on
4.4.2019.
(5) An amount of ` 30,68,000 representing collection of Remesh’s cheque was wrongly credited to the account
of Mukesh by the bank in their bank statement.
SOLUTION
In the books of Mukesh
Bank Reconciliation Statement as on 31.3.2019
Particulars Details Amount
`
Overdraft as per the cash book 5,000
Add: Cheques deposited in bank but not collected and credited by bank 20,00,000
till 31.3.2019
Interest on term loan not accounted in books 10,00,000
Bank charges not accounted in books 2,500 30,02,500
30,07,500
Less: Cheques issued but not presented for payment till 31.3.2019 (12,00,000)
18,07,500
Less: Erroneous credit by bank to Mukesh’s account (30,68,000)
Balance as per the bank statement (12,60,500)
SUMMARY
w Bank pass book is merely a copy of the customer’s account in the book of a bank.
w Bank reconciliation statement is a statement which reconciles the bank balance as per cash book with
the balance as per bank pass book by showing all causes of difference between the two.
w The salient features of bank reconciliation statement:
ª The reconciliation will bring out any errors that may have been committed either in the cash book
or in the pass book;
ª Any undue delay in the clearance of cheques will be shown up by the reconciliation;
ª A regular reconciliation discourages the accountant of the bank from embezzlement. There have
been many cases when the cashiers merely made entries in the cash book but never deposited the
cash in the bank; they were able to get away with it only because of lack of reconciliation.
ª It helps in finding out the actual position of the bank balance.
w The difference in the balances of both the books can be because of the following reasons:
1. Timing differences,
2. Transactions;
3. Errors.
w Bank reconciliation can be start from any of the following four balances given in the question:
1. Dr. balance as per cash book
2. Cr. balance as per cash book
3. Dr. balance as per pass book
4. Cr. balance as per pass book
w There are two methods of reconciling the bank balances :
1. Bank reconciliation statement without preparation of adjusted cash-book.
2. Bank reconciliation statement after the preparation of adjusted cash-book.
12. Overcasting of credit side of the cash book shall result in a higher bank balance in cash book when
compared with pass book balance.
13. A cheque for ₹ 25,000 that was issued and was also presented for payment in same month but
erroneously recorded on debit side of the cash book would cause a difference of ₹ 50,000 from the
balance in pass book.
14. A direct debit by bank on account of any payment as may be instructed by customer should be recorded
on credit side of cash book.
15. Bank Reconciliation Statement can be prepared in two formats – “Balance” presentation and “Plus &
Minus” presentation.
16. The difference between cash book & pass book that relates to errors are those mostly made by Bank.
17. A cheque for ₹ 80,000 that was discounted from bank was dishonoured and the bank charged ₹ 1,600
as the charges on account of same. While starting with debit balance in cash book for preparing bank
reconciliation statement, we need to deduct ₹ 78,400 to reconcile with pass book.
18. Interest on savings bank that is allowed or credited by bank is generally recorded in cash book prior to
it being recorded by bank.
19. A regular bank reconciliation discourages the accountants to be involved in any kind of funds
embezzlement.
20. Timing difference relates the transactions that are recorded in the same period in both cash book and
also the bank pass book.
Multiple Choice Questions
1. When the balance as per Cash Book is the starting point, direct deposits by customers are:
(a) Added (b) Subtracted (c) Not required to be adjusted.
2. A debit balance in the depositor’s Cash Book will be shown as:
(a) A debit balance in the Bank Statement.
(b) A credit balance in the Bank Statement.
(c) An overdrawn balance in the Bank Statement.
3. When balance as per Pass Book is the starting point, interest allowed by Bank is
(a) Added (b) Subtracted (c) Not required to be adjusted.
4. A Bank Reconciliation Statement is prepared with the help of:
(a) Bank statement and bank column of the Cash Book.
(b) Bank statement and cash column of the Cash Book
(c) Bank column of the Cash Book and cash column of the Cash Book.
5. The cash book showed an overdraft of `1,50,000, but the pass book made up to the same date showed
that cheques of ` 10,000, ` 5,000 and ` 12,500 respectively had not been presented for payments; and
the cheque of ` 4,000 paid into account had not been cleared. The balance as per the pass book will be:
(a) ` 1,10,000 (b) ` 2,17,500 (c) ` 1,26,500
6. When drawing up a Bank Reconciliation Statement, if you start with a debit balance as per the Bank
Statement, the unpresented cheques should be:
(a) Added; (b) Deducted; (c) Not required to be adjusted.
7. When drawing up a BRS if you start with a Dr. Balance as per Bank Statement, the following are added:
1. Cheque issued but not presented to bank
2. B/R collected directly by bank
3. Overcasting of the Dr. Side of bank A/c in the cash book.
(a) only 1
(b) only 1& 2
(c) all of the above
(d) only 3.
Theory Questions
1. Write short note on Bank reconciliation statement.
2. State the causes of difference between the balance shown by the pass book and the cash book.
Practical Questions
Q1. From the following particulars prepare a bank reconciliation statement as on 31st December 2019:
(i) On 31st December, 2019 the cash-book of a firm showed a bank balance of ` 60,000 (debit balance).
(ii) Cheques had been issued for ` 15,00,000, out of which cheques worth ` 4,00,000 only were
presented for payment.
(iii) Cheques worth ` 11,40,000 were deposited in the bank on 28th December, 2019 but had not been
credited by the bank. In addition to this, one cheque for ` 5,00,000 was entered in the cash book on
30th December, 2019 but was banked on 3rd January, 2020.
(iv) A cheque from Susan for ` 4,00,000 was deposited in the bank on 26th December 2019 but was
dishonoured and the advice was received on 2nd January, 2020.
(v) Pass-book showed bank charges of ` 2000 debited by the bank.
(vi) One of the debtors deposited a sum of ` 5,00,000 in the bank account of the firm on 20th December,
2019 but the intimation in this respect was received from the bank on 2nd January, 2020.
(vii) Bank pass-book showed a credit balance of ` 3,82,000 on 31st December, 2019.
Q2. According to the cash-book of Gopi, there was a balance of ` 44,50,000 in his bank on 30th June, 2019.
On investigation you find that :
(i) Cheques amounting to ` 6,00,000 issued to creditors have not been presented for payment till the
date.
(ii) Cheques paid into bank amounting to ` 11,05,000 out of which cheques amounting to ` 5,50,000
only collected by the bank up to 30th June 2019.
(iii) A dividend of ` 40,000 and rent amounting to ` 6,00,000 received by the bank and entered in the
pass-book but not recorded in the cash book.
(iv) Insurance premium (up to 31st December, 2019) paid by the bank ` 27,000 not entered in the cash
book.
(v) The payment side of the cash book had been under casted by ` 5,000.
(vi) Bank charges ` 1,500 shown in the pass book had not been entered in the cash book.
(vii) A bill payable of ` 2,00,000 had been paid by the bank but was not entered in the cash book and
bill receivable for ` 60,000 had been discounted with the bank at a cost of ` 1,000 which had also
not been recorded in cash book.
Required:
(a) to make the appropriate adjustments in the cash book, and
(b) to prepare a statement reconciling it with the bank pass book.
Q3. Prepare a bank reconciliation statement as on 30th September, 2019 from the following particulars:
Particulars `
Bank balance as per pass-book 10,00,000
Cheque deposited into the bank, but no entry was passed in the cash-book 5,00,000
Cheque received, but not sent to bank 11,20,000
Credit side of the bank column cast short 2,000
Insurance premium paid directly by the bank under the standing advice 60,000
Bank charges entered twice in the cash book 2,000
Cheque issued, but not presented to the bank for payment 5,00,000
Cheque received entered twice in the cash book 10,000
Bills discounted dishonoured not recorded in the cash book. 5,00,000
Q4. Prepare a bank reconciliation statement from the following particulars on 31st March, 2019:
Particulars `
Debit balance as per bank column of the cash book 37,20,000
Cheque issued to creditors but not yet presented to the bank for payment 7,20,000
Dividend received by the bank but not yet entered in the cash book 5,00,000
Interest allowed by the bank 12,500
Cheques deposited into bank for collection but not collected by bank up to this 15,40,000
date.
Bank charges 2,000
A cheque deposited into bank was dishonoured, but no intimation received 3,20,000
Bank paid house tax on our behalf, but no information received from bank in this 3,50,000
connection.
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. False : Bank Reconciliation Statement reconciles bank column of cash book with the balance in the pass
book i.e. customer account in the books of bank.
2. True : These are the three broad categories.
3. False : Adjusting the cash book is mandatory when bank reconciliation is done at the end of the financial
year.
4. False : Debit balance as per cash book should be represented by credit or favourable balance in pass
book.
5. False : Bank charges are example of the transactions that bank carries out by itself and the same has not
been recorded in the cashbook until statement is obtained from the bank.
6. True : Overcasting is an example of an error.
7. True : Since the cheques issued would have been recorded as payments and bank balance was credited
in cash book, we need to add it back as the same is not yet deducted from our bank balance.
8. False : Bank charges should be added when we start with credit or favourable balance in pass book as
bank would have debited the charges.
9. True : Since, we don’t know the causes of difference, matching the two statements is only efficient way
to identify the difference.
10. False : Cheques deposited but not yet cleared should be subtracted from debit or unfavourable balance
in pass book.
11. True : Cheques issued but not yet presented should be added back to a debit balance in cash book to
arrive at pass book balance i.e. ₹ 50,000 + ₹ 60,000 = ₹ 1,10,000.
12. False : Overcasting of credit side means excessive payments are recorded and hence would lower the
bank balance.
13. True: ₹ 25,000 payment is recorded as a receipt and hence it will have to be adjusted twice (once to
nullify and then once to record actual payment) hence causing the difference of double amount.
14. True : It is an example of a payment instructed by customer to be directly debited by bank, and hence
credited in the cash book.
15. True : Reconciliation statement can be prepared in either of the two formats.
16. False : Bank rarely makes mistakes, and hence differences that relate to errors are generally made in cash
book.
17. False : We need to deduct 81,600 (i.e. both cheque returned & charges) from debit balance in cash
book to arrive at balance as per pass book.
18. False : Interest allowed by bank is mostly recorded in cash book after the entry has been made in the
pass book or bank statement.
19. True : In absence of any reconciliation, the accountants can mis-utilize the funds temporarily by
recording the entry without actual depositing the cash.
20. False : Timing differences relate to the transactions that are recorded in cash book and pass book in two
different periods.
MCQs
Theoretical Questions
1. Bank reconciliation statement is prepared as on a particular date to reconcile and explain the causes
of difference between the bank balance as per cash book and the same as per savings bank pass book
or current account statement. At the end of each month, the bank balance as per cash book and that
as per pass book /bank statement should be compared and, if there is disagreement, these balances
should be reconciled stating exact reasons of disagreement. The reconciliation is made in a statement
called the bank reconciliation statement.
2. The difference between the balance shown by the passbook and the cashbook may arise on account of
the following:
(i) Cheques issued but not yet presented for payment.
(ii) Cheques deposited into the bank but not yet cleared.
(iii) Interest allowed by the bank.
(iv) Interest and expenses charged by the bank.
(v) Interest and dividends collected by the bank.
(vi) Direct payments by the bank.
(vii) Direct deposits into the bank by a customer.
(viii) Dishonour of a bill discounted with the bank.
(ix) Bills collected by the bank on behalf of the customer.
(x) An error committed in cash book or by the bank etc.
(xi) Undercasting or Overcasting in cashbook.
Practical Questions
Answer 1
Bank Reconciliation Statement
as on 31st December, 2019
` `
Bank balance (Dr.) as per cash book 60,000
Add: Cheques issued but not yet presented for payment 11,00,000
Cheques directly deposited by a customer not yet recorded in cash 5,00,000 16,00,000
book
16,60,000
Less: Cheques deposited but not yet credited by bank 11,40,000
Cheque received and recorded in cash book but not yet banked 5,00,000
Cheque dishonoured by the bank; the dishonour entry not yet passed 4,00,000
in cash book
Bank charges not recorded in cash book 2,000 (20,42,000)
Bank balance (Dr.) as per pass book (3,82,000)
Answer 2
Cash Book (Bank Column)
Receipts ` Payments `
To Balance b/d 44,50,000 By Insurance premium A/c 27,000
To Dividend A/c 40,000 By Correction of errors 5,000
To Rent A/c 6,00,000 By Bank charges 1,500
To Bill receivable A/c 59,000 By Bill payable 2,00,000
By Balance c/d 49,15,500
51,49,000 51,49,000
Bank Reconciliation Statement
as on 30th June, 2019
`
Adjusted balance as per cash book (Dr.) 49,15,500
Add: Cheques issued but not presented for payment till 30th June, 2019 6,00,000
Less: Cheques paid into bank for collection but not collected till 30th June, 2019 (5,55,000)
Balance as per pass book 49,60,500
Answer 3
Bank Reconciliation Statement as on 30th September, 2019
` `
Bank balance as per pass book 10,00,000
Add: Cheque received but not sent to the bank 11,20,000
Credit side of the bank column cast short 2,000
Insurance premium paid directly not recorded in the cash book 60,000
Cheque received entered twice in the cash book 10,000
Bills dishonoured not recorded in the cash book 5,00,000 16,92,000
26,92,000
Less: Cheque deposited into the bank but no entry was passed in the cash 5,00,000
book
Bank charges recorded twice in the cash book 2,000
Cheque issued but not presented to the bank 5,00,000 (10,02,000)
Bank balance as per cash book 16,90,000
Answer 4
Bank Reconciliation Statement
as on 31st March, 2019
` `
Debit balance as per cash book 37,20,000
Add: Cheque issued but not yet presented to bank for payment 7,20,000
Dividend received by bank not entered in cash book 5,00,000
Interest allowed by bank 12,500 12,32,500
49,52,500
Less: Cheques deposited into bank but not yet collected 15,40,000
Bank charges 2,000
A cheque deposited into bank was dishonoured 3,20,000
House tax paid by bank 3,50,000 (22,12,000)
Credit balance as per pass book 27,40,500
Type of Inventory
CHAPTER
OVERVIEW
In case of
Manufacturing In case of Trading
concerns concerns
Inventory, Inventory
not ordinarily ordinarily Adjusted Selling
interchangeable interchangeable Price
Weighted
FIFO LIFO Average Price
Whichever is
less
1. MEANING
Inventory can be defined as assets held
w for sale in the ordinary course of business, or
w in the process of production for such sale, or
w for consumption in the production of goods or services for sale, including maintenance supplies and
consumables other than machinery spares, servicing equipment and standby equipment.
There can be different types of inventory based on nature of business of an enterprise. The inventories of
a trading concern consist primarily of products purchased for resale in their existing form. It may also have
an inventory of supplies such as wrapping paper, cartons, and stationery. The inventories of manufacturing
concern consist of several types of inventories: raw material (which will become part of the goods to
be produced), work-in-process (partially completed products in the factory) and finished products. In
manufacturing concerns inventories will also include maintenance supplies, consumables, loose tools and
spare parts. However, inventories do not include spare parts, servicing equipment and standby equipment
which can be used only in connection with an item of fixed asset and whose use is expected to be irregular;
such machinery spares are generally accounted for as fixed assets. Similarly, in an enterprise engaged in
construction business, projects under construction are also considered as inventory.
At the year-end every business entity needs to ascertain the closing balance of Inventory which comprise
of Inventory of raw material, work-in-progress, finished goods and other consumable items. Value of closing
Inventory is put at the credit side of the Trading Account and asset side of the Balance Sheet. So, before
preparation of final accounts, the accountant should know the value of Inventory of the business entity.
However, we shall restrict our discussion on inventory valuation of a manufacturing concern and goods of
a trading concern.
2. INVENTORY VALUATION
A primary issue in accounting for inventories is the determination of the value at which inventories are
carried in the financial statements until the related revenues are recognized. Inventory is generally the
most significant component of the current assets held by a trading or manufacturing enterprise. It is widely
recognized that inventory is one of the major assets that affects efficiency of operations. Both excess of
inventory and its shortage affects the production activity, and the profitability of the enterprise whether
it is a manufacturing or a trading business. Proper valuation of inventory has a very significant bearing on
the authenticity of the financial statements. The significance of inventory valuation arises due to various
reasons as explained in the following points:
The common classification of inventories are raw materials; work-in-progress; finished goods; stores-in-
trade (in respect of goods acquired for trading) and spares and loose tools.
Cost of purchase consist of purchase price including duties and taxes (other than those subsequently
recoverable by the enterprise from the taxing authorities), freight inwards and other expenditure directly
attributable to the acquisition. Trade discounts, rebates, duty drawbacks and other similar items are deducted
in determining costs of purchase. In other words, cost includes any amount paid to the seller reduced by
any discounts/rebates given by the seller. Similarly, any duties paid to the supplier will be part of cost of the
inventory unless the enterprises can recover these taxes duties from the authorities.
Costs of conversion of inventories include costs directly related to the units of production, such as direct
labour. They also include a systematic allocation of fixed and variable overheads.
Other Costs may include administrative overheads incurred to bring the inventory into present location
and condition or any cost specifically incurred on inventory of a specified customer. Interest and other
borrowing costs are generally not included in the cost of inventory. However, in some circumstances where
production process is longer and it is required to carry inventory for a long period e.g. wine, rice and timber
it may be appropriate to consider interest and other borrowing cost also part of cost of inventory.
Exclusions from cost of inventories: Following expenses are generally not included in the costs of
inventories:
(a) abnormal amounts of wasted materials, labour or other production overheads;
(b) storage costs, unless those costs are necessary in the production process prior to further production
stage;
(c) administrative overheads that do not contribute to bringing the inventories to their present location
and condition; and
(d) selling and distribution costs
Net realizable value: This is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business less the estimated
costs of completion and the estimated costs necessary to make the sale. In case of finished goods and
traded goods Net realizable value will generally mean selling price which reduced by selling and distribution
expenses. In case of work in progress, expenses and overheads required to be incurred to convert work -In
progress into finished goods and making it ready for sale will also be reduced from selling price. In case of
raw materials, replacement cost is generally considered as net realizable value.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
INVENTORIES 4.5
An assessment is made of as at each balance sheet date. Inventories are usually written down to net realizable
value on an item-by-item basis. In some circumstances, however, it may be appropriate to group similar or
related items e.g. in case of interchangeable items it may not be possible to identify cost and net realizable
value of each item separately.
Opening inventory (known) + Purchases during the period (known) – Cost of Goods Sold (known) = Closing
Inventory (balancing figure)
Perpetual inventory system helps to overcome the limitations of periodic system. As inventory is taken as
residual figure, it includes loss of goods. However, the main limiting factor is the cost of using this system.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Surekha Ltd deals in 3 products P, Q & R, which are neither similar nor interchangeable. At the end of a financial
year, the Historical Cost and NRV of items of Closing Stock are given below. Determine the value of Closing Stock.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
INVENTORIES 4.7
? ILLUSTRATION 2
A manufacturer has the following record of purchases of a condenser, which he uses while manufacturing radio
sets:
Date Quantity (units) Price per unit
Dec. 4 900 50
Dec. 10 400 55
Dec. 11 300 55
Dec. 19 200 60
Dec. 28 800 47
2,600
1,600 units were issued during the month of December till 18th December.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
4.8 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
SOLUTION
The closing inventory is 1,000 units and would consist of:
800 units received on 28th December; and
200 units received on 19th December as per FIFO
`
The value of 800 units @ ` 47 37,600
The value of 200 units @ ` 60 12,000
Total 49,600
? ILLUSTRATION 3
In the previous example assume that following issues were made during the month of December:
Record of issues
SOLUTION
Computation of closing stock under perpetual inventory system
Using LIFO method, following will be stock ledger:
In the above example, if the entity followed periodic inventory valuation, closing inventory of 1,000 pcs. will
be valued as follows:
800 pcs. @ ` 47 each (purchased on Dec. 28th) = ` 37,600
200 pcs. @ ` 60 each (purchased on Dec. 19th) = ` 12,000
Total 1,000 pcs. = ` 49,600
We can see that cost of closing inventory has changed following LIFO method based on perpetual inventory
method and periodic inventory method.
"LIFO method is based on an irrational assumption that inventories entering last in the stores are issued or
consumed first. However, the flow of goods which is generally observed in business entities is contradictory
to this assumption. It should be noted that while applying LIFO, there will be difference in cost of goods
sold and value of closing inventory, if the entity follows periodic as against perpetual method of inventory
valuation. (Periodic and Perpetual methods have been explained later in this chapter). Therefore, LIFO
method is no longer adopted for valuing inventories. Accounting Standards also does not permit the usage
of LIFO Method. Generally, in practice, FIFO and Weighted Average Price Method are popular among the
business entities and both these methods are also permitted by Accounting Standards."
(iv) Simple Average Price Method
Simple Average price for computing value of inventory is a very simple approach. All the different prices are
added together and then divided by the number of prices. The closing inventory is then valued according to
the price ascertained. This method is generally followed by the entities using periodic inventory method as
it does not require efforts of identifying that closing inventory belongs to which consignments or lots. add
the text here before "Simple Average Price Method"
? ILLUSTRATION 4
In the same example of a manufacturer of radio sets given earlier, let us calculate the value of closing inventory
using Average Price Method:
SOLUTION
The simple average in this question is:
Thus, we see that value of inventories changes based on different cost formula used.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
INVENTORIES 4.11
Closing inventory = No. of units in inventory × Weighted average price per unit
Cost of goods sold = No. of units sold × Weighted average price per unit.
? ILLUSTRATION 5
On the basis of the data given in illustration 2 and 3, calculate the weighted average price and also the value of
closing inventory by weighted average price method.
SOLUTION
The computation of weighted average price in the referred example is shown below:
A new average rate would be calculated on receiving a fresh consignment. Answer on that basis would be
as under:
Perpetual and Periodic Inventory System and Average Methods of Cost of Inventory
Both Simple Average Method and Weighted Average Method are applied differently in case the entity uses
periodic inventory taking or Perpetual inventory taking. In case of periodic inventory taking inventory
available for sale during the period is considered together and an average rate is computed and closing
inventory is valued using that rate. In case perpetual inventory records are maintained average rate of
inventory is computed on each new purchase and next issue is recorded using new average rate.
Illustration 5 above is an example of Weighted average method used in perpetual inventory recording
system. In case the entity would have been using periodic inventory recording system, closing inventory
would have been valued as below:
Accordingly, closing stock of 1,000 pcs. would have been valued at 51,190 @ ` 51.19 per unit.
? ILLUSTRATION 6
M/s X, Y and Z are in retail business, following information are obtained from their records for the year
ended 31st March, 2020:
Find out the historical cost of inventories using adjusted selling price method.
SOLUTION
15,28,235
Add: Sales Tax 11% ` 1,68,106
` 16,96,341
Add: Packaging and transportation charges ` 87,500
` 17,83,841
Inventory valuation:
` 1,68,988
? ILLUSTRATION 7
From the following information, calculate the historical cost of inventories using adjusted selling price method:
`
Sales during the year 2,00,000
Cost of purchases 2,00,000
Opening inventory Nil
Closing inventory at selling price 50,000
SOLUTION
6. INVENTORIES TAKING
Normally all operations are suspended for one or two days during the financial year and physical
inventory is taken for everything in the godown or the store periodically. For the year-end inventory
valuation, physical inventory taking is done during the last week of the financial year or during the first
week of next financial year. If inventory taking is finished on 26th March, whereas accounting year ends
on 31st March purchases and sales between 26th and 31st March are then separately adjusted. Later,
a value is put on each item. The principle of cost or Net realizable value, whichever is lower, is applied
either for the inventory as a whole or item by item.
Normally, enterprises prefer to perform inventory taking closing day, however, sometimes inventory
taking cannot be carried out on the closing day. It is carried out a few days later or sometimes even a
few days earlier. In such a case, the actual value of the inventory must be so adjusted as to relate it to
the end of the year concerned. For doing so, it will be necessary to take into account the goods that
have come in (purchases and sales returns) and those that have gone out (sales and purchase returns)
during the interval between the close of the year and the date of actual inventory taking. Further, the
adjustment of all goods must be on the basis of cost. Suppose, a firm that closes its books on 31st
December, carried out the inventory taking on the 7th January next year and actual inventory was of
the cost of ` 7,85,000, during the period January 1 to 7 purchases were ` 1,53,000 and sales ` 2,50,000,
the mark up being 25% on cost. The inventory on 31st December would be ` 8,32,000 as shown below:
`
Inventory ascertained on January 7 7,85,000
Less: Purchases during the period Jan. 1 to 7 1,53,000
6,32,000
? ILLUSTRATION 8
From the following particulars ascertain the value of Inventories as on 31st March, 2020:
`
Inventory as on 1.4.2019 1,42,500
Purchases 7,62,500
Manufacturing Expenses 1,50,000
Selling Expenses 60,500
Administrative Expenses 30,000
Financial Charges 21,500
Sales 12,45,000
At the time of valuing inventory as on 31st March, 2019, a sum of ` 17,500 was written off on a particular
item, which was originally purchased for ` 50,000 and was sold during the year for ` 45,000. Barring the
transaction relating to this item, the gross profit earned during the year was 20 percent on sales.
SOLUTION
` `
Inventory as on 1st April, 2019 1,42,500
Less: Book value of abnormal inventory
(` 50,000 - ` 17,500) 32,500 1,10,000
Add: Purchases 7,62,500
Manufacturing Expenses 1,50,000
10,22,500
Less: Cost of goods sold:
Sales as per books 12,45,000
Less: Sales of abnormal item 45,000
12,00,000
Less: Gross Profit @ 20% 2,40,000 9,60,000
Inventory in trade as on 31st March, 2020 62,500
? ILLUSTRATION 9
A trader prepared his accounts on 31st March, each year. Due to some unavoidable reasons, no inventory
taking could be possible till 15th April, 2020 on which date the total cost of goods in his godown came to
` 5,00,000. The following facts were established between 31st March and 15th April, 2020.
You are required to ascertain the value of inventory as on 31st March, 2020.
SOLUTION
Statement of valuation of Inventory on 31st March, 2020
` `
Value of Inventory as on 15th April, 2020 5,00,000
Add: Cost of goods sold during the period between
31st March, 2020 to 15th April, 2020
Sales (` 4,10,000 - ` 10,000) 4,00,000
Less: Gross Profit (20% of ` 4,00,000) 80,000 3,20,000
8,20,000
Less: Purchases during the period from
31st March, 2020 to 15th April, 2020 50,340
7,69,660
? ILLUSTRATION 10
Inventory taking for the year ended 31st March, 2020 was completed by 10th April 2020, the valuation of
which showed a inventory figure of ` 16,75,000 at cost as on the completion date. After the end of the
accounting year and till the date of completion of inventory taking, sales for the next year were made for
` 68,750, profit margin being 33.33 percent on cost. Purchases for the next year included in the inventory
amounted to ` 90,000 at cost less trade discount 10 percent. During this period, goods were added to
inventory at the mark up price of ` 3,000 in respect of sales returns. After inventory taking it was found that
there were certain very old slow-moving items costing ` 11,250, which should be taken at ` 5,250 to ensure
disposal to an interested customer. Due to heavy flood, certain goods costing ` 15,500 were received from
the supplier beyond the delivery date of customer. As a result, the customer refused to take delivery and net
realizable value of the goods was estimated to be ` 12,500 on 31st March. Compute the value of inventory
for inclusion in the final accounts for the year ended 30th March, 2020.
SOLUTION
? ILLUSTRATION 11
Find out the value of Inventory as on 31-3-2020 if the company follows First in first out basis.
SOLUTION
? ILLUSTRATION 12
Find out the value of Inventory as on 31-3-2020 if the company follows Weighted Average basis.
SOLUTION
SUMMARY
• Inventory can be defined as assets held for sale in the ordinary course of business, or in the process of
production for such sale, or for consumption in the production of goods or services for sale, including
maintenance supplies and consumables other than machinery spares.
• The inventories of manufacturing concern consist of several types of inventories: raw material (which
will become part of the goods to be produced), parts and factory supplies, work-in-process (partially
completed products in the factory) and, of course, finished products.
• Proper valuation of inventory has a very significant bearing on the authenticity of the financial
statements.
• Cost of goods sold is calculated as follows:
Cost of goods sold = Opening Inventory + Purchases + Direct expenses - Closing Inventory.
• Inventories should be generally valued at the lower of cost or net realizable value.
• Inventory Valuation Techniques:
Historical Cost Methods
Specific Identification Method
FIFO (First in first out) Method
LIFO (Last in first out) Method
Average Price Method
Weighted Average Price Method
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
4.20 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
MCQs
1. The amount of purchase if
Cost of goods sold is ` 80,700
Opening Inventory ` 5,800
Closing Inventory ` 6,000
(a) ` 80,500 (b) ` 74,900 (c) ` 80,900.
2. Average Inventory = ` 12,000. Closing Inventory is ` 3,000 more than opening Inventory. The value
of closing Inventory = ______.
(a) ` 12,000 (b) ` 24,000 (c) ` 13,500.
3. While finalizing the current year’s profit, the company realized that there was an error in the valuation
of closing Inventory of the previous year. In the previous year, closing Inventory was valued more by
` 50,000. As a result
(a) Previous year’s profit is overstated and current year’s profit is also overstated
(b) Previous year’s profit is overstated and current year’s profit is understated
(c) Previous year’s profit is understated and current year’s profit is also understated
4. Consider the following for Q Co. for the year 2019-20:
Cost of goods available for sale ` 1,00,000
Total sales ` 80,000
Opening inventory of goods ` 20,000
Gross profit margin on sales 25%
Closing inventory of goods for the year 2019-20 as
Theory Questions
1. Write short notes on:
(i) Adjusted Selling Price method of determining cost of stock.
(ii) Principal methods of ascertainment of cost of inventory.
2. Distinguish between:
(i) LIFO and FIFO basis of costing of stock.
(ii) FIFO and weighted average price method of stock costing.
3. Define inventory. Explain the importance of proper valuation of inventory in the preparation of statements
of the business entity.
Practical Questions
1. X who was closing his books on 31.3.2020 failed to take the actual stock which he did only on 9th April,
2020, when it was ascertained by him to be worth ` 2,50,000.
It was found that sales are entered in the sales book on the same day of dispatch and return
inwards in the returns book as and when the goods are received back. Purchases are entered in the
purchases day book once the invoices are received.
It was found that sales between 31.3.2020 and 9.4.2020 as per the sales day book are ` 17,200.
Purchases between 31.3.2020 and 9.4.2020 as per purchases day book are ` 1,200, out of these
goods amounting to ` 500 were not received until after the stock was taken.
Goods invoiced during the month of March, 2020 but goods received only on 4th April, 2020
amounted to ` 1,000. Rate of gross profit is 33-1/3% on cost.
Ascertain the value of physical stock as on 31.3.2020.
2. From the following information, ascertain the value of stock as on 31.3.2020:
`
Value of stock on 1.4.2019 7,00,000
Purchases during the period from 1.4.2019 to 31.3.2020 34,60,000
Manufacturing expenses during the above period 7,00,000
Sales during the same period 52,20,000
At the time of valuing stock on 31.3.2019 a sum of ` 60,000 was written off a particular item which
was originally purchased for ` 2,00,000 and was sold for ` 1,60,000. But for the above transaction
the gross profit earned during the year was 25% on cost.
3. The Profit and loss account of Hanuman showed a net profit of ` 6,00,000, after considering the closing
stock of ` 3,75,000 on 31st March, 2020. Subsequently the following information was obtained from
scrutiny of the books:
(i) Purchases for the year included ` 15,000 paid for new electric fittings for the shop.
(ii) Hanuman gave away goods valued at ` 40,000 as free samples for which no entry was made in the
books of accounts.
(iii) Invoices for goods amounting to ` 2,50,000 have been entered on 27th March, 2020, but the
goods were not included in stock.
(iv) In March, 2020 goods of ` 2,00,000 sold and delivered were taken in the sales for April, 2020.
(v) Goods costing ` 75,000 were sent on sale or return in March, 2020 at a margin of profit of 33-1/3%
on cost. Though approval was given in April, 2020 these were taken as sales for March, 2020.
Calculate the value of stock on 31st March, 2020 and the adjusted net profit for the year ended on that
date.
4. Physical verification of stock in a business was done on 23rd June, 2020. The value of the stock was
` 48,00,000. The following transactions took place between 23rd June to 30th June, 2020:
(i) Out of the goods sent on consignment, goods at cost worth ` 2,40,000 were unsold.
(ii) Purchases of ` 4,00,000 were made out of which goods worth ` 1,60,000 were delivered on 5th
July, 2020.
(iii) Sales were ` 13,60,000, which include goods worth ` 3,20,000 sent on approval. Half of these
goods were returned before 30th June, 2020, but no information is available regarding the
remaining goods.
(iv) Goods are sold at cost plus 25%. However goods costing ` 2,40,000 had been sold for ` 1,20,000.
Determine the value of stock on 30th June, 2020.
ANSWERS / HINTS
True and False
1. True: Inventories refers to stocks of goods and materials that are maintained in business for revenue
generation.
2. True: For a construction business a building under construction will be inventory. The building is being
built in the normal course of business and will eventually be sold as well as inventory.
3. False: Inventory is valued at lower of cost or net realizable value.
4. False: Under Perpetual Inventory System management have daily information of closing stock.
5. True: A periodic inventory system is suitable to small and micro enterprises, where physical counting of
inventory is not a tedious process.
6. False: When closing inventory is overstated, net income for the accounting period will be overstated.
7. False: Closing stock = Cost of goods sold - (Opening inventory + Purchases + Direct expenses).
8. False: Cost of inventories should comprise all cost of purchase, costs of conversion and other costs
incurred in bringing the inventories to their present location and condition.
9. False: Costs of conversion of inventories include costs directly related to the units of production. They
also include a systematic allocation of fixed and variable overheads.
10. False: Abnormal amounts of wasted materials, labour or other production overheads expenses are
generally not included in the costs of inventories.
11. False: Periodic system requires closure of business for counting of inventory.
12. True: Under Periodic inventory system actual physical count of inventory is taken of all the inventory on
hand at a particular date.
13. True: Value of Closing stock as per average method is more realistic then LIFO.
14. False: The value of stock is shown on the assets side of the balance-sheet as current assets.. As it is
realisable within 12 months.
15. False: Under inflationary conditions, LIFO and weighted average will not show lowest value of cost of
goods sold.
16. False: Under FIFO, valuation of inventory is based on the assumption that costs are charged against
revenue in the order in which they occur.
17. True: The conservatism concept states that one shall not account for anticipated profits but shall provide
all prospective losses. Valuing inventory at cost or net realisable value whichever is less, therefore is
based on principle of Conservatism.
18. False: Finished goods are normally valued at cost or market price whichever is lower.
MCQs
2 (i) Under FIFO method of inventory valuation, inventories purchased first are issued first. The closing
inventories are valued at latest purchase prices and inventory issues are valued at corresponding old
purchase prices. In other words, under FIFO method, costs are assigned to the units issued in the same
order as the costs entered in the inventory. During periods of rising prices, cost of goods sold are valued
at older and lower prices if FIFO is followed and consequently reported profits rise due to lower cost of
goods sold.
On the other hand, under LIFO method of inventory valuation, units of inventories issued should
be valued at the prices paid for the latest purchases and closing inventories should be valued at
the prices paid for earlier purchases. In other words, closing inventories are valued at old purchase
prices and issues are valued at corresponding latest purchase prices.
2 (ii) Under the First-In-First-Out (FIFO) method of valuation of stock, the actual issue of goods is usually
the earliest lot on hand. Hence, the stock in hand will therefore consist of the latest consignments. The
closing stock is valued at the price paid for such consignments.
The weighted average price method is not a simple average price method. Under this method of
valuation of stock, a stock ledger is maintained, recording receipts and issues on daily basis. A new
average would be calculated on receiving fresh consignment. The average price thus calculated
after considering arrival of new consignment with the previous value of stock and dividing the
preceding stock value and the cost of new arrival with the total units of preceding and new arrival
will give the weighted average price.
3. Inventory can be defined as assets held
w for sale in the ordinary course of business, or
w in the process of production for such sale, or
w for consumption in the production of goods or services for sale, including maintenance
supplies and consumables other than machinery spares.
The significance of inventory valuation arises due to the following reasons:
(i) Determination of Income
(ii) Ascertainment of Financial Position
(iii) Liquidity Analysis
(iv) Statutory Compliance
Practical Questions
Answer 1
Statement of Valuation of Physical Stock as on 31st March, 2020
`
Value of stock as on 9th April, 2020 2,50,000
Add: Cost of sales during the intervening period
Sales made between 31.32020 and 9.4.2020 17,200
Less: Gross profit @25% on sales (4,300) 12,900
2,62,900
Less: Purchases actually received during the intervening period:
Purchases from 1.4.2020 to 9.4.2020 1,200
Less: Goods not received upto 9.4.2020 (500) 700
2,62,200
Less: Purchases during March, 2020 received on 4.4.2020 1,000
Value of physical stock as on 31.3.2020 2,61,200
Answer 2
Statement of Valuation of Stock as on 31st March, 2020
`
Value of stock as on 1st April, 2019 7,00,000
Add: Purchases during the period from 1.4.2019 to 31.3.2020 34,60,000
Add: Manufacturing expenses during the above period 7,00,000
48,60,000
Less: Cost of sales during the period:
Sales 52,20,000
Less: Gross profit 10,32,000 41,88,000
Value of stock as on 31.3.2020 6,72,000
Working Note:
`
Calculation of gross profit:
Gross profit on normal sales 20/100 x (52,20,000 -1,60,000) 10,12,000
Gross profit on the particular (abnormal) item 1,60,000 - (2,00,000 - 60,000) 20,000
10,32,000
Note: The value of closing stock on 31st March, 2020 may, alternatively, be found out by preparing
Trading Account for the year ended 31st March, 2020.
Answer 3
Profit and Loss Adjustment Account
Dr. Cr.
` `
To Advertisement (samples) 40,000 By Net profit 6,00,000
To Sales (goods approved in April to be 1,00,000 By Electric fittings 15,000
taken as April sales: 7,500 + 2,500)
By Samples 40,000
By Stock (purchases of 2,50,000
March not included in
To Adjusted net profit 10,40,000 stock)
By Sales (goods sold in 2,00,000
March wrongly taken
as April sales)
By Stock (goods sent 75,000
on approval basis not
included in stock)
_______ _______
11,80,000 11,80,000
Answer 4
Statement of Valuation of Stock on 30th June, 2020
`
Value of stock as on 23rd June, 2020 48,00,000
Add: Unsold stock out of the goods sent on consignment 2,40,000
Purchases during the period from 23rd June, 2020 to 30th June, 2,40,000
2020
Goods in transit on 30th June, 2020 1,60,000
Cost of goods sent on approval basis (80% of ` 1,60,000) 1,28,000 7,68,000
55,68,000
Less: Cost of sales during the period from 23rd June, 2020 to
30th June, 2020
Sales (` 13,60,000 - ` 1,60,000) 12,00,000
Less: Gross profit 96,000
11,04,000
Value of stock as on 30th June, 2020 44,64,000
Working Notes:
To present To accumulate
To ascertain true and fair To ascertain
funds for the
true results view of the true cost
replacement
of operations financial of production
of assets
position
Expected Estimated
Cost of asset useful life residual
and utility value
1. INTRODUCTION
1.1 Concept of Depreciation
Property, plant and equipment are tangible items that:
(a) are held for use in the production or supply of goods or services, for rental to others, or for
administrative purposes; and
(b) are expected to be used during more than a period of twelve months.
These are also called fixed assets in common parlance. When a fixed asset is purchased, it is recorded in
books of account at it original or acquisition/purchase cost. However fixed assets are used to earn revenues
for a number of accounting periods in future with the same acquisition cost until the concerned fixed asset
is sold or discarded. It is therefore necessary that a part of the acquisition cost of the fixed assets is treated or
allocated as an expense in each of the accounting period in which the asset is utilized. The amount or value
of fixed assets allocated in such manner to respective accounting period is called depreciation. Value of such
assets decreases with passage of time mainly due to following reasons.
Depreciation of an asset begins when it is available for use, i.e., when it is in the location and condition
necessary for it to be capable of operating in the manner intended by management. Thus it is not necessary
that an asset must be used to be depreciated. There is decrease in value of assets due to normal wear and
tear even when these are not physically used. Accordingly, value of such wear and tear should be estimated
and accounted for.
Depreciation is allocated so as to charge a fair proportion of the depreciable amount in each accounting
period during the expected useful life of the asset. Depreciation for a period helps to charge that portion of
the cost of the asset against the revenues earned, which is expired for that period and hence follows matching
principle. In other words the total cost of the asset is reflected in form of a) Expired cost (depreciation) and
b) Unexpired Cost which shall be the written down value of the asset being reflected in balance sheet. Also
charging depreciation every year reduces the distributable profits and hence ensuring the availability of
funds whenever the replacement is required.
The depreciation is type of loss in the value of assets employed for carrying on a business. Being an essential
element of business expenditure, it is necessary to calculate the amount of such loss and to make a provision,
and therefore, arrive at the amount of profit or loss made by the business.
Basically, the cost of an asset used for purpose of business has to be written off over its economic (not
physical) life which must be estimated. A point to remember is that usually, at the end of the economic life,
an asset has some value as scrap or otherwise. The amount to be written off in each year should be as such
which will reduce the book value of the asset, at the end of its economic life, to its estimated scrap value.
1.2 Depreciation on components of an assets
It may be noted that Accounting Standards as well as the Companies Act, 2013 requires depreciation to
be charged on a component basis. Each part of an item of Property, Plant and Equipment with a cost
that is significant in relation to the total cost of the item should be depreciated separately. An enterprise
should allocate the amount initially recognised in respect of an item of property, plant and equipment to
its significant parts/components and should depreciate each such part separately based on the useful life
and residual value of each particular component. For Example- Aircraft is a classic example of such an asset.
The airframe (i.e. the body of the aircraft), the engines and the interiors have different individual useful lives.
If the life of the airframe (being the longest of the individual lives of the three major types of components)
is taken as the life of the aircraft, it is important that other two major components i.e. engine and interiors
are depreciated over their respective useful life and not over the life of airframe. Other components (usually
small and low value) which will require replacement very frequently may be depreciated over the useful
life of airframe and their frequent replacement cost may be charged to expense as and when it is incurred.
Here it is important to note that a part of Property, Plant & Equipment to be identified as a separate
component should have both
(a) significant cost when compared to overall cost of item of property, plant and equipment and
(b) and estimated useful life or depreciation method different from rest of the parts of the property
plant and equipment.
A significant part of an item of property, plant and equipment may have a useful life and a depreciation
method that are the same as the useful life and the depreciation method of another significant part of that
same item. Such parts may be grouped in determining the depreciation charge.
(2) True position statement: Value of the Property, Plant & Equipment should be adjusted for depreciation
charged in order to depict the actual financial position. In case depreciation is not accounted for
appropriately, the property, plant and equipment would be disclosed in financial statements at a value
higher than their true value. Whereas we should always present the same at its unexpired cost which is
after charging the expired cost as depreciation.
(3) Funds for replacement: Generation of adequate funds in the hands of the business for replacement of
the asset at the end of its useful life. Depreciation is a good indication of the amount an enterprise
should set aside to replace a fixed asset after its economic useful life is over. However, the replacement
cost of a fixed asset may be impacted by inflation or other technological changes.
(4) Ascertainment of true cost of production: For ascertaining the cost of the production, it is necessary to
charge depreciation as an item of cost of production.
Further depreciation is a non-cash expense and unlike other normal expenditure (e.g. wages, rent, etc.) does
not result in any cash outflow. Further depreciation by itself does not create funds it merely draws attention
to the fact that out of gross revenue receipts, a certain amount should be retained for replacement of assets
used for carrying on operation which is achieved by charging depreciation that reduces the distributable
profits.
Depreciable amount
Depreciation = i.e. ` 1,00,000/ 5 = ` 20,000 per year
Estimated useful life
Thus all the expenses which are necessary for asset to bring it in condition and location of desired used will
become part of cost of the asset. However, following expenses should not become part of cost of asset:
(a) costs of opening new facility or business, such as inauguration costs;
(b) cost of introducing new product or service (for example cost of advertisement or promotional
activities).
(c) cost of conducting business in a new location or with a new class of customer (including cost of
staff training); and
(d) administration and other general overhead costs.
Once an asset has been brought to its intended condition and location of use, no cost should recognized as
part of cost of the asset unless there is major repair or addition which increases the useful life of the asset
or improves the production capacity of the asset. Accordingly, cost incurred while and item is capable of
operating in intended manner but it is not yet put to use or is used at less than full capacity should not be
capitalized as part of cost of the asset. Similarly, cost of relocation of an asset should not be capitalized.
Any additions made to a particular item of property, plant and equipment after it is initially put to use are
depreciated over the remaining useful life of the asset. Any addition or extension which has a separate identity
and is capable of being used after the existing asset is disposed of, is accounted for separately. Therefore,
it is important to maintain an asset register capturing asset wise details of cost, rate of depreciation, date
of capitalization etc. All these details need to be captured for any additions to existing assets as well. In the
absence of the adequate information, it will be very difficult to compute depreciation expense year on year.
Also, at the time of disposal or discard of a particular asset, it will not be possible to compute gain or loss on
such disposal/discard.
Methods of Depreciation
Results in a constant
charge over the useful Results in a decreasing Results in a charge based
life if the residual value charge over the useful on the expected use or
of the asset does not life output
change
The Income Tax Rules, however, prescribe the Diminishing Balance Method except in the case of assets of an
undertaking engaged in generation and distribution of power.
3.1 Straight Line Method
According to this method, an equal amount is written off every year during the working life of an asset so
as to reduce the cost of the asset to nil or its residual value at the end of its useful life. The advantage of this
method is that it is simple to apply and gives accurate results especially in case of leases, and also in case of
plant and machinery. This method is also known as Fixed Instalment Method.
Cost of Asset – Scrap Value
Straight Line Depreciation =
Useful life
The underlying assumption of this method is that the particular tangible asset generates equal utility
during its lifetime. But this cannot be true under all circumstances. The expenditure incurred on repairs and
maintenance will be low in earlier years, whereas the same will be high as the asset becomes old. Apart
from this the asset may also have varying capacities over the years, indicating logic for unequal depreciation
provision. However, many assets have insignificant repairs and maintenance expenditures for which straight
line method can be applied.
While using this method the period of use of an asset in a particular year should also be considered. In
the year of purchase of an asset it may have been available for use for part of the year only, accordingly
depreciation should be proportioned to reflect the period for which it was available for use. For example,
if an asset was purchased on March 1, 2017 and the enterprise prepares financial statements for the year
ending on March 31, 2017 depreciation will be provided for a period of 1 month only. Similar situation
will arise in the year in which an asset is retired from its intended used or is sold. However, under income
tax rules depreciation is provided for full year if the asset was used for more than 180 days in a particular
financial year.
3.2 Reducing or Diminishing Balance Method or Written Down Value (WDV) Method
Under this system, a fixed percentage of the diminishing value of the asset is written off each year so as
to reduce the asset to its residual value at the end of its life. Repairs and small renewals are charged to
revenue. This method is commonly used for plant, fixtures, etc. Under this method, the annual charge for
depreciation decreases from year to year, so that the earlier years suffer to the benefit of the later years.
Also, under this method, the value of asset can never be completely extinguished, which happens in the
earlier explained Straight Line Method. However, it is very simple to operate. This method is based on the
assumption that cost of repairs will increase as the asset get old, therefore, depreciation in earlier years
should be high when the repair cost is expected to be low and depreciation in later years should be low
when the repair cost is expected to be high. Therefore, this method will result in almost equal burden in all
the years of use of the asset as depreciation will reduce with increase in repair costs will increase with every
passing year. On the other hand, under the Straight Line Method, the charge for depreciation is constant,
while repairs tend to increase with the life of the asset. Among the disadvantages of this method is the
danger that too low a percentage may be adopted as depreciation with the result that over the life of the
asset full depreciation may not be provided; also if assets are grouped in such a way that individual assets
are difficult to identify, the residue of an asset may lie in the asset account even after the asset has been
scrapped. The last mentioned difficulty could be, however, over come if a Plant register is maintained.
The rate of depreciation under this method may be determined by the following formula:
Residual Value
1– n × 100
Cost of asset
Second Alternative
Amount of Depreciation is credited to the Asset Account every year and the Asset Account is carried at
historical cost less depreciation.
Accounting entries:
Depreciation Account Dr.
To Asset Account
Profit and Loss Account Dr.
To Depreciation Account
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Jain Bros. acquired a machine on 1st July, 2018 at a cost of ` 14,00,000 and spent ` 1,00,000 on its installation.
The firm writes off depreciation at 10% p.a. of the original cost every year. The books are closed on 31st December
every year.
Required
Show the Machinery Account and Depreciation Account for the year 2018 and 2019.
Machinery Account
` `
2018 2018
July 1 To Bank A/c 14,00,000 Dec. 31 By Depreciation A/c
July 1 To Bank A/c - 10% on ` 15,00,000 for 75,000
Installation 1,00,000 6 months
Expenses Dec. 31 By Balance c/d 14,25,000
15,00,000 15,00,000
2019 2019
Jan. 1 To Balance b/d 14,25,000 Dec. 31 By Depreciation A/c
10% on ` 15,00,000 1,50,000
Dec. 31 By Balance c/d 12,75,000
14,25,000 14,25,000
Depreciation Account
` `
2018 2018
Dec. 31 To Machinery A/c 75,000 Dec. 31 By Profit & Loss A/c 75,000
2019 2019
Dec. 31 To Machinery A/c 1,50,000 Dec. 31 By Profit & Loss A/c 1,50,000
? ILLUSTRATION 2
Jain Bros. acquired a machine on 1st July, 2018 at a cost of ` 14,00,000 and spent ` 1,00,000 on its installation.
The firm writes off depreciation at 10% p.a. every year. The books are closed on 31st December every year.
Required
Show the Machinery Account on diminishing balance method for the year 2018 and 2019.
SOLUTION
The number of years (including the present year) of remaining life of the asset
Total of all digits of the life of the asset (in years)
Suppose the estimated life of an asset is 10 years; the total of all the digits from 1 to 10 is 55 i.e.,10 + 9 + 8 +
7 + 6 + 5 + 4 + 3 + 2 + 1, or by the formula:
n (n + 1) 10 × 11
= = 55
2 2
The depreciation to be written off in the first year will be 10/55 of the cost of the asset less estimated scrap
value; and the depreciation for the second year will be 9/55 of the cost of asset less estimated scrap value
and so on.
The method is not yet in vogue; and its advantages are the same as those of the Reducing Balance Method.
? ILLUSTRATION 3
M/s Akash & Co. purchased a machine for ` 10,00,000. Estimated useful life and scrap value were 10 years and `
1,20,000 respectively. The machine was put to use on 1.1.2014.
Required
Show Machinery Account and Depreciation Account in their books for 2019 by using sum of years digits method.
SOLUTION
` `
2019 2019
Jan. 1 To Balance b/d (w.n.2) 3,60,000 Dec. 31 By Depreciation A/c (w.n.3) 80,000
Dec. 31 By Balance c/d 2,80,000
3,60,000 3,60,000
2020
Jan.1 To Balance b/d 2,80,000
Depreciation Account
` `
2019 2019
Dec. 31 To Machinery A/c 80,000 Dec. 31 By Profit and Loss A/c 80,000
80,000 80,000
Working Notes:
Where it is practicable to keep a record of the actual running hours of each machine, depreciation may
be calculated on the basis of hours that the concerned machine worked. The machine hour rate of the
depreciation, is calculated after estimating the total number of hours that machine would work during
its whole life; however, it may have to be varied from time to time, on a consideration of the changes in
the economic and technological conditions which might take place, to ensure that the amount provided
for depreciation corresponds to that considered appropriate in the changed circumstances. It would be
observed that the method is only a slight variation of the Straight Line Method under which depreciation is
calculated per year. Under this method it is calculated for each hour the machine works.
Schedule II to the Companies Act 2013, prescribes estimated useful life of different assets for companies, also
recognizes this method to some extent. It prescribes that depreciation should be charged using estimate
useful life suggested in it, however, in certain category of plant and machinery it prescribes to charge higher
amount of depreciation if these assets are used for 2 shifts or 3 shifts. In a way, schedule II combines straight
line method and machine hour method.
? ILLUSTRATION 4
A machine was purchased for ` 30,00,000 having an estimated total working of 24,000 hours. The scrap value is
expected to be ` 2,00,000 and anticipated pattern of distribution of effective hours is as follows :
Year
1–3 3,000 hours per year
4-6 2,600 hours per year
7 - 10 1,800 hours per year
Required
SOLUTION
Under this method depreciation of the asset is determined by comparing the annual production with the
estimated total production. The amount of depreciation is computed by the use of following method:
? ILLUSTRATION 5
A machine is purchased for ` 20,00,000. Its estimated useful life is 10 years with a residual value of ` 2,00,000.
The machine is expected to produce 1.5 lakh units during its life time. Expected distribution pattern of
production is as follows:
Year Production
1-3 20,000 units per year
4-7 15,000 units per year
8-10 10,000 units per year
Required
Determine the value of depreciation for each year using production units method.
SOLUTION
? ILLUSTRATION 6
M/s Surya & Co. took lease of a quarry on 1-1-2017 for ` 1,00,00,000. As per technical estimate the total quantity
of mineral deposit is 2,00,000 tonnes. Depreciation was charged on the basis of depletion method. Extraction
pattern is given in the following table:
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
5.14 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
SOLUTION
Depreciation Account
` `
2017 2017 `
Dec. 31 To Quarry lease A/c 1,00,000 Dec. 31 By Profit & Loss A/c 1,00,000
1,00,000 1,00,000
2018 2018
Dec. 31 To Quarry lease A/c 5,00,000 Dec. 31 By Profit & Loss A/c 5,00,000
2019 5,00,000 2019 5,00,000
Dec. 31 To Quarry lease A/c 7,50,000 Dec. 31 By Profit & Loss A/c 7,50,000
7,50,000 7,50,000
the profit or loss on the sale of that asset. The resulting profit or loss on sale of the asset is ultimately
transferred to profit and loss account.
For example: The book value of the asset as on 1st January, 2019 is ` 50,00,000. Depreciation is charged on
the asset @10%. On 1st July 2019, the asset is sold for ` 32,00,000. In such a situation, profit or loss on the
sale will be calculated as follows:
`
Book value as on 1st Jan., 2019 50,00,000
Less: Depreciation for 6 months @10% (from 1st Jan., 2019 to 30th June, 2019) (2,50,000)
Written down value as on 1st July, 2019 47,50,000
Less: Sale proceeds as on 1st July, 2019 (32,00,000)
Loss on sale of the asset 15,50,000
? ILLUSTRATION 7
A firm purchased on 1st January, 2018 certain machinery for ` 5,82,000 and spent ` 18,000 on its erection. On
July 1, 2018 another machinery for ` 2,00,000 was acquired. On 1st July, 2019 the machinery purchased on
1st January, 2018 having become obsolete was auctioned for ` 38,600 and on the same date fresh machinery
was purchased at a cost of ` 4,00,000.
Depreciation was provided for annually on 31st December at the rate of 10 per cent p.a. on written down value.
Required
Prepare machinery account.
SOLUTION
Machinery Account
` `
2018 2018 `
Jan. 1 To Bank A/c 5,82,000 Dec. 31 By Depreciation A/c 70,000
Jan. 1 To Bank A/c –
erection charges 18,000 By Balance c/d 7,30,000
July 1 To Bank A/c 2,00,000
8,00,000 8,00,000
2019 2019
Jan. 1 To Balance b/d 7,30,000 July 1 By Depreciation on
sold machine 27,000
July 1 To Bank A/c 4,00,000 By Bank A/c 3,86,000
By Profit and Loss A/c 1,27,000
Dec. 31 By Depreciation A/c 39,000
By Balance c/d 5,51,000
11,30,000 11,30,000
Working Note:
Book Value of Machines
Example :
Cost of Machine ` 10,50,000
Residual Value ` 50,000
Useful life 10 years.
The company charges depreciation on straight line method for the first two years and thereafter decides to
adopt written down value method by charging depreciation @ 25%. (calculated based on useful life). You
are required to calculate depreciation for the 3rd year.
Depreciation already charged for the first 2 years as per straight line method is ` 2,00,000. Therefore, WDV
for 2nd year is ` 8,50,000
Therefore in the profit and loss account of the 3rd year, the depreciation of ` 2,12,500 (25% of ` 850,000)
should be debited. In case the entity would have continued with Straight Line Method, depreciation for 3rd
year would have been ` 1,00,000.
? ILLUSTRATION 8
M/s Anshul & Co. commenced business on 1st January 2015, when they purchased plant and equipment for `
7,00,000. They adopted a policy of charging depreciation at 15% per annum on diminishing balance basis and
Over the years, their purchases of plant have been:
Date Amount
`
1-1-2016 1,50,000
1-1-2019 2,00,000
On 1-1-2019 it was decided to change the method and rate of depreciation to straight line basis. On this date
remaining useful life was assessed as 6 years for all the assets purchased before 1.1.2019 with no scrap value and
10 years for the asset purchased on 1.1.2019.
Required
Calculate the difference in depreciation to be adjusted in the Plant and Equipment Account for the year ending
31st December, 2019.
SOLUTION
? ILLUSTRATION 9
A Machine costing ` 6,00,000 is depreciated on straight line basis, assuming 10 years working life and Nil residual
value, for three years. The estimate of remaining useful life after third year was reassessed at 5 years.
Required
Calculate depreciation for the fourth year.
SOLUTION
Revaluation
Increase Decrease
? ILLUSTRATION 10
A machine of cost ` 12,00,000 is depreciated straight-line assuming 10 year working life and zero residual value
for three years. At the end of third year, the machine was revalued upwards by ` 60,000 the remaining useful life
was reassessed at 9 years.
Required
Calculate depreciation for the fourth year.
SOLUTION
w The resulting profit or loss on sale of the tangible asset is ultimately transferred to profit and loss
account.
w The depreciation method residual value & useful life applied to an asset should be reviewed at least
at each financial year-end and, if there has been a significant change in the expected pattern of
consumption of the future economic benefits embodied in the asset, on account of the above, they
should be changed to reflect the changed pattern.
w Whenever there is a revision in the estimated useful life of the asset, the balance depreciable amount
should be charged to the asset over the revised remaining estimated useful life of the asset.
w Whenever the depreciable asset is revalued, the depreciation should be charged on the revalued
amount on the basis of the remaining estimated useful life of the asset.
17. When a property, plant or equipment is sold then provision for depreciation account is debited, asset
account is credited and any gain or loss is recorded to profit and loss account.
18. While calculating the depreciation as per diminishing balance method, the salvage value of the asset at
the end of its life is reduced from its cost.
19. Any change in the estimated useful life of an asset should be accounted for as a change in an accounting
estimate in accordance with Accounting Standards.
20. Whenever any depreciable asset is sold during the year, depreciation is charged on it for that entire
year.
Multiple Choice Questions
1. Original cost = ` 12,60,000; Salvage value = Nil; Useful life = 6 years. Depreciation for the first year under
sum of years digits method will be
(a) ` 3,60,000 (b) ` 1,20,000 (c) ` 1,80,000
3. The number of production of similar units expected to be obtained from the use of an asset by an
enterprise is called as
(a) Unit life (b) Useful life (c) Production life
4. If a concern proposes to discontinue its business from March 2015 and decides to dispose of all its
plants within a period of 4 months, the Balance Sheet as on March 31, 2015 should indicate the plants
at their
(a) Historical cost (b) Net realizable value (c) Cost less depreciation
5. In the case of downward revaluation of a plant which is for the first time revalued, the account to be
debited is
(a) Plant account (b) Revaluation Reserve (c) Profit & Loss account
6. The portion of the acquisition cost of the tangible asset, yet to be allocated is known as
(a) Written down value (b) Accumulated value (c) Realisable value
8. Original cost of a machine was ` 25,20,000 salvage value was ` 1,20,000, useful life was 6 years.
Annual depreciation under Straight Line Method
(a) ` 4,20,000 (b) ` 4,00,000 (c) ` 3,00,000
9. The cost of a machine is ` 20,00,000. Two years later the book value is ` 10,00,000. The Straight-line
percentage depreciation is
(a) 50% (b) 33-1/3% (c) 25%
10. A machinery with original cost of ₹ 10,00,000 and Nil Salvage value acquired on 1st April 2017 with 4
years useful life was depreciated using Straight Line Method. It was decided to sell the machinery on 1st
October 2020 for ₹ 1,20,000. What shall be the gain or (loss) on the sale of Machinery ?
(a) Loss of ₹ 1,30,000 (b) Gain of ₹ 1,20,000 (c) Gain of ₹ 5,000 (d) Loss of ₹ 5,000
13. If the equipment account has a balance of Rs. 22,50,000 and the accumulated depreciation account has
a balance of Rs. 14,00,000, the book value of the equipment is
(a) ` 36,50,000 (b) ` 8,50,000 (c) ` 14,00,000
14. A plant with original cost of ₹ 50,00,000 was revalued after 2 years resulting in credit to Revaluation
Surplus account of ₹ 4,00,000. Towards the year end of 2019-20, due to COVID-19 the plan value had
gone down by ₹ 5,00,000 and accordingly management decided to revalue the same. What shall be the
impact of this downwards revaluation on the Profit & Loss Account ?
(a) Debit of ₹ 5,00,000 (b) Debit of ₹ 1,00,000
(c) Credit of ₹ 5,00,000 (d) Credit of ₹ 1,00,000
Theory Questions
1. Distinguish between Straight line method of depreciation and Written down value method of
depreciation.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
5.24 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
Depreciation is at the rate of 10% per annum on cost. It is the Company’s policy to assume that all
purchases, sales or disposal of plant occurred on 30th June in the relevant year for the purpose of
calculating depreciation, irrespective of the precise date on which these events occurred.
On 1st June 2019, a new machinery was acquired at a cost of ` 2,80,000 and installation charges incurred
in erecting the machine works out to ` 8,920 on the same date. On 1st June, 2019 a machine which had
cost ` 4,37,400 on 1st January 2017 was sold for ` 75,000. Another machine which had cost ` 4,37,000
on 1st January, 2018 was scrapped on the same date and it realised nothing.
Write a plant and machinery account for the year 2019, allowing the same rate of depreciation as in the
past calculating depreciation to the nearest multiple of a Rupee.
3. The LG Transport company purchased 10 trucks at ` 45,00,000 each on 1st April 2016. On October 1st,
2018, one of the trucks is involved in an accident and is completely destroyed and ` 27,00,000 is received
from the insurance in full settlement. On the same date another truck is purchased by the company
for the sum of ` 50,00,000. The company write off 20% on the original cost per annum. The company
observe the calendar year as its financial year.
Give the motor truck account for two year ending 31 Dec, 2019.
4. A Machinery costing ₹ 20,00,000 is depreciated on straight line assuming 10 years working life and
nil salvage value for four years. At the end of the fourth year, the machinery was revalued upwards by
₹ 80,000. The remaining useful life of the machinery was also reassessed as 8 years at the end of the
fourth year. Calculate the depreciation for 5th Year.
5. Amazing group had Property, Plant & Equipment (PP&E) with a book value of ₹ 35,00,000 on 31st
December 2019. The balance in Revaluation Surplus on that date was ₹ 3,00,000. As part of their practice
of revaluing the assets on yearly basis, another revaluation was carried out on 31st December 2019.
Evaluate the impact of Revaluation if the Fair Value as a result of Revaluation done on 31st December
2019 was (a) ₹ 37,00,000 (b) ₹ 33,00,000 and (c) ₹ 31,00,000. Also, give the journal entries.
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. False : It is the decrease in market value as one of the reasons for depreciation. Increase in market value
may result in Revaluation.
2. True : It is not necessary that the asset must be used to be depreciated, thus depreciation may start once
it is brought in the location & condition required to be used.
3. False : Non refundable taxes & duties form part of the cost.
4. False : Inauguration costs shouldn’t be part of cost.
5. True : SLM method results in same amount and Declining method involves same rate of depreciation.
6. True : Revaluation should be done for the whole class of the asset.
7. False : Any decrease in value of asset on account of revaluation should be first debited to Revaluation
Reserve, if any, and then to Profit & Loss account.
8. True : Sum of years digit method depreciation is calculated as 10/55 x (12,00,000 – 1,00,000) = 2,00,000
9. False : Depletion relates to allocation of cost of natural resources
10. True : Depreciation being non cash expense reduces the distributable profits and hence facilitates
replacement of asset when required.
Theoretical Questions
1. Under straight line method an equal amount is written off each year throughout the working life of
the depreciable tangible asset so as to reduce the cost of the asset to nil or to its scarp value at the
end. Under reducing balance method, a fixed percentage is charged on the diminishing balance of the
asset each year so as to reduce the value of the asset to its scarp value at the end of useful life. The basic
distinction between these two methods are as follows:
Under straight line method, annual depreciation charge is equal throughout the life of the asset; but
under reducing balance method, depreciation charge is reduced over the years as the asset grows old.
Under straight-line method, the asset can be fully depreciated but under reducing balance method
asset can never be fully depreciated.
Under straight line method the charge for depreciation is constant while repair charges increase with
the life of the asset, so the total charge throughout the life of the asset will not be uniform. To the
contrary, under reducing balance method, depreciation charges become high in the initial years but
generally repair remains low. As the asset grows old depreciation charge reduces but repair expenses
increase. Thus under reducing balance method depreciation and repairs are more or less evenly
distributed throughout the life of the asset.
2. Natural resources include physical assets like mineral deposits, oil and gas resources and timber. These
natural resources exhaust by exploitation.
3. The factors considered for calculation of depreciation are as: (i)Cost of asset including expenses for
installation, commissioning, trial run etc. (ii) Estimated useful life of the asset and (iii) Estimated scrap
value (if any) at the end of useful life of the asset.
Practical Questions
Answer 1
Calculation of provision for depreciation of plant and machinery for the year ended 31st
December, 2019.
Plant purchased in: ` `
2002 nil
2008 nil
2009 50,000
2010 1/2 year at 10% on ` 2,40,000 12,000
1 year at 10% on ` 4,60,000 46,000 58,000
2017 10% on ` 5,00,000 50,000
2018 10% on ` 3,00,000 30,000
2019 1/2 year at 10% on ` 15,00,000 75,000
2,63,000
Working Note :
(i) Calculation of loss on sale of machine on 1-6-2019
`
Cost on 1-1-2017 4,37,400
Less : Depreciation @ 10% on ` 4,37,400 (43,740)
W.D.V. on 31-12-2017 3,93,660
Less : Depreciation @ 10% on ` 3,93,660 (39,366)
W.D.V. on 31-12-2018 3,54,294
Less : Depreciation @ 10% on ` 3,54,294 for 5 months (14,762)
3,39,532
Less : Sale proceeds on 1-6-2019 (75,000)
Loss 2,64,532
(ii) Calculation of loss on scrapped machine
`
Cost on 1-1-2018 4,37,000
Less : Depreciation @ 10% on ` 4,37,000 (43,700)
W.D.V. on 1-1-2019 3,93,300
Less : Depreciation @ 10% on ` 3,93,300 for 5 months (16,388)
Loss 3,76,912
(iii) Depreciation
Balance of machinery account on 1-1-2019 19,00,000
Less : W.D.Vof machinery sold 3,54,294
W.D.V. of machinery scrapped 3,93,300 (7,47,594)
W.D.V. of other machinery on 1-1-2019 11,52,406
Depreciation @ 10% on ` 11,52,406 for 12 months 1,15,240
Depreciation @ 10% on ` 2,88,920 for 7 months 16,854
1,32,094
Answer 3
Date Particulars Amount Date Particulars Amount
2018 2018
Jan-01 To balance b/d 2,92,50,000 Oct-01 By bank A/c 27,00,000
To Profit & Loss A/c
Oct-01 (Profit on settlement 4,50,000 Oct-01 By Depreciation 6,75,000
of Truck) on lost assets
3,47,00,000 3,47,00,000
2019 2019
Jan-01 To balance b/d 2,29,75,000 Dec-31 By Depreciation A/c 91,00,000
Dec-31 By balance c/d 1,38,75,000
2,29,75,000 2,29,75,000
Working Note:
1. To find out loss on Profit on settlement of truck
`
Original cost as on 1.4.2016 45,00,000
Less: Depreciation for 2016 (6,75,000)
38,25,000
Less: Depreciation for 2017 (9,00,000)
29,25,000
Less: Depreciation for 2018 (9 months) (6,75,000)
22,50,000
Less: Amount received from Insurance company (27,00,000)
4,50,000
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
5.30 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
Answer 4
Depreciation per year for first 4 years = ₹ 20,00,000 / 10 = ₹ 2,00,000
Thus, WDV of the Machinery at end of the 4th year = ₹ 20,00,000 – (₹ 2,00,000 x 4) = ₹ 12,00,000
Revalued Amount i.e. New Depreciable Amount shall be = ₹ 12,00,000 + 80,000 = ₹ 12,80,000
Original remining useful life is (10-4) = 6 Years whereas it is reassessed as 8 Years.
Hence, depreciation for 5th Year = ₹ 12,80,000 / 8 = ₹ 1,60,000
Answer 5
(a) Fair Value : ₹ 37,00,000
Since this is an upward revaluation and the group had a balance in revaluation surplus (i.e. there was
an upward movement earlier), hence this will result in an additional credit of ₹ 2,00,000 to Revaluation
Surplus and hence the total Revaluation Surplus balance (part of other comprehensive income in
Equity) shall increase to ₹ 5,00,000. The Accounting journal entry shall be:
Property, Plant & Equipment A/c Dr 2,00,000
To Revaluation Surplus A/c 2,00,000
(b) Fair Value : ₹ 33,00,000
Since this is a downward revaluation and the group had a balance in revaluation surplus (i.e. there was
an upward movement earlier), hence this will result in a reduction or a debit to Revaluation Surplus to
the extent of balance therein and any excess shall be debited to Profit & Loss A/c. In this case, there is a
reduction in fair value of ₹ 2,00,000 (35,00,000 – 33,00,000) and hence the entire amount shall be debited
to Revaluation Surplus. Hence, the total Revaluation Surplus balance (part of other comprehensive
income in Equity) shall decrease to ₹ 1,00,000. The Accounting journal entry shall be:
Revaluation Surplus A/c Dr 2,00,000
To Property, Plant & Equipment A/c 2,00,000
(c) Fair Value : ₹ 31,00,000
Since this is also a downward revaluation and the group had a balance in revaluation surplus (i.e. there
was an upward movement earlier), hence this will result in a reduction or a debit to Revaluation Surplus
to the extent of balance therein and any excess shall be debited to Profit & Loss A/c. In this case, there
is a reduction in fair value of ₹ 4,00,000 (35,00,000 – 31,00,000) and hence the Revaluation Surplus A/c
shall be debited by ₹ 3,00,000 and the balance ₹ 1,00,000 shall be debited to Profit & Loss A/c. Hence,
the total Revaluation Surplus balance (part of other comprehensive income in Equity) shall become Nil.
The Accounting journal entry shall be:
Revaluation Surplus A/c Dr 3,00,000
Profit & Loss A/c Dr 1,00,000
To Property, Plant & Equipment A/c 4,00,000
Insolvency
Retirement of bills
The party which makes the order is known as the drawer. The party which accepts the order is known as
the acceptor and the party to whom the amount has to be paid is known as the payee. The drawer and the
payee can be the same.
A Bill of Exchange can be passed on to another person by endorsement. Endorsement on a bill of exchange
is made exactly as it is done in the case of a cheque. The primary liability on a bill of exchange is that of the
acceptor. If he does not pay, a holder can recover the amount from any of the previous endorsers or the
drawee.
Sometimes, it may happen that a bill of exchange is drawn for foreign trade operations. Such a bill is known
as “Foreign Bill of Exchange”. A foreign bill of exchange is one which is drawn in one country and is payable
in another. It is generally drawn up in triplicate wherein each copy is sent by separate post so that at least
one copy reaches the intended party. Payment will be made only on one of the copies and when such
payment is made the other copies become useless. Section 12 of the Negotiable Instruments Act provides
that all instruments, which are not inland instrument, are foreign.
Drawee
Payee Maker
(b) The second possibility is that the bill will be dishonoured, that is to say, the bill will not be paid. If the bill
is dishonoured, the bill becomes useless and the party from whom the bill was received will be liable to
pay the amount (and also the expenses incurred by the party).
Therefore, the following entries will be made :
1. If the bill was kept till maturity then :
Drawee / Maker of the note Dr.
To Bills Receivable Account
2. If the bill was endorsed in favour of a creditor, the entry is :
Drawee / Maker of the note Dr.
To Bill payables
3. If the bill was discounted with the bank :
Drawee / Maker of the note Dr.
To Bank A/c
Thus, it will be seen that in case of dishonour, the party which gave the bill has to be debited (because he
has become liable to pay the amount). The credit entry is in Bills Receivable Account (if it was retained) or
the Creditor or the bank (if it was endorsed/discounted in their favour).
w When a bill is drawn after sight, the term of the bill begins to run from the date of ‘sighting’, i.e., when
the bill is accepted.
w When a bill is drawn after date, the term of the bill begins to run from the date of drawing the bill.
(i) on demand,
(ii) at sight, or
(iii) on presentment
Notes:
(i) The expression ‘after sight’ means-
(a) in a promissory note, after presentment for sight
(b) in a bill of exchange, after acceptance or noting for non-acceptance or protest for non-acceptance.
(ii) A cheque cannot be a time instrument because the cheque is always payable on demand. Though a cheque
can be post dated and which can be presented on or after such date. A cheque has validity of 90 days from its
date after that it becomes void, normally termed as ‘Stale Cheque’ as bank will not honour such cheque.
Suppose X received from Y a bill for `1,000. On Maturity the bill is dishonoured and `10 is paid as noting
charges. The entry in this case will be
` `
Y Dr. 1,010
To Bills Receivable Account 1,000
To Bank A/c 10
Suppose X had endorsed this bill in favour of Z. In that case entry for dishonoured bill would have been
Y Dr. 1,010
To Z 1,010
This is because Z will claim `1,010 from X and X has the right of recovering `1,010 from Y. Similarly, if the
bill has been discounted with a bank, entry will be :
Y Dr. 1,010
To Bank A/c 1,010
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Ms. Sujata receives two bills from Ms. Aruna dated 1st January 2020 for 2 months. The first bill is for 10,200
and the second bill is for Rs. 15,000. The second bill was endorsed in favour or Mr. Sree on 3rd January 20.
And the First bill is discounted immediately with the bank for Rs. 10,000. Pass the necessary journal entries
in the books of Ms. Sujata.
SOLUTION
In the books of Sujata
Journal Entries
? ILLUSTRATION 2
Vijay sold goods to Pritam on 1st September, 2019 for `1,06,000. Pritam immediately accepted a three months
bill. On due date Pritam requested that the bill be renewed for a fresh period of two months. Vijay agrees provided
interest at 9% was paid immediately in cash. To this Pritam was agreeable. The second bill was met on due date.
Give Journal entries in the books of Vijay and Pritam.
SOLUTION
Books of Vijay
Journal
2019 ` `
1-Sept. Pritam Dr. 1,06,000
To Sales Account 1,06,000
(Sales of goods to Pritam as per Invoice No...)
Bills Receivable Account Dr. 1,06,000
To Pritam 1,06,000
(3 months acceptance received from Pritam for the
amount due from him)
Dec. 4 Pritam Dr. 1,06,000
To Bills Receivable Account 1,06,000
(Pritam acceptance cancelled because of renewal)
Books of Pritam
Journal
2019 ` `
1-Sept. Purchase Account Dr. 1,06,000
To Vijay A/c 1,06,000
(Purchase of goods from Vijay as per Invoice No...)
Vijay A/c Dr. 1,06,000
To Bills Payables Account 1,06,000
(3 months acceptance given to Vijay for the amount)
Dec. 4 Bills Payable Account Dr. 1,06,000
To Vijay A/c 1,06,000
(Cancellation of bill because of renewal)
Interest Account Dr. 1,590
To Vijay 1,590
(Interest @ 9% on `1,06,000 due to Vijay for 2 months
because of renewal)
Vijay Account Dr. 1,07,590
To Cash Account 1,590
To Bills Payable Account 1,06,000
[New acceptance for 2 months for `106,000 and
Cash (for interest) paid to Vijay]
2020
Feb. 7 Bills Payable Account Dr. 1,06,000
To Bank Account 1,06,000
(Cash paid against second bill)
? ILLUSTRATION 3
On 1st January, 2020, Ankita sells goods for `5,00,000 to Bhavika and draws a bill at three months for the amount.
Bhavika accepts it and returns it to Ankita. On 1st March, 2020, Bhavika retires her acceptance under rebate of
12% per annum. Record these transactions in the journals of Ankita and Bhavika.
SOLUTION
Journal Entries in the books of Ankita
Date Particulars ` `
2020
Jan. 1 Bhavika’s account Dr. 5,00,000
To Sales account 5,00,000
(Being the goods sold to Bhavika on credit)
Bills receivable account Dr. 5,00,000
To Bhavika’s account 5,00,000
(Being the acceptance of bill received)
1-Mar Bank account Dr. 4,95,000
Rebate on bills account Dr. 5,000
To Bills receivable account 5,00,000
(Being retirement of bill by Bhavika one month
before maturity, the rebate being given to her at
12% p.a.)
Date Particulars ` `
2020
Jan. 1 Purchases account Dr. 5,00,000
To Ankita account 5,00,000
(Being the goods purchased from Ankita on credit)
Ankita Account Dr. 5,00,000
To Bills Payable Account 5,00,000
(Being the acceptance of bill)
1-Mar Bills Receivable Account Dr. 5,00,000
To Rebate Income Account 5,000
To Bills receivable account 4,95,000
(Being retirement of bill one month before maturity,
the rebate being received at 12% p.a.)
? ILLUSTRATION 4
SOLUTION
Books of K. Katrak
Journal Entries
` `
(i) Bills Payable Account Dr. 2,500
Interest Account Dr. 50
To Cash A/c 1,000
To Bills Payable Account 1,550
(Bills Payable to Basu discharged by cash payment
of `1,000 and a new bill for `1,550 including `50 as
interest)
(ii) (a) G. Gupta Dr. 4,020
To M. Mehta 4,020
(G. Gupta’s acceptance for `4,000 endorsed to M.
Mehta dishonoured,`20 paid by M. Mehta as noting
charges)
(b) M. Mehta Dr. 4,020
To Bank Account 4,020
(Payment to M. Mehta on withdrawal of bill earlier
received from Mr. G. Gupta)
(iii) Bank Account Dr. 1,990
Discount Account Dr. 10
To Bills Receivable Account 2,000
(Payment received from D. Dalal against his
acceptance for `2,000. Allowed him a discount of
`10)
(iv) Bills Payable Account Dr. 5,000
To Bills Receivable Account 5,000
(Bills Receivable from Mody endorsed to Patel in
settlement of bills payable issued to him earlier)
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
6.14 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
? ILLUSTRATION 5
On 1st January, 2020, Vilas draws a bill of exchange for `10,000 due for payment after 3 months on Eknath.
Eknath accepts to this bill of exchange. On 4th March, 2020 Eknath retires the bill of exchange at a discount of
12% p.a. You are asked to show the journal entries in the books of Eknath.
SOLUTION
Journal entries in the books of Eknath
? ILLUSTRATION 6
On 1st January, 2020, Vilas draws a Bill of Exchange for `10,000 due for payment after 3 months on Eknath.
Eknath accepts to this bill of exchange. On 4th March, 2020. Eknath retires the bill of exchange at a discount of
12% p.a. You are asked to show the journal entries in the books of Vilas.
SOLUTION
1.15 INSOLVENCY
Insolvency of a person means that he is unable to pay his liabilities. This means that bills accepted by him
will be dishonoured. Therefore, when it is known that a person has become insolvent, entry for dishonour
of his acceptance must be passed. Later on, something may be received from his estate. When and if an
amount is received, cash account will be debited and the personal account of the debtor will be credited.
The remaining amount will be irrecoverable and, therefore, should be written off as bad debt. The students
should be careful to calculate the amount actually received from an insolvent’s estate and amount to be
written off only after preparing his account.
In the books of drawee of the bill, the amount not ultimately paid by him due to insolvency, should be
credited to Deficiency Account.
? ILLUSTRATION 7
Mr. David draws two bills of exchange on 1.1.2020 for `6,000 and `10,000. The bills of exchange for `6,000 is for
two months while the bill of exchange for `10,000 is for three months. These bills are accepted by Mr. Thomas.
On 4.3.2020, Mr. Thomas requests Mr. David to renew the first bill with interest at 18% p.a. for a period of two
months. Mr. David agrees to this proposal. On 20.3.2020, Mr. Thomas retires the acceptance for `10,000, the
interest rebate i.e. discount being `100. Before the due date of the renewed bill, Mr. Thomas becomes insolvent
and only 50 paise in a rupee could be recovered from his estate.
You are to give the journal entries in the books of Mr. David.
SOLUTION
? ILLUSTRATION 8
Rita owed `1,00,000 to Siriman. On 1st October, 2019, Rita accepted a bill drawn by Siriman for the amount at 3
months. Siriman got the bill discounted with his bank for `99,000 on 3rd October, 2019. Before the due date, Rita
approached Siriman for renewal of the bill. Siriman agreed on the conditions that `50,000 be paid immediately
together with interest on the remaining amount at 12% per annum for 3 months and for the balance, Rita should
accept a new bill at three months. These arrangements were carried out. But afterwards, Rita became insolvent
and 40% of the amount could be recovered from his estate.
Pass journal entries (with narration) in the books of Siriman.
SOLUTION
In the books of Siriman
Journal Entries
Particulars L.F. ` `
Bills Receivable A/c Dr. 1,00,000
To Rita 1,00,000
(Being a 3 month’s bill drawn on Rita for the amount due)
Bank A/c Dr. 99,000
Discount A/c Dr. 1,000
To Bills Receivable A/c 1,00,000
(Being the bill discounted)
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING FOR SPECIAL TRANSACTIONS 6.17
Entries are passed in the books of two parties exactly in the way already pointed out for ordinary bills. The
only additional entry to be passed is for sending the remittance for one party to the other party and also
debiting the other party with the shared amount of discount.
? ILLUSTRATION 9
On 1st July, 2019 Gorge drew a bill for `1,80,000 for 3 months on Harry for mutual accommodation. Harry accepted
the bill of exchange. Gorge had purchased goods worth `1,81,000 from Jack on the same date. Gorge endorsed
Harry’s acceptance to Jack in full settlement. On 1st September, 2019, Jack purchased goods worth `1,90,000
from Harry. Jack endorsed the bill of exchange received from Gorge to Harry and paid ` 9,000 in full settlement of
the amount due to Harry. On 1st October, 2019, Harry purchased goods worth `2,00,000 from Gorge. Harry paid
the amount due to Gorge by cheque. Give the necessary Journal Entries in the books of Harry and Gorge.
SOLUTION
Date Particulars ` `
1.7.2019 Gorge’s account Dr. 1,80,000
To Bills payable account 1,80,000
(Acceptance of bill drawn by Gorge)
1.9.2019 Jack’s account Dr. 1,90,000
To Sales account 1,90,000
(Sales made to Jack)
1.9.2019 Bills receivable account Dr. 1,80,000
Bank account Dr. 9,000
Discount account Dr. 1,000
To Jack’s account 1,90,000
(Acceptance received from Jack’s endorsement of
bill received from Gorge for ` 1,80,000 and ` 9,000
received in full settlement of the amount due)
1.9.2019 Bills payable account Dr. 1,80,000
To Bills receivable account 1,80,000
(Own acceptance received from Jack’s endorsement,
cancelled)
1.10.2019 Purchase account Dr. 2,00,000
To Gorge’s account 2,00,000
(Purchases made from Gorge)
Gorge’s account Dr. 20,000
To Bank account 20,000
(Amount paid to Gorge after adjusting `180,000
for accommodation extended to him)
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING FOR SPECIAL TRANSACTIONS 6.19
Date Particulars ` `
1.7.2019 Purchases Account Dr. 1,81,000
To Jack Account 1,81,000
(Purchase of goods from Jack)
1.7.2019 Bills Receivable Account Dr. 1,80,000
To Harry Account 1,80,000
(Acceptance by Harry of bill drawn on him)
1.7.2019 Jack’s account Dr. 1,81,000
To Rebate Account 1,000
To Bills Receivable Account 1,80,000
(Harry’s bill endorsed to Jack)
1.10.2019 Harry Account Dr. 2,00,000
To Sales account 2,00,000
(Sales to Harry)
1.10.2019 Bank Account Dr. 20,000
To Harry account 20,000
(Amount received from Gorge after adjusting
`180,000 for accommodation extended by him)
? ILLUSTRATION 10
For the mutual accommodation of ‘X’ and ‘Y’ on 1st April, 2019, ‘X’ drew a four months’ bill on ‘Y’ for `4,000. ‘Y’
returned the bill after acceptance of the same date. ‘X’ discounts the bill from his bankers @ 6% per annum and
remit 50% of the proceeds to ‘Y’. On due date ‘X’ is unable to send the amount due and therefore ‘Y’ draws a bill for
`7,000, which is duly accepted by ‘X’. ‘Y’ discounts the bill for `6,600 and sends `1,300 to ‘X’. Before the bill is due
for payment ‘X’ becomes insolvent. Later 25 paise in a rupee received from his estate.
Record Journal entries in the books of ‘X’.
SOLUTION
In the books of X
Journal Entries
? ILLUSTRATION 11
X draws on Y a bill of exchange for Rs 30,000 on 1st April, 2020 for 3 months. Y accepts the bill and sends it to
X who gets it discounted for Rs 28,800. X immediately remits Rs 9,600 to Y. On the due date, X, being unable
to remit the amount due, accepts a bill for Rs 42,000 for three months which is discounted by Y for Rs 40,110.
Y sends Rs 6,740 to X. Before the maturity of the bill X becomes bankrupt, his estate paying fifty paise in the
rupee. Give the journal entries in the books of X and Y.
SOLUTION
In the books of X
Journal Entries
Date Particulars L.F. DR. (in `) CR. (in `)
01/04/2020 Bills receivables A/c Dr. 30,000
To Y A/c 30,000
(Being bill of exchange drawn on Mr. Y)
1/4/2020 Bank A/c Dr. 28,800
Discount charges A/c Dr. 1,200
To Bills receivable A/c 30,000
(Being the bills receivable discounted with the bank at a
charge of Rs. 1,200)
1/4/2020 Y A/c Dr. 10,000
To Bank A/c 9,600
To Discount charges 400
(Being the amount remitted to Y along with his share of
the bank charges)
04/7/2020 Y A/c Dr. 42,000
To Bills payable A/c 42,000
(being the bills drawn by Y, due to non payment of earlier
bill)
04/7/2020 Bank A/c Dr. 6,740
Discount charges A/c Dr. 1,260
To Y A/c 8,000
(Being the amount discounted and sent it by Y to X)
Bills payable A/c Dr. 42,000
To Y’s A/c 42,000
(being the bill due dishonoured due to bankruptcy)
Y A/c Dr. 28,000
To Bank A/c 14,000
To Deficiency account 14,000
(Being the amount due to Y discharged by payment of 50
paise in a rupee)
In the books of Y
Journal Entries
Date Particulars L.F. DR. (in `) CR. (in `)
01/04/2020 X A/c Dr. Dr. 30,000
To Bills payable A/c 30,000
(Being bill of exchange accepted and sent to Mr. X)
1/4/2020 Bank A/c Dr. 9,600
Discount charges A/c Dr. 400
To X A/c 10,000
(being the amount received from X on account of the
billsofreceivable)
© The Institute Chartered Accountants of India
6.22 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
? ILLUSTRATION 12
Anil draws a bill for `9,000 on Sanjay on 5th April, 2019 for 3 months, which Sanjay returns it to Anil after
accepting the same. Anil gets it discounted with the bank for ` 8,820 on 8th April, 2019 and remits one-third
amount to Sanjay. On the due date Anil fails to remit the amount due to Sanjay, but he accepts a bill for `12,600
for three months, which Sanjay discounts it for ` 12,330 and remits ` 2,220 to Anil. Before the maturity of the
renewed bill Anil becomes insolvent and only 50% was realized from his estate on 15th October, 2019.
Pass necessary Journal entries for the above transactions in the books of Anil.
SOLUTION
In the books of Anil
Journal Entries
Date of Voucher Party from whom Acceptor Date Due Place of Amt. ` L.F. Mode of Disposal
receipt No. Received of Bill Date Payment
Date of Drawer Payee Date of Bill Due Date Place of Amt.` L.F. Mode of Disposal
Acceptance Payment
SUMMARY
w A Bill of Exchange is defined as an “instrument in writing containing an unconditional order signed by
the maker directing a certain person to pay a certain sum of money only to or to the order of a certain
person or to the bearer of the instrument”.
w A promissory note is an instrument in writing, not being a bank note or currency note containing an
unconditional undertaking signed by the maker to pay a certain sum of money only to or to the order
of a certain person. Under Section 31(2) of the Reserve Bank of India Act a promissory note cannot be
made payable to bearer.
w A party which receives a Promissory Note or receives an accepted Bill of Exchange will treat it as a new
asset under the name of Bills receivable. A party which issues a Promissory Note or accepts a Bill of
Exchange will treat it as new liability under the heading of Bills Payable.
2. On 16.6.2020 P draws a bill on Q for `1,25,000 for 30 days. 19th July is a public holiday, maturity date
of the bill will be:
(a) 19th July (b) 18th July (c) 17th July
3. PQ draws a bill on XY for `130,000 on 1.1.2020. X accepts the same on 4.1.2020 for period of 3 months
after date. What will be the maturity date of the bill:
(a) 4.4.2020 (b) 3.4.2020 (c) 7.4.2020
4. A draws a bill on B. A endorsed the bill to C. The payee of the bill will be
(a) A (b) B (c) C
5. A bill of ` 120,000 was discounted by Saras with the banker for `1,18,800. At maturity, the bill returned
dishonoured, noting charges ` 200. How much amount will the bank deduct from Saras’s bank balance
at the time of such dishonour?
(a) `1,20,000 (b) `1,18,800 (c) `1,20,200
6. X draws a bill on Y for `300,000 on 1.1.2020 for 3 months after sight, date of acceptance is 6.1.2020.
Maturity date of the bill will be:
(a) 8.4.2020 (b) 9.4.2020 (c) 10.4.2020
7. X sold goods to Y for ` 5,00,000. Y paid cash `4,30,000. X will grant 2% discount on balance, and Y
request X to draw a bill for balance, the amount of bill will be:
(a) ` 98,000 (b) ` 68,000 (c) ` 68,600
8. On 1.1.2020, X draws a bill on Y for ` 5,00,000 for 3 months. X got the bill discounted 4.1.2020 at 12%
rate. The amount of discount on bill will be:
(a) ` 15,000 (b) ` 16,000 (c) ` 18,000
9. Mr. Jay draws a bill on Mr. John for ` 3,00,000 on 1.1.2020 for 3 months. On 4.2.2020, John got the bill
discounted at 12% rate. The amount of discount will be:
(a) ` 9,000 (b) ` 6,000 (c) ` 3,000
10. XZ draws a bill on YZ for ` 2,00,000 for 3 months on 1.1.2020. The bill is discounted with banker at a
charge of `1,000. At maturity the bill return dishonoured. In the books of XZ, for dishonour, the bank
account will be credited by:
(a) `199,000 (b) ` 200,000 (c) ` 201,000
11. On 1.1.2020, XA draws a bill on YB for ` 1,00,000. At maturity YB request XA to renew the bill for 2
month at 12% p.a. interest. Amount of interest will be:
(a) ` 2,000 (b) ` 1,500 (c) ` 1,800
(b) A promise
(c) A request to deliver the goods
Theory Questions
Q1. Write short notes on:
(a) Accommodation bill.
(b) Renewal of bill.
(c) Noting charges.
Q2. What is bill of exchange? How does it differ from Promissory Note?
Practical Questions
Q1 On 1st January, 2020, A sells goods for `10,000 to B and draws a bill at three months for the amount.
B accepts it and returns it to A. On 1st March, 2020, B retires his acceptance under rebate of 12% per
annum. Record these transactions in the journals of B.
Q2 A draws upon B three Bills of Exchange of ` 3,000, ` 2,000 and ` 1,000 respectively. A week later his
first bill was mutually cancelled, B agreeing to pay 50% of the amount in cash immediately and for the
balance plus interest `100, he accepted a fresh Bill drawn by A. This new bill was endorsed to C who
discounted the same with his bankers for `1,500. The second bill was discounted by A at 5%. This bill on
maturity was returned dishonoured (nothing charge being `30). The third bill was retained till maturity
when it was duly met.
Give the necessary journal entries recording the above transactions in the books of A.
Q3 Journalize the following in the books of Don:
(i) Bob informs Don that Ray’s acceptance for ` 3,000 has been dishonoured and noting charges are
` 40. Bob accepts ` 1,000 cash and the balance as bill at three months at interest of 10%.Don accepts
from Ray his acceptance at two months plus interest @ 12% p.a.
(ii) James owes Don ` 3,200; he sends Don’s own acceptance in favour of Ralph for ` 3,160; in full
settlement.
(iii) Don meets his acceptance in favour of Singh for ` 4,500 by endorsing John’s acceptance for ` 4,450
in full settlement.
(iv) Ray’s acceptance in favour of Don retired one month before due date, interest is taken at the rate of
6% p.a.
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. False: The bills payable account is a liability account that is disclosed in the balance sheet.
2. False: Bill of exchange contains an order to pay the required amount and not a mere promise to pay.
3. False: 3 Days of grace are added to the due date to arrive at the maturity date.
4. False: There can be more than 2 parties- namely the drawer, acceptor and the payee of the bill.
5. True: When a bill is drawn in the country and is payable outside the country it is termed as a foreign bill.
6. True: In case of the promissory note, it is generally the maker who makes the payment, but in case of
the bill of exchange, the person accepting the bill shall be liable to make the payment to the holder of
the bill.
MCQs
Theoretical Questions
1 (a) Bills of Exchange are usually drawn to facilitate trade transmission, that is, bills are meant to finance
actual purchase and sale of goods. But the mechanism of bill can be utilised to raise finance also.
When bills are used for such a purpose, they are known as accommodation bills.
(b) When the acceptor of a bill finds himself in financial straits to honour the bill on the due date, then
he may request the drawer to cancel the original bill and draw on him a fresh bill for another period.
And if the drawer agrees, a new bill in place of the original bill may be accepted by the drawee for
another period. This is called the renewal of bill.
(c) The charges paid to Notary public for notify the dishonour are noting charges. Refer para 1.12 for
details.
2 A bill of exchange has been defined as “an instrument in writing containing an unconditional order
signed by the maker directing a certain person to pay a certain sum of money only to or to the order
of certain person or to the bearer of the instrument”. When such an order is accepted by the drawee, it
becomes a valid bill of exchange. A promissory note is an instrument in writing (not being a bank note
or a government currency note) containing an unconditional undertaking, signed by the maker, to pay
a certain sum of money only to, or to the order of, a certain person, or to the bearer of the instrument.
A promissory note needs no acceptance, as the debtor himself writes the document promising to pay
the stated amount. Like bills of exchange, promissory notes are also negotiable instruments, and can
be transferred by endorsement. In case of bill of exchange, the drawer and the payee may be the same
person but in case of a promissory note, the maker and the payee cannot be the same person.
Practical Questions
Answer 1
Journal Entries in the books of B
Working Note :
Calculation of rebate:
10,000 x 12/100 x 1/12 = `100
Answer 2
Journal of A
` `
Bills Receivable A/c Dr. 6,000
To B 6,000
(Three bills for `3,000, `2,000 and `1,000 drawn on B and duly accepted
by him received)
B Dr. 3,000
To Bills Receivable A/c 3,000
(Bill received from B cancelled for renewal)
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
6.30 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
` `
(i)(a) Ray Dr. 3,040
To Bob 3,040
(Ray’s acceptance endorsed to Bob dishonoured on due date
nothing charges paid by Bob `40)
(b) Bob Dr. 3,040
Interest Dr. 51
To Cash 1,000
To Bills Payable A/c 2,091
(Amount payable to Bob `3,040 settled by cash payment
`1,000 and issue of new bill for `2,091 including interest ` 51
for three months on `2,040 @ 10% p.a.)
(c) Bills Receivable A/c Dr. 3,100.80
To Ray 3,040.00
To Interest 60.8
Sales or Sales or
Transaction Sales or
Return Return Day Return
is treated Book Ledger
Journal is
as Ordinary prepared
Sale with four
main
columns Treated as
Memorandum
Books
2.1 INTRODUCTION
Under normal course of business, goods sold to customers is treated as sale immediately when the goods
are sold, with corresponding revenue from such sale being recognized in the profit and loss account.
However, when a businessman wants to increase his sales or introduce a new product in the market, he
usually faces hardship due to competition prevailing in the market. To counter it, goods are sometimes sent
to the customers on sale or return basis. Here, goods sent on ‘approval’ or ‘on return’ basis means goods are
delivered to the customers with the option to retain or return them within a specified period. Generally,
these transactions take place between a manufacturer (or a wholesaler) and a retailer. In current scenario,
this practice is prevalent in case of online sales, where the buyer is given time of few days to return the goods
if the buyer believes that the specifications of goods are different from the same mentioned on website at
the time of sale. There may be certain terms and conditions to administrate the return of goods. Following
are essentially the features of sale of goods on approval or return basis:
(a) There is a change in the possession of goods from one person to another.
(b) It does not involve transfer of ownership of goods. The ownership is passed only when the buyer gives
his approval or if the goods are not returned within that specified period.
(c) The customer does not incur any liability when the goods are merely sent to him. In case of online
transactions, sometimes customers are given choice to pay on receipt of goods and in some cases they
are required to pay in advance and then seller ships the goods to buyer. Even in case the buyer has
paid in advance, it retains the right of refund if the goods are returned as per the terms and conditions
agreed between seller and buyer.
As per the definition given under the Sale of Goods Act, 1930, in respect of such goods, the sale will take
place or the property in the goods pass to the buyer under any of the following conditions is satisfied:
(i) When he signifies his approval or acceptance to the seller;
(ii) When he does some act adopting the transaction;
(iii) If he does not signify his approval or acceptance to the seller but retains the goods without giving
notice of rejection, on the expiry of the specified time (if a time has been fixed) or on the expiry of
a reasonable time (if no time has been fixed).
2.2.1 WHEN THE BUSINESS SENDS GOODS CASUALLY ON SALE OR RETURN BASIS
When the transactions are few, the seller on sending the goods, treats them as an ordinary sale. If the goods
are accepted or not returned or the business receives no intimation within the specified time limit, no extra
entry is required to be passed because the entry for sale (passed at the time of sending goods) becomes the
usual entry after the expiry of the specified period. If the goods are returned within a specified time limit, a
reverse entry is passed to cancel the previous transaction. If, at the year-end, goods are still lying with the
customers and the specified time limit is yet to expire, the entry for sales made earlier is cancelled and the
value of the goods lying with the customers must be reduced from the selling price to the cost price, and
treated as part of closing inventories Inventories for Balance Sheet purposes.
Journal Entries:
1. When goods are sent on sale or return basis:
Trade receivables / Customers Account Dr. [Invoice price]
To Sales Account
2. When goods are rejected or returned within the specified time:
Sales/Return Inwards Account Dr. [Invoice price]
To Customers/Trade receivables Account
3. When goods are accepted at invoice price:
[No entry]
? ILLUSTRATION 1
CE sends goods to his customers on Sale or Return basis. The following transactions took place during 2019:
Sept. 15 Sent goods to customers on sale or return basis at cost plus 33 1/3 % ` 1,00,000
Oct. 20 Goods returned by customers ` 40,000
Nov. 25 Received letters of approval from customers ` 40,000
Dec . 31 Goods with customers awaiting approval ` 20,000
CE records sale or return transactions as ordinary sales. You are required to pass the necessary Journal Entries in
the books of CE assuming that accounting year closes on 31st December, 2019.
SOLUTION
In the books of CE
Journal Entries
Amit runs an online store where in the goods are casually sold on sale on approval basis, the following is the
information provided to you during 2020:
Date Particulars Amt (in `)
10th Feb Sale on approval basis- 25% on cost 1,20,000 (cost)
20th Feb Goods returned by customers 80,000
15th March Goods for which approval given by customers 40,000
31st March Goods with customers awaiting approval 30,000
All the above goods are sold ordinarily in the course of the online business. Considering that he closes his books
on 31st March 2020, you are required to pass entries in the books of Amit, to record the above transactions.
Note- Additionally it has been provided that on 15th April 2020, the customers have rejected the goods for which
approval has been pending on 31st March, deal with the same accordingly.
SOLUTION
In the books of Amit
Journal Entries
? ILLUSTRATION 3
Mr. Kumar sells goods on approval or return basis casually. He has sold goods worth Rs. 1,50,000, (sold at a profit
of 33 1/3% on sale) which has been awaiting approval from the customers as on the date of closing the books.
After the expiry of the period, the customers have accepted goods equivalent to 75% of the cost of the goods and
the rest considered to be rejected.
You are required to show the necessary journal entries as on the date of closing the books and the entries after the
expiry of the period and the treatment of the goods.
SOLUTION
In the books of Kumar
Journal Entries
Date Particulars L.F. Dr. (in ` ) Cr. (in ` )
Closing Sales A/c Dr. 1,50,000
date To Trade receivables A/c 1,50,000
(Being the cancellation of original entry of sale in
respect of goods on sale or return basis)
Inventories with customers on Sale or Return A/c Dr. 1,00,000
To Trading A/c 1,00,000
(Being the adjustment for cost of goods lying with
customers awaiting approval)
Note- 1,50,000* 1/3= 50,000
Cost price= 1,50,000-50,000= 1,00,000
On expiry Trade receivables A/c Dr. 75,000
of approval To Sales A/c 75,000
period (being the goods equal to 75% of the cost of
goods sent on approval basis, with the remaining
being rejected)
Note: 1,00,000*75% = 75,000 (accepted)
1,50,000-75,000 = 75,000 (rejected)
There is no need to pass the entry for the return of the goods as they have already been
reversed as on the closing date.
? ILLUSTRATION 4
S. Ltd. sends out its goods to dealers on Sale or Return basis. All such transactions are, however, treated as actual
sales and are passed through the Day Book. Just before the end of the accounting year on 31.03.2020, 200 such
goods have been sent to a dealer at `250 each (cost ` 200 each) on sale or return basis and debited to his account.
Of these goods, on 31.03.2020, 50 were returned and 70 were sold while for the other goods, date of return has
not yet expired.
Pass necessary adjustment entries on 31.03.2020.
SOLUTION
In the books of S. Ltd.
Journal Entries
? ILLUSTRATION 5
Caly Company sends out its gas containers to dealers on Sale or Return basis. All such transactions are, however,
treated as actual sales and are passed through the Day Book. Just before the end of the financial year, 100 gas
containers, which cost them ` 900 each have been sent to the dealer on ‘sale or return basis’ and have been
debited to his account at `1,200 each. Out of this only 20 gas containers are sold at `1,500 each.
You are required to pass necessary adjustment entries for the purpose of Profit and Loss Account and Balance
Sheet.
SOLUTION
In the books of Caly Company
Journal Entries
? ILLUSTRATION 6
E Ltd. sends out its accounting machines costing ` 200 each to their customers on Sales or Return basis. All such
transactions are, however, treated like actual sales and are passed through the Day Book. Just before the end
of the financial year, i.e., on March 24, 2020, 300 such accounting machines were sent out at an invoice price of
` 280 each, out of which only 90 accounting machines are accepted by the customers ` 250 each and as to the
rest no report is forthcoming. Show the Journal Entries in the books of the company for the purpose of preparing
Final Accounts for the year ended March 31, 2020.
SOLUTION
In the books of E Ltd.
Journal Entries
? ILLUSTRATION 7
A sends out goods on approval to few customers and includes the same in the Sales Account. On 31.3.2020, the
Trade receivables balance stood at `1,00,000 which included `7,000 goods sent on approval against which no
intimation was received during the year. These goods were sent out at 25% over and above cost price and were
sent to-
Mr. X - ` 4,000 and Mr. Y - ` 3,000.
Mr. X sent intimation of acceptance on 30th April and Mr. Y returned the goods on 10th April, 2020.
Make the adjustment entries and show how these items will appear in the Balance Sheet on 31st March, 2020.
Show also the entries to be made during April, 2020. Value of closing Inventories as on 31st March, 2020 was
`60,000.
SOLUTION
In the Books of A
Journal Entries
Liabilities ` Assets ` `
Trade receivables ( `1,00,000 - ` 7,000) 93,000
Inventories-in-trade 60,000
Add: Inventories with customers on Sale or Return
5,600 65,600
1,58,600
Notes:
(1) Cost of goods lying with customers = 100/125 x ` 7,000 = ` 5,600
(2) No entry is required on 10th April, 2020 for goods returned by Mr. Y. Goods should be included physically
in the Inventories-in-trade.
2.2.2 WHEN THE BUSINESS SENDS GOODS FREQUENTLY ON SALE OR RETURN BASIS
When a business sends goods on sale or return on a frequent basis, an immediate sale does not take place.
Only when the customer signifies his intention to purchase the goods or takes some action whereby it is
indicated that he has decided to purchase the goods, the property in the goods passes to the buyer. So long
as the property does not pass to the buyer, the seller does not record it as a sale and, therefore, does not
debit the customer with the sales price.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING FOR SPECIAL TRANSACTIONS 6.41
Under this method, record of goods sent is maintained in a specially ruled Sale or Return Journal / Day Book
instead of passing entry for sale of goods. This Day Book is divided into 4 main columns - (1) Goods sent on
Approval; (2) Goods Returned: (3) Goods Approved; and (4) Balance.
When such a Journal is kept the following procedure is adopted for recording transactions entered into on
this basis:
w When goods are sent out for sale on approval, entries are made only in column 1 to 4, the sale price of
goods being entered in column 4. The sale price is also posted to the debit of the customers’ account
in ‘Goods on Approval Ledger’, and periodically total of column 4 is posted to the credit of Goods on
Approval Total Account in the same ledger.
w If goods are returned, entries are made in columns 5 to 8, the price of goods returned being entered to
column 8. The individual amounts are credited to the Customers’ Accounts, in the ‘Goods on Approval’
Ledger and the total of this column in periodically posted to the Total Goods on Approval Account.
w If the goods are retained by the customer, entries are made in columns 9 to 12. The individual amounts
are then posted to the debit of customer’s accounts in the Sales Ledger and their total is credited to
Sales Account in the General Ledger. Further the customer’s accounts in the Goods on Approval Ledger
are credited with the individual amounts of goods sold and periodically, the total of the amount is
posted to the debit of Goods on Approval Total Account.
w The value of goods sent out but not sold or returned till the close of the year is extended to column 13.
The total of this column, afterwards, will show the value of goods with customers at the sale price.
The balance amount is calculated as follows:
Balance Value of Goods Sent on Sale or Return – Value of Goods Returned – Value of Goods Approved.
Information relating to goods delivered and goods returned is kept on Memorandum basis.
However, information relating to goods approved and balance is duly accounted for by passing journal
entries relating to sales and Inventories on approval basis.
The amount, after eliminating the element of profit, is included in the Trading Account representing the
value of Inventories with customers at cost price. Like an ordinary closing Inventories, such goods are
considered as Inventories lying with customers on behalf of seller and are valued at cost or net realisable
value whichever is less.
w When goods are sent to the customers on a sale or return basis, they are first recorded in the Sale or
Return day Book. Thereafter, in the Sale or Return Ledger, all the customers are individually debited and
the Sale or Return Account is credited with the periodical total of the Sale or Return Day Book.
w When the goods are returned by the customers within the specified time, they are recorded initially
in the Sale or Return Day Book. Thereafter, in the Sale or Return Ledger, the Sale or Return Account
is debited with the periodical total of the Sale or Return Day Book and the individual customers are
credited. The above mentioned records are all memorandum and hence cannot find a place in the
regular books.
w When the business receives information about the acceptance of the goods or no intimation is
received within the specified time, they are recognised as sales and are recorded in the Sales Day Book.
Periodically, the total of the Sales Day Book is credited to Sales Account and debited to the Individual
Customers Account. To cancel the earlier entries, individual customers are credited and the Sale or
Return Account is debited.
The entries for the approved goods are shown below:
In the Memorandum Sale or Return Ledger In the regular General ledger
w At the year end, in the Sale or return Ledger, the sum of the debit balances of the Individual Customers’
Account must be equal to the credit balance of the Sale or return Account. It represents Inventories with
customers waiting for approval at invoice price. To adjust the cost of such goods with customers in the
Final Accounts, the following entry is passed:
Inventories with Customers on Sale or Return Account Dr. [Cost or net realisable
To Trading Account value whichever is less]
In short, under this method, entries are passed in the regular books of account only at the time of sale or a
year end, if inventory is still lying with customers (pending approval).
SUMMARY
• As per the definition given under the Sale of Goods Act, 1930, in respect of such goods, the sale will take
place or the property in the goods pass to the buyer:
(i) When he signifies his approval or acceptance to the seller;
(ii) When he does some act adopting the transaction;
(iii) If he does not signify his approval or acceptance to the seller but retains the goods without giving
notice of rejection, on the expiry of the specified time (if a time has been fixed) or on the expiry of
a reasonable time
• Accounting entries depend on the fact whether the business sends goods on sale or approval basis (i)
casually; (ii) frequently; and (iii) numerously.
1. Goods sold on approval or return basis are not recorded as credit sales initially when they are sent out.
2. The customer retains the goods even after the expiry of the mentioned term, but this act does not
confirm to sale of goods as there is no express consent given.
3. At the end of the year- those goods on approval basis awaiting approval from the customer are shown
as part of sales in the books of the seller.
4. No entry needs to be passed in the books of the seller, when the customer rejects the goods awaiting
approval after the closing of the books of the seller.
5. The period within which the customer has to reject or accept is fixed by the buyer.
6. Mere transfer of the possession of the goods from the seller to the customer under sale on approval
basis, also ensure transfer of ownership to customer.
Multiple Choice Questions
1. When a large number of articles are sent frequently on a sale or return basis, it is necessary to maintain
(a) Sale journal (b) Goods returned journal (c) Sale or return journal
2. Sale or Return Day Book and Sale or Return Ledger are known as
(a) principal books (b) subsidiary books (c) memorandum books
3. A sent some goods costing ` 3,500 at a profit of 25% on sale to B on sale or return basis. B returned
goods costing ` 800. At the end of the accounting period i.e. on 31st December, 2020, the remaining
goods were neither returned nor were approved by him. The Inventories on approval will be shown in
the balance sheet at `
Theory Questions
Q1. What are the features of sale of goods on approval or return basis? Explain in brief.
Q2. When ‘sale or return basis’ transactions are numerous, what books are maintained by the business
entity.
Practical Questions
Q1 A firm sends goods on sale or return basis. Customers having the choice of returning the goods within
a month. During May 2020, the following are the details of goods sent:
Date (May) 2 8 12 18 20 27
Customers P B Q D E R
Value (`) 15,000 20,000 28,000 3,000 1,000 26,000
Within the stipulated time, P and Q returned the goods and B, D, and E signified that they have accepted
the goods.
Show in the books of the firm, the Sale or Return Account and Customer- P for Sale or Return Account
on 15th June, 2020.
Q2 On 31st December, 2020 goods sold at a sale price of ` 3,000 were lying with customer, Ritu to whom
these goods were sold on ‘sale or return basis’ were recorded as actual sales. Since no consent has been
received from Ritu, you are required to pass adjustment entries presuming goods were sent on approval
at a profit of cost plus 20%. Present market price is 10% less than the cost price.
Q3 X supplied goods on sale or return basis to customers, the particulars of which are as under.
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. False: They are recorded as sales irrespective of whether the customer might accept or reject the goods
at the end of the period given for the approval.
2. False: As per the Sale of goods Act, when the goods are retained by the customer after the given time
and no express intimation is given with regard to rejection- they are deemed sales.
3. False: At the end of the accounting period- if there are goods sold on approval or return basis, without
any information, then the accounting treatment s to reverse the same from the sales and to add it with
the existing closing stock at cost price.
4. True: At the end, already the entries pertaining to the reversal of the sale and the addition to the closing
stock would have been passed. If subsequently if the customer rejects the goods, no further entry needs
to be passed
5. False: It is the seller who fixes the terms of the period within which the customer has to get back with
the answer of rejection or accepting the goods.
6. False: Only upon accepting the goods expressly or doing some act, inconsistent with the title of goods,
the ownership and risk associated with the goods pass on to the buyer. Mere transfer of possession
does no convey ownership.
MCQs
Theoretical Questions
1. Features of sale of goods on approval or return basis: (i) There is a change in the possession of goods
from one person to another. (ii) It does not involve transfer of ownership of goods. The ownership is
passed only when the retailer gives his approval or if the goods are not returned within that specified
period. (iii) The retailer (customer) does not incur any liability when the goods are merely sent to him.
2. When transactions are numerous, a business maintains the following books: (a) Sale or Return Day Book;
and (b) Sale or Return Ledger. ‘Ledger’ contains the accounts of the customers and the ‘Sale or Return’
Total account. ‘Day Book’ is the primary book which records all transactions, and from there these are
entered in the ‘Sale or Return’ Total account. It is important to remember that both are Memorandum
Books, i.e., these records are not a part of regular books of accounts.
Practical Questions
Answer 1
Sale or Return Account
Date Particulars ` `
2020
31st Dec. Sales A/c Dr. 3,000
To Ritu’s A/c 3,000
(Being cancellation of entry for sale of goods, not yet
approved)
Inventories with customers A/c (Refer W.N.) Dr. 2,250
To Trading A/c 2,250
(Being Inventories with customers recorded at market
price)
Working Note:
Calculation of cost and market price of Inventories with customer
Answer 3
In the books of ‘X’
Goods on sales or return, sold and returned day book.
UNIT 3 : CONSIGNMENT
LEARNING OUTCOMES
After studying this unit, you will be able to:
w Understand the special features of consignment business, meaning of the terms consignor and
consignee.
w Analyse the difference between the two transactions – sale and consignment and understand that why
consignment is termed as special transaction.
w Practice the accounting treatments for consignment transactions and events in the books of consignor
and consignee.
w Note the variations in accounting when goods are sent at cost and goods are sent above the cost.
w Learn the technique of computing value of consignment inventory lying with the consignee and also
the amount of inventory reserve in it.
w Learn the technique of computing cost of abnormal loss and treatment of insurance claim in relation to
it.
w Understand the distinction between ordinary commission, del-credere commission and over-riding
commission paid to the consignee.
w See the variation of accounting treatment for bad debts when consignee is paid ordinary commission
and when consignee is paid del-credere commission in addition to it.
w Understand the reason of including/excluding various expenditures to cost while valuing the goods
returned by the consignee.
Goods Consigned
Consignor Consignee
Account Sales
Commission earned
3.2 DISTINCTIONS
3.2.1 CONSIGNMENT AND SALE
4. The relationship between the consignor and The relationship between the seller and the
the consignee is that of a principal and agent. buyer is that of a creditor and a debtor.
5. Expenses done by the consignee to receive the Expenses incurred by the buyer are to be borne
goods and to keep it safely are borne by the by the buyer itself after the transfer of goods.
consignor unless there is any other agreement.
Commission Discount
Commission may be defined as remuneration The term discount refers to any reduction or
of an employee or agent relating to services rebate allowed and is used to express one of the
performed in connection with sales, following situations:
purchases, collections or other types of
An allowance given for the settlement of a debt
business transactions and is usually based on a
before it is due i.e. cash discount.
percentage of the amounts involved.
Commission earned is accounted for as An allowance given to the whole sellers or bulk
an income in the books of accounts, and buyers on the list price or retail price, known as
commission allowed or paid is accounted for as trade discount. A trade discount is not shown in
an expense in the books of the party availing the books of account separately and it is shown
such facility or service. by way of deduction from cost of purchases.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Exe sent on 1st July, 2019 to Wye goods costing ` 50,000 and spent ` 1,000 on packing etc. On 3rd July, 2019, Wye
received the goods and sent his acceptance to Exe for ` 30,000 payable at 3 months. Wye spent ` 2,000 on freight
and cartage, ` 500 on godown rent and ` 300 on insurance. On 31st December, 2019 he sent his Account Sales
(along with the amount due to Exe) showing that 4/5 of the goods had been sold for ` 55,000. Wye is entitled to
a commission of 10%. One of the customers turned insolvent and could not pay ` 600 due from him. Show the
necessary journal entries in the books of consignor. Also prepare ledger accounts.
SOLUTION
Journal Entries in the books of Consignor
` `
1 Open Consignment Account and debit it with the cost of goods and
credit it with “Goods sent on Consignment Account”.
1/7/2019 Consignment to Wye A/c Dr. 50,000
To Goods Sent on Consignment A/c 50,000
2 For the expenses incurred by the consignor,debit Consignment
Account and credit cash or Bank, as the case may be.
1/7/2019 Consignment to Wye A/c Dr. 1,000
To Bank A/c 1,000
3 If the consignee sends an advance, debit Cash(or Bank) or Bills
Receivable and credit the consignee’s personal account
3/7/2019 Bills Receivable A/c Dr. 30,000
To Wye 30,000
(Note: Wye’s account has appeared only now, in the previous
two entries his account did not figure since he is not personally
involved)
4 Wye’s acceptance will mature on 6/10/2019
Assuming it was met, the entry will be:
6/10/2019 Bank A/c Dr. 30,000
To Bills Receivable A/c 30,000
(Note: If such bill is discounted by consignor with the bank before
maturity, pass usual entry for discounting a bill. The discount on
bills may either be treated as consignment expenses and charged to
Consignment A/c or it may be treated as general financial charges
and charged to Profit & Loss Account)
Note: Sometimes an examination problem states only that the consignor’s expenses amounted
to such amount and that consignee spent so much. If details are not available, then for valuing
inventories the expenses incurred by the consignor should be treated as part of cost while those
incurred by the consignee should be ignored.
If the expected selling price of inventories on hand is lower than the cost, the inventories should be valued
at expected net selling price only, i.e. expected selling price less delivery expenses, etc.
Particulars ` `
(i) Consignment to Wye A/c Dr. 60,000
To Goods sent on Consignment A/c 60,000
(ii) Consignment to Wye A/c Dr. 1,000
To Bank 1,000
(iii) Bills Receivable A/c Dr. 30,000
To Wye 30,000
(iv) Bank A/c Dr. 30,000
To Bills Receivable A/c 30,000
(v) Wye Dr. 55,000
To Consignment to Wye A/c 55,000
(vi) Consignment to Wye A/c Dr. 3,400
To Wye 3,400
77,600 77,600
2019 ` 2019 `
Dec. 31 To Consignment to Wye A/c – 10,000 1-Jul By Consignment to Wye A/c 60,000
loading
To Trading A/c –transfer 50,000
(bal.fig.)
60,000 60,000
Inventories on Consignment Account
2019 ` 2019 `
Dec. 31 To Consignment to Wye A/c 12,600 Dec. 31 By Balance c/d 12,600
2017
Jan. 1 Balance b/d 12,600
`
Inventories on consignment 12,600
Less: Inventory Reserve 2,000
10,600
What would be the situation if the commission to Wye includes del-credere commission also?
In that case Wye would not be able to charge the bad debt of ` 600 to Exe; he will have to bear the loss
himself. The student can see that then the profit on consignment will be ` 6,300.
In this regard it is to be noted that when del – credere commission is paid to the consignee, the consignee
account is debited in the books of consignor for both cash and credit sales. But if no such del – credere
commission is paid then consignee account cannot be debited for credit sales and in that case the following
entry is passed in the books of consignor for credit sales.
Consignment Trade receivables A/c Dr.
To Consignment A/c
The difference is because in case del-credere commission is paid to consignee then consignee is responsible
to bear any loss of bad debts and he will have to pay full amount of sales to consigner. Accordingly, in the
books of consignor, whole amount (cash sales plus credit sales) is shown as receivable from consignee. On
the other hand if del-credere commission is not paid than consignor is responsible to bear loss of bad debts,
therefore, till the time consignee has not received money from customers, it is not shown as receivable from
consignee.
3.8 COMMISSION
Commission is the remuneration paid by the consignor to the consignee for the services rendered to the
former for selling the consigned goods. Three types of commission can be provided by the consignor to the
consignee, as per the agreement, either simultaneously or in isolation. They are:
? ILLUSTRATION 2
Exe sent on 1st July, 2019 to Wye goods costing ` 50,000 and spent ` 1,000 on packing etc. On 3rd July, 2019, Wye
received the goods and sent his acceptance to Exe for ` 30,000 payable at 3 months. Wye spent ` 2,000 on freight
and cartage, ` 500 on godown rent and ` 300 on insurance. On 31st December, 2019 he sent his Account Sales
(along with the amount due to Exe) showing that 4/5 of the goods had been sold for ` 55,000. Wye is entitled to
a commission of 10%. One of the customers turned insolvent and could not pay ` 600 due from him. Show the
necessary journal entries in the consignee’s book.
SOLUTION
Journal Entries in the books of Consignee
2019 Particulars ` `
1 On sending the acceptance to Exe
July 3 Exe Dr. 30,000
To Bills Payable A/c 30,000
2 On meeting expenses on the consignment:
July 3 Exe Dr. 2,800
To Bank 2,800
3 On meeting his acceptance:
Oct. 6 Bills payable Dr. 30,000
To Bank 30,000
4 On sales being effected:
Trade receivables/Bank Dr. 55,000
To Exe 55,000
5 On there being a bad debt:
Exe Dr. 600
To Trade receivables 600
6 On earning the commission:
Exe Dr. 5,500
To Commission Earned A/c 5,500
7 On settling the account to Exe:
Exe Dr. 16,100
To Bank 16,100
If the commission includes del-credere commission also, he would not be able to debit Exe for the bad debt.
In that case the debit should be to the Commission Earned Account whose net balance will then be `4,900
and he will have to pay `16,700 to Exe.
? ILLUSTRATION 3
1,000 toys consigned by Rosie & Co. of Calcutta to Sahoo of Srinagar at a cost of `150 each. Rosie & Co. paid
freight ` 10,000 and insurance ` 1,500. During the voyage 100 toys were totally damaged by fire and had to be
thrown overboard. Sahoo took delivery of the remaining toys and paid `14,400 as customs duty. Sahoo sent a
bank draft to Roy & Co. for `50,000 as advance payment and later sent an account sales showing that 800 toys
had been sold at `220 each. Expenses incurred by Sahoo on go-down rent and advertisement, etc., amounted
to `2,000. Sahoo was entitled to commission of 5 per cent. One of the credit customers could not pay for 5 toys.
You are required to prepare the Consignment Account, Goods sent on consignment, Inventories on consignment
account and Sahoo’s a/c in the books of Rosie & Co., assuming that nothing has been recovered from the insurers
due to a defect in the policy. Sahoo settled his account immediately.
SOLUTION
In the books of M/s Rosie & Co
Dr. Consignment to Sahoo Account Cr
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Goods sent on Consignment A/c 1,50,000 By Sahoo- sale Proceeds 1,76,000
To Bank(expenses) 11,500 By Abnormal loss Ac (loss by fire) 16,150
Freight 10,000
Insurance 1,500
To Sahoo-expenses 26300 By Inventories on consignment
Customs duty 14,400
17,750
Sundry expenses 2,000
Commission (5%) 8,800
Bad debt (220*5) 1,100
To P&L Account-transfer of profit 22,100
2,09,900 2,09,900
Dr. Goods sent on consignment account Cr
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Trading A/c 1,50,000 By Consignment to Sahoo A/c 1,50,000
1,50,000 1,50,000
Dr. Inventories on Consignment account Cr
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Consignment to Wye A/c 17,750 By Balance c/d 17,750
17,750 17,750
Dr. Sahoo’s account Cr
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Consignment to Sahoo Ac 1,76,000 By bank (bank draft as advance) 50,000
By consignment to Sahoo A/c
Customs duty 14,400
Sundry expenses 2,000
Commission 8,800
Bad debts 1,100 26300
By balance amount remitted 99,700
1,76,000 1,76,000
Working notes :
(a) Computation of the abnormal loss- 100 toys
a. Cost of 100 toys 100*150 15000
b. Freight charges- 100 toys 10000/1000*100 1000
c. Insurance- 100 toys 1500/1000*100 150
a. Abnormal loss 16,150
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING FOR SPECIAL TRANSACTIONS 6.65
? ILLUSTRATION 4
Nike sports Co. of New Delhi consigned 100 shoes to Adidas Co. of Ahmedabad costing ` 1,500 each, invoiced at
` 2,000 each. The consignor paid freight ` 10,000 and insurance in transit ` 1,500. During transit, 10 shoes were
totally damaged.
Adidas Co took delivery of remaining shoes and paid ` 1,530 for octroi duty. Adidas co. sent a bank draft to Nike
sports Co. for Rs 50,000 as advance and later on sent an account sales showing that 80 shoes had been sold @
` 2,200 each. Expenses incurred by Adidas Co. on godown rent were ` 2,000. Adidas Co. is entitled to a commission
of 5% on invoice price and 25% on any surplus of sale price over invoice price. Insurance claim was settled at
` 14,000.
Prepare consignment account, consignee’s account and the related working notes account in the books of the
Nike sports Co.
SOLUTION
In the books of M/s Nike sports Co.
Dr. Consignment to Adidas Co. Account Cr
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Goods sent on Consignment A/c 2,00,000 By goods sent on consignment 50,000
To Bank (expenses) 11,500 By Adidas Co- sale Proceeds 1,76,000
Freight 10,000
Insurance 1,500
To Adidas Co.-expenses 15,530 By Abnormal loss Ac (loss in transit) 16,150
Octroi duty 1,530
Go-down rent 2,000
Commission (WN) 12,000
To Reserve on closing stock 5,000 By Inventories on consignment 21,320
To P&L Account-transfer of profit 31,440
2,63,470 2,63,470
? ILLUSTRATION 5
Miss Rakhi consigned 1,000 radio sets costing `900 each to Miss Geeta, her agent on 1st July, 2020. Miss Rakhi
incurred the following expenditure on sending the consignment.
Freight ` 7,650
Insurance ` 3,250
Miss Geeta received the delivery of 950 radio sets. An account sale dated 30th November, 2020 showed that 750
sets were sold for `9,00,000 and Miss Geeta incurred `10,500 for carriage.
Miss Geeta was entitled to commission 6% on the sales effected by her. She incurred expenses amounting to
`2,500 for repairing the damaged radio sets remaining in the inventories.
Miss Rakhi lodged a claim with the insurance company which was admitted at `35,000. Show the Consignment
Account and Miss Geeta’s Account in the books of Miss Rakhi.
SOLUTION
In the books of Miss Rakhi
Consignment Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Goods sent on By Miss Geeta 9,00,000
Consignment A/c 9,00,000 By Insurance Co. 35,000
By Profit & Loss A/c
To Cash abnormal loss(net) 10,545
Freight 7,650 By Consignment
Insurance 3,250 10,900 Inventories 1,84,391
To Miss Geeta
Carriage 10,500
Repairs 2,500
Commission 54,000 67,000
To Profit & Loss A/c 1,52,036
11,29,936 11,29,936
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
6.68 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
1. Abnormal loss :
Cost to the consignor: 50 sets @ ` 900 45,000
50 × 10,900
Add: Proportionate expenses incurred by the consignor
1,000 545
Gross abnormal loss 45,545
Less: Insurance claim (35,000)
Net abnormal loss 10,545
2. Valuation of Inventories
200 sets @ ` 900 1,80,000
200 × 10,900 2,180
Add: Proportionate expenses of the consignor
1,000
2,211
Add: Carriage and customs duty paid by the consignee 200 × 10,500
950
1,84,391
? ILLUSTRATION 6
Vikram Milk Foods Co. Ltd. of Vikrampur sent to Sunder Stores, Sonepuri 5,000 kgs of baby food packed in 2,000
tins of net weight 1 kg and 6,000 packets of net weight 1/2 kg for sale on consignment basis. The consignee’s
commission was fixed at 5% of sale proceeds. The cost price and selling price of the product were as under:
SOLUTION
Vikram Milk Foods Co. Ltd.
Consignment to Sonepuri Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Goods sent on By Sunder Stores
Consignment A/c
2,000 1 kg. tins @ ` 10 20,000 1,500 1 kg. tins @ ` 15 22,500
6,000 1/2 kg. pkts. @ ` 6 36,000 56,000 4,000 1/2 kg. pkts. @ ` 7 28,000 50,500
To Sunder Stores: By Insurance - Claim 450
Freight 1,440 By Profit & Loss A/c -
Rent and insurance 600 abnormal loss(Net) 65
Commission 2,525 4,565 By Inventory on 16,915
consignment A/c
To Profit & Loss A/c – 7,365
Profit
67,930 67,930
Sunder Stores, Sonepuri
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Consignment to Sonepuri By Consignment to
Account - Sales Proceeds 50,500 Sonepuri Account -
Freight 1,440
Rent & Insurance 600
Commission 2,525
By Bank(Bal. fig) 45,935
50,500 50,500
Working Notes:
? ILLUSTRATION 7
Shri Mehta of Mumbai consigns 1,000 cases of goods costing ` 1,000 each to Shri Sundaram of Chennai. Shri
Mehta pays the following expenses in connection with consignment:
`
Carriage 10,000
Freight 30,000
Loading charges 10,000
Shri Sundaram sells 700 cases at ` 1,400 per case and incurs the following expenses:
Clearing charges 8,500
Warehousing and storage 17,000
Packing and selling expenses 6,000
It is found that 50 cases have been lost in transit and 100 cases are still in transit.
Shri Sundaram is entitled to a commission of 10% on gross sales. Draw up the Consignment Account and
Sundaram’s Account in the books of Shri Mehta.
SOLUTION
In the books of Shri Mehta
Consignment to Sundaram of Chennai Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Goods sent on By Sundaram (Sales) 9,80,000
Consignment 10,00,000 By Loss in Transit 50 cases 52,500
@ `1,050 each
To Bank (Expenses) 50,000 By Consignment Inventories
To Sundaram (Expenses) 31,500 In hand 150 @ ` 1,060 each 1,59,000
Sundaram’s Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Consignment to Chennai A/c 9,80,000 By Consignment A/c
(Expenses) 31,500
By Consignment A/c
(Commission) 98,000
By Balance c/d 8,50,500
9,80,000 9,80,000
Working Notes:
(i) Consignor’s expenses on 1,000 cases amounts to `50,000; it comes to `50 per case. The cost of cases lost
will be computed at `1,050 per case.
(ii) Sundaram has incurred ` 8,500 on clearing 850 cases, i.e., `10 per case; while valuing closing inventories
with the agent `10 per case has been added to cases in hand with the agent.
(iii) It has been assumed that balance of `8,50,500 is not yet paid.
? ILLUSTRATION 8
Ajay of Mumbai consigned to Vijay of Delhi, goods to be sold at invoice price which represents 125% of cost. Vijay
is entitled to a commission of 10% on sales at invoice price and 25% of any excess realised over invoice price. The
expenses on freight and insurance incurred by Ajay were `10,000. The account sales received by Ajay shows that
Vijay has effected sales amounting to `1,00,000 in respect of 75% of the consignment. His selling expenses to be
reimbursed were ` 8,000. 10% of consignment goods of the value of `12,500 were destroyed in fire at the Delhi
godown and the insurance company paid `12,000 net of salvage. Vijay remitted the balance in favour of Ajay.
Prepare consignment account and the account of Vijay in the books of Ajay along with the necessary calculations.
SOLUTION
Books of Ajay
Consignment to Vijay Account
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Goods sent on 1,25,000 By Goods sent on 25,000
Consignment A/c Consignment A/c (Loading)
To Cash A/c 10,000 By Abnormal Loss 11,000
To Vijay(Expenses) 8,000 By Vijay (Sales) 1,00,000
Particulars ` Particulars `
To Consignment A/c 1,00,000 By Consignment A/c 8,000
By Consignment A/c 10,938
By Bank A/c 81,062
1,00,000 1,00,000
Working Notes:
1. Calculation of value of goods sent on consignment:
Abnormal Loss at Invoice price = ` 12,500.
Abnormal Loss as a percentage of total consignment = 10%.
Hence the value of goods sent on consignment = ` 12,500 X 100/ 10 = ` 1,25,000.
Loading of goods sent on consignment = ` 1,25,000 X 25/125 = ` 25,000.
Note:
1. It has been assumed that final payment received from Vijay.
2. Abnormal loss is always calculated at cost even if invoice price of goods is given.
3. Value of inventories always valued at invoice price if invoice price is given.
SUMMARY
w In Consignment one person (consignor) sends goods to another person (consignee) to be sold on
behalf of and at the risk of the former.
w In the case of consignment, cost means not only the cost of the goods as such to the consignor but
also all expenses incurred till the goods reaches the premises of the consignee. Such expenses include
packaging, freight, cartage, insurance in transit, octroi, etc.
w Expenses incurred after the goods have reached the consignee’s godown (such as godown rent,
insurance of godown, delivery charges) are not treated as part of the cost of purchase for valuing
inventories on hand.
w If the expected selling price of inventories on hand is lower than the cost, the value put on the
inventories should be expected net selling price only, i.e. expected selling price less delivery expenses,
etc.i.e. expenses necessary for sales.
w Proforma invoice is made to show the high value of goods consigned than the cost and entries in the
books of the consignor are made out on that basis. Even the inventories remaining unsold will initially
be valued on the basis of the invoice price.
w Hence, if entries are first made on invoice basis, the effect of the loading (i.e., amount added to arrive at
the invoice price) must be removed by additional entries to ascertain profit or loss.
w Abnormal loss is valued just like inventories in hand. Students should be careful while valuing goods
lost in transit and goods lost in consignee’s godown. Both are abnormal loss but in case of former
consignee’s non-recurring expenses are not to be included whereas it is to be included in case of latter.
w Normal loss, is an unavoidable loss and be spread over the entire consignment while valuing inventories.
The total cost plus expenses incurred should be divided by the quantity available after the normal loss
to ascertain the cost per unit.
w Commission is the remuneration paid by the consignor to the consignee for the services rendered to the
former for selling the consigned goods. Three types of commission can be provided by the consignor to
the consignee, as per the agreement, either simultaneously or in isolation. They are:
ª Ordinary commission
ª Del-credere commission
ª Over-riding commission
w For accounting of consignee, he is concerned only when he sends an advance to the consignor, makes a
sale, incurs expenses on the consignment and earns his commission. He debits or credits the consignor
for all these as the case may be.
w Abnormal loss is always calculated at cost even if invoice price of goods is given.
w Value of inventories always valued at invoice price if invoice price is given.
6 Out of the following at which point the treatment of “Sales” and “Consignment” is same:
(a) Ownership transfer.
(b) Money receive.
(c) Inventories outflow.
7 If del-credere commission is allowed for bad debt, consignee will debit the bad debt amount to:
(a) Commission Earned A/c
(b) Consignor’s A/c
(c) Trade receivables (Customers) A/c
8 A proforma invoice is sent by:
(a) Consignee to Consignor
(b) Consignor to Consignee
(c) Customer/Debtors to Consignee
9 Which of the following statement is correct:
(a) Consignee will pass a journal entry in his books at the time of receiving goods from consignor.
(b) Consignee will not pass any journal entry in his books at the time of receiving goods from consignor.
(c) The ownership of goods will be transferred to consignee at the time of receiving the goods.
10 Consignment Inventories will be recorded in the balance sheet of consignor on asset side at:
(a) Invoice Value
(b) At Invoice value less Inventories reserve
(c) At lower than cost price
11 Which of the following expenses of consignee will be considered as non-selling expenses:
(a) Advertisement
(b) Insurance on freight inward
(c) Selling Expenses
12 The consignment accounting is made on the following basis:
(a) Accrual
(b) Realisation
(c) Cash Basis
13 Which of the following item is not credited to consignment account?
(a) Cash sales made by consignee
(b) Credit sales made by consignee
(c) Inventories Reserve on closing consignment Inventories
Theory Questions
Q1. Write short notes on:
(i) Del-credere commission.
(ii) Account sales.
(iii) Over-riding commission.
Q2. Distinguish between:
(i) Consignment sale and Normal sale.
(ii) Commission and Discount.
Practical Questions
Q1. X of Delhi purchased 10,000 metres of cloth for `2,00,000 of which 5,000 metres were sent on
consignment to Y of Agra at the selling price of ` 30 per metre. X paid ` 5,000 for freight and ` 500 for
packing etc.
Y sold 4,000 metre at ` 40 per metre and incurred ` 2,000 for selling expenses. Y is entitled to a
commission of 5% on total sales proceeds plus a further 20% on any surplus price realised over ` 30
per metre. 3,000 metres were sold at Delhi at ` 30 per metre less ` 3,000 for expenses and commission.
Owing to fall in market price, the inventories of cloth in hand is to be reduced by 10%.
Prepare the Consignment Account and Trading and Profit & Loss Account in books of X.
Q2. D of Delhi appointed A of Agra as its selling agent on the following terms:
Goods to be sold at invoice price or over.
A to be entitled to a commission of 7.5% on the invoice price and 20% of any surplus price realized over
invoice price
The principals to draw on the agent a 30 days bill for 80% of the invoice price.
On 1st February, 2020, 1,000 cycles were consigned to A, each cycle costing ` 640 including freight and
invoiced at ` 800.
Before 31st March, 2020, (when the principal’s books are closed) A met his acceptance on the due date;
sold off 820 cycles at an average price of ` 930 per cycle, the sale expenses being ` 12,500; and remitted
the amount due by means of Bank draft.
Twenty of the unsold cycles were shop-spoiled and were to be valued at a depreciation of 50% of cost.
Show by means of ledger accounts how these transactions would be recorded in the books of A and
find out the value of closing inventory with A to be recorded in the books of D at cost.
Q3. Mr. Y consigned 800 packets of toothpaste, each packet containing 100 toothpastes. Cost price of each
packet was ` 900. Mr. Y Spent ` 100 per packet as cartage, freight, insurance and forwarding charges.
One packet was lost on the way and Mr. Y lodged claim with the insurance company and could get `570
as claim on average basis. Consignee took delivery of the rest of the packets and spent ` 39,950 as other
non-recurring expenses and ` 22,500 as recurring expenses. He sold 740 packets at the rate of ` 12 per
toothpaste. He was entitled to 2% commission on sales plus 1% del-credere commission.
You are required to prepare Consignment Account. Calculate the cost of inventories at the end, abnormal
loss and profit or loss on consignment.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
ACCOUNTING FOR SPECIAL TRANSACTIONS 6.77
Q4 A of Agra sent on consignment goods valued ` 1,00,000 to B of Mumbai on 1st March, 2019. He incurred
the expenditure of ` 12,000 on freight and insurance. A’s accounting year closes on 31st December. B
was entitled to a commission of 5% on gross sales plus a del-credere commission of 3%. B took delivery
of the consignment by incurring expenses of ` 3,000 for goods consigned.
On 31.12.2019, B informed on phone that he had sold all the goods for ` 1,50,000 by incurring selling
expenses of ` 2,000. He further informed that only ` 1,48,000 had been realized and rest was considered
irrecoverable, and would be sending the cheque in a day or so for the amount due along with the
accounts sale.
On 5.1.2020, A received the cheque for the amount due from B and incurred bank charges of ` 260 for
collecting the cheque. The amount was credited by the bank on 9.1.2020.
Write up the consignment account finding out the profit/loss on the consignment, B’s account, Provision
for expenses account and Bank account in the books of the consignor, recording the transactions upto
the receipt and collection of the cheque.
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. False: The abnormal loss is credited to the consignment account since it is a reduction in the value
of the stock. Alternatively it can be credited to the trading account of the consignor too as there is
reduction from the stock of the goods.
2. False: The sales account shows the balance receivable on account of the sales- both cash and credit.
Whereas the account sales statement is given by the consignee to the consignor on a periodical basis
detailing the transactions done by the former.
3. True: The consignor is the owner of the goods sent on consignment. Consignee is a mere agent
appointed to sell the goods for a commission and the mere transfer of possession does not entitle
consignee to become the owner of the goods.
4. False: The del-credere commission is the commission paid to the consignee for bearing the loss of the
bad debts if any.
5. True: It is the consignor who has to record the closing stock of the consigned goods since he is the
owner of the goods. There is no entry passed in the books of the consignee.
6. False: It is a nominal account recording the expenses on the debit and the income on the credit side,
balance being the profit/ loss on the consignment account to the trading account.
7. False: Proforma invoice is given by the consignor to the consignee with regard to the goods sent on
consignment and their price.
8. False: If del credere commission is given to the consignee then, the bad debts are taken into the
accounts of the consignee. It will not appear in the consignment account.
9. False: Abnormal loss occurs due to unforeseen circumstances, but if necessary steps are taken they can
be controlled, it is only the natural loss which cannot be controlled since it occurs due to nature of the
product.
10. False: The relationship between the consignor and the consignee is that of a principal and agent. It is
mere arrangement for sale of goods on behalf of the consignor.
MCQs
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13
(a) (a) (b) (a) (c) (c) (a) (b) (b) (b) (b) (a) (c)
Theoretical Questions
1 (i) Del-credere commission is an additional commission paid by the consignor to the consignee
for undertaking responsibility of collection of debts. Generally, the consignee gets ordinary
commission for sales made by him as a percentage of gross sales, over and above, he may get del-
credere commission for the additional responsibility of debt collection. Sometimes it is agreed that
del-credere commission shall be allowed on credit sales only. However, in the absence of any such
agreement the consignor allows del-credere commission on total sales and not merely on credit
sales. If the consignee is entitled to del-credere commission, he has to bear the bad debts; if any,
arising, out of credit sale of consignment goods.
(ii) Account sales is a periodic statement furnished by the consignee to the consignor stating therein,
the quantity sold, price charged, expenses incurred on behalf of the consignee and commission
payable to him in respect of a particular consignment, and the net amount due from him and
remittance received if any. It also shows the details of quantity of goods received, destroyed, if any,
and still held as stock.
(iii) Over-riding commission is an extra commission allowed to the consignee in addition to the normal
commission. Such additional commission is generally allowed:-
To provide additional incentive to the consignee for the purpose of introducing and creating a
market for a new product.
To provide incentive for supervising the performance of other agents in a particular area.
To provide incentive for ensuring that the goods are sold by the consignee at the highest possible
price.
2. (i) In case of consignment, the property in the goods remains with the consignor until the goods are
actually sold. The consignee acts only as a custodian of goods sent by consignor. In consignment,
the ownership of goods does not pass on to the consignee in any case. In case of ordinary sale, the
ownership of goods passes to the buyer immediately after sale. In case of consignment, the risk
attached to the goods remain with the consignor even after sending the goods to the consignee.
However, in case of ordinary sale, as soon as the property in the goods passes on to the buyers, the
risk attached to the goods also passes at the same time. The relationship between consignor and
consignee is that of principal and agent. In case of credit sale, the relationship between the buyer
and the seller is that of a debtor and a creditor.
(ii) Commission may be defined as remuneration of an employee or agent relating to services
performed in connection with sales, purchases, collections or other types of business transactions
and is usually based on a percentage of the amounts involved.
Commission earned is accounted for as an income in the books of accounts, and commission
allowed or paid is accounted for as an expense in the books of the party availing such facility or
service.
The term discount refers to any reduction or rebate allowed and is used to express one of the
following situations:
An allowance given for the settlement of a debt before it is due i.e. cash discount.
An allowance given to the whole sellers or bulk buyers on the list price or retail price, known as
trade discount. A trade discount is not shown in the books of account separately and it is shown by
way of deduction from cost of purchases.
Practical Questions
ANSWER 1
In the books of Mr. X
Consignment Account
2020 ` 2020 `
Feb. 1 To Bills payable A/c 6,40,000 Mar. 31 By Cash/Bank A/c (820x `930) 7,62,600
(80% of ` 8,00,000)
Mar. 31 To Cash A/c (expenses) 12,500
To Commission earned A/c 70,520
To Bank A/c 39,580 _______
7,62,600 7,62,600
2020 ` 2020 `
Mar. 4 To Cash/Bank A/c 6,40,000 Feb. 1 By D’s A/c 6,40,000
6,40,000 6,40,000
`
160 cycles at ` 640 (cost price including freight) 1,02,400
20 cycles (shop-spoiled) at 50% of the cost i.e. at ` 320 each 6,400
Value of closing inventory with A i.e. the amount (net effect of the loading) at which D _______
will account for in his books on 31st March, 2020
1,08,800
Working Note:
CALCULATION OF COMMISSION:
`
7.5 % on the invoice price amount (820x ` 800) i.e. ` 6,56,000 49,200
20% on the surplus price amount (820 x ` 130) ` 1,06,600 21,320
70,520
2.
`
Abnormal loss:
Cost of packet lost during transit 900
Add: Expenses incurred by Y 100
Gross Abnormal loss 1,000
Less: Insurance claim received (570)
Net Abnormal loss 430
`
59 packets @ ` 900 53,100
Add: Expenses incurred by Y (59x `100) 5,900
Add: Proportionate (non-recurring) expenses incurred by the consignee
(59/799x `39,950) 2,950
61,950
4.
Closing inventories No. of packets
Packets consigned 800
Less: Packet lost in transit (1)
799
Less: Packets sold 740
59
ANSWER 3
Consignment Account
` `
To Goods sent on consignment A/c 7,20,000 By Consignee’s A/c-Sales 8,88,000
(800x ` 900) (740x100x `12)
To Cash A/c 80,000
(expenses 800x `100) By Abnormal Loss Cash A/c 570
(insurance claim)
To Consignee’s A/c: By Profit and loss account 430
Recurring expenses 22,500 (abnormal loss)
Non-recurring expenses 39,950 By Consignment stock A/c 61,950
Commission @ 2% on ` 8,88,000 17,760
Del-credere commission @ 1% on 8,880
` 8,88,000
To Profit and loss A/c 61,860
(profit on consignment)
9,50,950 9,50,950
ANSWER 4
In the books of Mr. A
Consignment to Mumbai Account
2019 ` 2019 `
March 1 To Goods sent on consignment A/c 1,00,000 Dec. 31 By B’s A/cs 1,50,000
To Cash A/c (freight and insurance) 12,000
To B’s A/c:
Clearance expenses 3,000
Selling expenses 2,000
Commission
@ 5% on ` 1,50,000 = 7,500
Del-credere commission @3% on 17,000
` 1,50,000 = 4,500
Dec. 31 To Provision for expenses 260
(bank charges)
To Profit and loss A/c 20,740
(profit on consignment)
1,50,000 1,50,000
B’s Account
2019 ` 2019 `
Dec. 31 To Consignment A/c 1,50,000 Dec. 31 By Consignment A/c-
Clearance expenses 3,000
Selling expenses 2,000
Commission 7,500
Del-credere commission 4,500 17,000
By Balance c/d 1,33,000
1,50,000 1,50,000
2020 2020
Jan. 1 To Balance b/d 1,33,000 Jan. 5 By Bank A/c 1,33,000
Bank Account
2020 ` 2020 `
Jan. 5 To B’s account 1,33,000 Jan. 5 By Bank charges 260
Jan. 5 By Balance c/d 1,32,740
1,33,000 1,33,000
Provision for Expenses Account
2020 ` 2020 `
Jan. 5 To Bank charges 260 Jan. 1 By Balance b/d 260
260 260
w Understand what is average due date and how to choose 0 (zero) day for calculating average due date.
w Learn calculation of average due date where amount is lent in various instalments.
w Familiarize with the steps involved in calculation of average due date where amount is lent in one
instalment but repayment is done in various instalments. Also understand days of grace and learn the
technique of maturity date by counting the days of grace.
UNIT OVERVIEW
Bill of
For calculation of Where amount
Exchnage/ Where amount
interest on drawings is lent in various is lent in one
Promissory
of partners instalments
Note instalment
If Bill/Invoice
is payable
at a stated no. of
on a specific date months(s)/days
after date
4.1 INTRODUCTION
In business enterprises, a large number of receipts and payments by and from a single party may occur
at different points of time. To simplify the calculation of interest involved for such transactions, the idea
of average due date has been developed. Where a person owing several amounts due on different dates,
desires to pay the total amount payable by him/her on a particular date, so that neither the debtor nor the
creditor stands to lose or gain anything by way of interest, that date is known as average due date. Average
Due Date is weighted average of due dates of various transactions where amount of each transaction is
used as weight. The unique feature of this approach is that the party making payment neither suffers any
loss nor gains anything by this arrangement of making a single payment. Average due date is generally used
in following circumstances:
Average due date: It is the mean or equated date on which a single total payment may be made in lieu
of different payments on different dates without any loss to either party.
Where payment is not made on the average due date, the party receiving the amount charges interest
for as many days as the payment is delayed from the average due date.
Points to be noted:
1. Selection of base date/ zero date: Such a date may be the due date of the first transaction or the due
date of the last transaction or any other due date between the first and the last but preferably earlier
due date may be taken.
2. While ascertaining the number of intervening days (plus or minus) between the base date and the due
date of each transaction ignore the first date and include the last day.
3. If due date is in fraction, round it off.
4. If amount is paid before due date, rebate is given.
5. If amount is paid after due date, then interest is charged.
6. Whenever there is a sale of goods by two persons to each other on different dates, the formula for
calculating average due date becomes:
Difference in products
Base date ±
Difference in amounts
4.2.2 Calculating Due Date of Bill or Note Payable Few Months after Date or Sight
When the bill is made payable at a stated number of months after date or after sight or after certain events,
then the period stated shall be held to terminate on the date of the month which corresponds with the day
on which the instrument is dated. If the month in which the period would terminate has no corresponding
day, the period shall be held to terminate on the last day of such month.
Example: A Bill due on 29th January, 2015 is made payable at one month after date. The due date of
instrument is 3rd day after 28th February, i.e., 3rd March (in 2015, February is of 28 days only).
4.2.3 Calculation of Due Date when the Maturity Day is a Holiday
When the day on which a promissory note or bill of exchange is at maturity (after including days of grace) is
a public holiday, the instrument shall be deemed to be due on the preceding business day. The expression
“public holiday” includes Sundays and other days declared by the Central Government by notification in the
official gazette, to be a public holiday. And now if the preceding day is also a public holiday, it will fall on the
day preceding the previous day. But if the holiday happens to be emergency or unforeseen holiday then the
date shall be the next following day.(Ref: Negotiable Instruments Act 1881).
w Case 1: Learn calculation of average due date where one Party is involved
w Case 2: Learn calculation of average due date where inter transactions between 2 Parties are involved
w Case 3: Learn calculation of average due date where amount is repaid in Instalments
w Case 4: Learn Calculation of average due date for determining interest on drawings.
Case 1: Learn calculation of average due date Where one Party is involved
Calculation of average due date
Under this type of problem, average due date is calculated as follows :
a. Take the earliest due date as starting day or base date or “O” day for convenience. Any date whatsoever,
may also be taken as “O” day.
b. Consider the number of days from base date up to each due date. Calculations may also be made in
month.
c. Multiply the number of days by the corresponding amounts.
d. Add up the amount and products.
e. Divide the “Product total” by “Amount total” and get result approximately upto a whole number.
f. This number is added in the base date to find the average due date.
Thus the formula for the average due date can be under.
Total of products
Average due date = Base date ±
Total amounts
Note: For calculation of no. of days, no. of days in each respective month involved are to be considered
individually.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
The followings are the amounts due on different dates in between the same parties:
Amount Due Date
`
500 3rd July
800 2nd August
1,000 11th September
Suggest a date on which all the bills may be paid out without any loss of interest to either party.
SOLUTION
Considering 3rd July as the starting day the following table is prepared:
Gain of Interest: 3rd July to 13th August and 2 August to 13th August
He however, gains interest, due to late payment on ` 500 for 41 days from 3rd July to 13th August and on
` 800 for 11 days i.e. ` 2.80 + ` 1.20, i.e., ` 4.
Thus, the debtor neither loses nor gains by payment of all the amounts on 13th August.
It should be noted that in calculating the number of days only one of the dates, either the starting date or
the due date is to be counted.
In the same manner, bill due to one party may be cancelled as against bills of same amount due from the
same party after adjustment of interest for the period elapsing between the two average due dates. Instead
of payment of several bills on the same date as above, other bill starting from the average due date for
agreed period together with interest for the period may be accepted.
? ILLUSTRATION 2
The following amounts are due to X by Y. Y wants to pay off (a) on 18th March or (b) on 14th July. Interest rate of
8% p.a. is taken into consideration.
Due Dates `
10th January 500
26th January (Republic Day) 1,000
23rd March 3,000
18th August (Sunday) 4,000
SOLUTION
Taking 10th January as the base date
11,07,000
Average Due Date = 10th Jan. + = 10th Jan + 131 days = 21st May
8500
January 21
February 28
March 31
April 30
110
(a) If the payment is made on 18th March rebate will be allowed for unexpired time from 18th March to 21th
May i.e., 13 + 30 + 21 i.e. for 64 days. He has to pay the discounted value of the total amount.
8 64 64
Discount = 8,500 x x = 680 x = ` 119.2
100 365 365
Amount to be paid on 18th March= ` (8,500 – 119.23) = ` 8,380.77
(b) If the payment is deferred to 14th July, interest is to be paid from 21th May to 14th July i.e., for
10 + 30 + 14 = 54 days.
8 54 54
Interest = 8,500 x x = 680 x = ` 100.6
100 365 365
The amount to be paid on 14th July.
` 8,500 + 100.6 = 8600.6
? ILLUSTRATION 3
SOLUTION
Calculation of Average Due Date
Taking 10th August 2019 as the base date
? ILLUSTRATION 4
A trader having accepted the following several bills falling due on different dates, now desires to have these bills
cancelled and to accept a new bill for the whole amount payable on the average due date :
Sl. No. Date of bill Amount Usance of the bill
1 1st March 2020 400 2 months
2 10th March 2020 300 3 months
3 5th April 2020 200 2 months
4 20th April 2020 375 1 month
5 11th May 2020 500 2 months
You are required to find the said average due date.
SOLUTION
Case 2: Learn calculation of average due date Where inter transactions between 2 Parties are involved
When more than one party is involved where one party purchase and also sells to other party like JK Tyres
and Maruti where Maruti sells car to JK Tyres for their employees and purchases Tyres from them. In such a
case instead of paying gross amount they may go for new amount i.e. Purchase amount and sales amount
will be set off and thus here we take difference of amount and produce as Net Amount. In such cases, earliest
date of both parties is taken as the base date.
? ILLUSTRATION 5
Two traders X and Y buy goods from one another, each allowing the other one month’s credit. At the end of 3
months the accounts rendered are as follows:
SOLUTION
Taking May 18th as the zero or base date ( April 18 +One month Credit=18 May)
For Y’s payments:
The students should note that the same base date should be taken. Therefore, the base date will be May
18th in this case also.
? ILLUSTRATION 6
Manoj had the following bills receivables and bills payable against Sohan. Calculate the average due date, when
the payment can be received or made without any loss of interest.
Date Bills Receivable Tenure Date Bills Payable Tenure
` `
01/06/2020 3,000 3 month 29/05/2020 2,000 2 month
05/06/2020 2,500 3 month 03/06/2020 3,000 3 month
09/06/2020 6,000 1 month 9/06/2020 6,000 1 month
12/06/2020 1,000 2 month
20/06/2020 1,500 3 month
15 August, 2020 was a Public holiday. However, 6 September, 2020 was also declared as sudden holiday.
SOLUTION:
Let us take 12.07.2020 as Base date.
Bills receivable
Due date No. of days from 12.07.2020 Amount Product
04/09/2020 54 3,000 1,62,000
08/09/2020 58 2,500 1,45,000
12/07/2020 0 6,000 0
14/08/2020 33 1,000 33,000
23/09/2020 73 1,500 1,09,500
14,000 4,49,500
Bills payable
Due date No. of days from 12.07.2020 Amount Product
01/08/2020 20 2,000 40,000
07/09/2020 57 3,000 1,71,000
12/07/2020 0 6,000 0
11,000 2,11,000
Excess of products of bills receivable over bills payable = 4,49,500 – 2,11,000 = 2,38,500
Excess of bills receivable over bills payable = 14,000 – 11,000 = 3,000
Number of days from the base date to the date of settlement is 2,38,500/3,000 = 79.5 (appox.)
Hence date of settlement of the balance amount is 80 days after 12th July i.e. 30th September.
On 30th September, 2020 Sohan has to pay Manoj ` 3,000 to settle the account.
? ILLUSTRATION 7
Mr. Kapoor had the following Bills receivable and Bills payable against Mr. Khan, the details of which has been
given as follows-
SOLUTION
? ILLUSTRATION 8
Mr. Green and Mr. Red had the following mutual dealings and desire to settle their account on the average due
date:
SOLUTION
w Case 3: Learn calculation of average due date where amount is repaid in Instalments
Calculation of average due date in a case where the amount is lent in one instalment and repayment is done
in various instalments (opposite to what we have done in the first case). The problem takes a different shape.
The procedure for calculating average due date can be summarized as under:
Step 1: Calculate number of days/monthly/years from the date of lending money to the date of each
repayment.
Step 2: Find the total of such days/months/years.
Step 3: Quotient will be the number of days/months/years by which average due date falls away from date
of commencement of loan.
As explained earlier, if instalment are same, we can use Simple mean concept i. Divide days by number of
items and no need for product.
Thus, the formula for the average due date can be written as under:
Average due date = Date of Loan + to the date of repayment of each instalment
Number of instalments
? ILLUSTRATION 9
` 10,000 lent by Dass Bros. to Kumar & Sons on 1st January, 2015 is repayable in 5 equal annual instalments
commencing on 1st January, 2016. Find the average due date and calculate interest at 5% per annum, which
Dass Bros. will recover from Kumar & Sons.
SOLUTION
Due date No. of years from 1 Jan 2015
1Jan 2015 0
1Jan 2016 1
1Jan 2017 2
1Jan 2018 3
1Jan 2019 4
1Jan 2020 5
Average=5+4+3+2+1/5=3 years
Amount Paid on Money used by Dass Bros upto 31st Dec. 2020 Product
` `
2,000 1st Jan. 2016 5 Years 10,000
2,000 1st Jan. 2017 4 Years 8,000
2,000 1st Jan. 2018 3 Years 6,000
2,000 1st Jan. 2019 2 Years 4,000
2,000 1st Jan. 2020 1 Year 2,000
30,000
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
6.98 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
` 30,000 x 5
Interest at 5% p.a. on ` 30,000 for one year. = = ` 1,500
100
Dass Bros. will receive interest (if given on 1st Jan., 2018 on ` 10,000 from average due date to 31st Dec.,
5 x 3 x ` 10,000
2020, i.e., for 3 years at 5% p.a. = = ` 1,500
100
From the above, it can be concluded that if the borrower pays ` 2,000 yearly from 1st Jan., 2016 for 5 years
and if the lender gives ` 10,000 on 1st Jan., 2018 then both will charge same interest from each otherThere
is no loss to any of the parties. But actually lender gives ` 10,000 on 1st Jan., 2015, therefore, he has given
loan 3 years in advance and will charge interest on ` 10,000 for 3 years.
` 10,000 x 5 x 3
Interest = = ` 1,500 (to be charged by Dass Bros.)
100
? ILLUSTRATION 10
SOLUTION
Total of Product
Average due date = Base date +
Total of amount
7,50,000
1st January 2015 + = 37.5 months~ 38 months
20,000
Average due date= 1st January 2015+ 38 months = 1st March 2018.
Case 4: Learn Calculation of average due date for determining interest on drawings
In the case of drawings also, amount is drawn by the owners of business on various dates but it may settled
on one day. It should be noted that, when different amounts are due on different dates, but they are
ultimately settled on one day the interest may be calculated by means of Average Due Date. When interest
is chargeable on drawings, and drawings are on different dates, interest may be calculated on the basis of
Average Due Date of drawings determined on the basis given above. An illustration is given below to help
in understanding the same:
? ILLUSTRATION 11
A and B, two partners of a firm, have drawn the following amounts from the firm in the year ending 31st March,
2020:
A Date B
Date
` `
1 July
st
500 12 June
th
1,000
30th September 800 11th August 500
1st November 1,000 9th February 400
28th February 400 7th March 900
Interest at 6% p.a. is charged on all drawings. Calculate interest chargeable by using (i) ordinary system
(ii) Average due date system. (assume 1 year = 365 days) any function of day should be ignored.
SOLUTION
6 1
4,49,600 x x = ` 73.91
100 365
6 5.444
2,700 x x = ` 73.49
100 12
Or,
Taking 1st April as the base date (O-day):
Dates ` Months from O-day Products
A 1st July 500 3 1,500
30th September 800 6 4,800
1st November 1,000 7 7,000
28th February 400 11 4,400
2,700 17,700
17,700
Average Due Date = months from 1st April. i.e. 6.556 months i.e. 17th October.
2,700
Interest is chargeable from October 17 to March 31 i.e. 5.444 months.
6 5.444
2,700 x x = ` 73.49
100 12
June 18
July 31
Aug. 31
Sept. 30
110
131 days -110 days i.e. 21st October
So, interest is chargeable from 21st October to 31st March i.e. for 161 days.
6 161
2,800 x x = ` 74.10
100 365
The Differences in amounts in the two systems (1) and (2) are due to approximation.
? ILLUSTRATION 12
A partner in a firm has drawn the following amounts for the half year ended on 31st March 2020 :
Date Amount
9th Sep 2019 9,000
10th Oct 2019 10,000
11th Nov 2019 11,000
12th Dec 2019 12,000
13th Jan 2020 13,000
14th Feb 2020 14,000
15th Mar 2020 15,000
Assume February has 28 days
SOLUTION
SUMMARY
w Average Due Date is one on which the net amount payable can be settled without causing loss of
interest either to the borrower or the lender.
w It is used in various cases like:
(i) Calculation of interest on drawings of partners.
(ii) Cancellation of various bills of exchange due on different dates and issuance of a Single bill.
(iii) Amount lent in one instalment and repayable in various instalments.
w When the amount is lent in various instalments then average due date can be calculated as :
Every promissory note or bill of exchange (other than those payable on demand or at sight or on
presentment) falls due on the third day after on which it is expressed to be payable. This exempted
period of three days is called days of grace.
1. The specific due date excludes the addition of grace days to arrive at the due date.
2. Payment made before the average due date entitles rebate to the customer.
3. Average due date results in loss to the party making the payment.
4. It is always the date of any transaction which is considered as base date.
5. Interest has to be paid by the party making payment exactly on the average due date.
6. Where the due date is a Public holiday and the preceding day is a sudden holiday, then the due date
falls on the day preceding the sudden holiday.
Multiple Choice Questions
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. True: Where the due date is specifically given, then there is no need of further addition of 3 days grace
to it.
2. True: The rebate is given to the customers who make payment early to the average due date calculate.
3. False: It is single weighted average date calculated in such a way that it does not create any profit / loss
to both the parties involved.
4. False: The date of the earlier or most initial transaction that is considered as the base date for the
purpose of arriving at the average due date.
5. False: If payment made on the average due date, then there is no need to pay interest or provide rebate
as it is a date resulting in no profit/loss to either parties.
6. True: This can be understood from the foll ex- where August 15th is the due date, then the revised
due date is 14th- which is considered as sudden holiday, then the due date becomes 13th (preceding
working day).
MCQs
1. (c) 2. (c) 3. (a) 4. (b) 5. (c)
Theoretical Questions
1. In business enterprises, many receipts and payments by and from a single party may occur at different
points of time. To simplify the calculation of interest involved for such transactions, the idea of average
due date has been developed. Average Due Date is a break-even date on which the net amount payable
can be settled without causing loss of interest either to the borrower or the lender.
2. Few instances where average due date can be used:
(i) Calculation of interest on drawings made by the proprietors or partners of a business firm at
several points of time.
(ii) Settlement of accounts between a principal and an agent.
(iii) Settlement of contra accounts, that is, A and B sell goods to each other on different dates.
Practical Questions
Answer 1
Calculation of Interest chargeable from Partners
Taking 1st May as the base date
62,50,000
Average Due Date = days from 1st May. i.e 57 days
1,10,000
= 27thJune
Interest is chargeable for Yash from 27th June to March 31 i.e. 277 days
` 1,10,000 x 10% x 277/365 = ` 8,348
Answer 2
A B C D=B ±C
Principal Interest from Average Due Date to Actual date of Payment Total amount
Amount to be paid
(i) Payment on average due date
` 67,500 12 0
` 67,500 x x =0
100 365 ` 67,500
(ii) Payment on 25 Aug. 2020
th
` 67,500 12 15
` 67,500 x x = 333
100 365 ` 67,833
Interest to be charged for period of 15 days from 10.8.2020 to
25th Aug. 2020
(iii) Payment on 30th July, 2020
` 67,500 12 (11)
` 67,500 x x = (244)
100 365 ` 67,256
Rebate has been allowed for unexpired credit period of 11
days from 30.7.2020 to 10.8.2020
b) Learn the methods of preparing Account Current, namely preparation of Account Current with the help
of interest tables, by means of product and by means of balances.
By means of
With the help of By means of
products of
interest tables products
balances
5.1 INTRODUCTION
An Account Current is a running statement of transactions between parties for a given period of time and
includes interest allowed or charged on various items. It takes the form of an ledger account.
Some of the situations when account current is prepared are:
1. It is prepared when frequent transactions regularly take place between two parties. For example it is
prepared by a manufacturer who sells goods frequently to a merchant on credit and receives payments
from him in instalments at different intervals and charges interest on the amount which remains
outstanding.
2. A consignee of goods can also prepare an Account Current, if the latter is to settle the account at the
end of the consignment & interest is chargeable on outstanding balance.
3. An Account Current also is frequently prepared to set out the transactions taking place between a
banker and his customer.
4. It is prepared when two or more persons are in joint venture and each co-venture is entitled to interest
on their investment. Also, no separate set of book is maintained for it.
An Account Current has two parties - one who renders the account and the other to whom the account is
rendered. This is indicated in the heading of an Account Current, which is like the following: “A in Account
Current with B”. It implies that A is the customer, and the account is being rendered and prepared to him by
B.
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
6.108 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
5.2.1 Method 1: Preparation of Account Current with the help of Interest Tables-Individual Method
According to this method, all the transactions are arranged in the form of an account. There are two
additional columns on both the sides of such an account.
(a) One column is meant to indicate the number of days counted from the due date of each transaction to
the date of rendering the account. If no specific date is mentioned as the date on which payment is due,
the date of the transactions is presumed to be the due date.
(b) The other column is meant for writing interest.
With the help of ready made tables, interest due on different amounts at given rates for different periods of
time is found out and this is entered against each item separately.
The interest columns of both the sides are totalled up and the balance is drawn.
? ILLUSTRATION 1
Prepare Account Current for Nath Brothers in respect of the following transactions with Shyam:
2019 `
2020
The account is to be prepared upto 1st February. Calculate interest @ 6% per annum. (1 year = 365 days)
SOLUTION
Shyam in Account Current with Nath Brothers
(Interest to 1st February, 2020 @ 6% p.a.)
Date. Particulars Due Amount Days Interest Date Particulars Due Amount Days Interest
2019 date ` 2019 date `
Sept.16 To Sales 1st Oct. 200 123 4.04 Oct. 1 By Cash A/c 1st Oct. 90 123 1.82
A/c
Nov.1 To Cash A/c 1st Nov. 330 92 5 Oct. 21 By Purchase 1st Dec. 500 62 5.1
A/c
Dec. 1 To Cash A/c 1st Dec. 330 62 3.36 Dec. 5 By Purchase 1st Jan. 500 31 2.55
A/c
Dec.10 By Purchase 1st Jan. 200 31 1.02
A/c
2020 2020
Jan. 1 To Cash A/c 1st Jan. 600 31 3.06 Feb. 1 By Balance of 4.97
Interest
Jan. 9 To sales A/c 1st Feb. 20 Feb.1 By Balance c/d 194.97 -
Feb. 1 To Interest 4.97
1,484.97 15.46 1,484.97 15.46
Tutorial Notes:
(1) While counting the number of days, the date of due date is ignored and the date upto which the account
is prepared, is included.
(2) While counting the number of days, for opening balances, the opening date as well as date upto which
the account is prepared, is counted.
Calculation of days:
Transaction Due Date Oct. Nov. Dec. Jan. Feb. Total Days
2019
16th Sept. 1st Oct. 30+ 30+ 31+ 31+ 1= 123
1st Oct. 1st Oct. 30+ 30+ 31+ 31+ 1= 123
21st Oct. 1st Dec. - - 30+ 31+ 1= 62
1st Nov. 1st Nov. - 29+ 31+ 31+ 1= 92
1st Dec. 1st Dec. - - 30+ 31+ 1= 62
5th Dec. 1st Jan. - - - 30+ 1= 31
10th Dec. 1st Jan. - - - 30+ 1= 31
2020
1st Jan. 1st Feb. - - - 30+ 1= 31
9st Jan. 1st Feb. - - - - -= 0
2. Backward (or Epoque Method)- Under this method, the number of the days are calculated from the
opening date of statement to the due date of transaction.
EXAMPLE
From the following particulars, make up an Account Current to be rendered by Mr. X to Mr. Y on 31st December,
2019 taking interest into account at the rate of 18% p.a.
30.07. 2019 Goods sold to Mr. Y (Credit Period allowed 1 month) ` 300
01.08. 2019 Good purchased from Mr. Y (Credit Period received 1 month) ` 200
01.09. 2019 Mr. Y accepted Mr. X’s Draft at 3 Months date ` 400
You are required to prepare the Account Current according to interest on individual transaction under the Forward
and Backward methods.
SOLUTION
(a) Product of individual Transaction Method (Forward Method)
Mr. Y in Account Current with Mr. X (interest to 31st Dec. 2019 @ 18% p.a.)
Date Particulars Due Amt. Days Product Date Particulars Due Amt. Days Product
` ` ` `
date date
01.07.2019 To Balance b/d 600 184 1,10,400 01.08.2019 By Sep. 1 200 121 24,200
Purchase
A/c
30.07.2019 To Sales A/c Aug 300 123 36,900 01.09.2019 By Cash A/c Sep. 1 100 121 12,100
30
31.12. 2019 To Interest on 49 01.09.2019 By B/R A/c Dec. 4 400 27 10,800
Balance
for 1 day @
18%
[ [
1,00,200 x 18 x 1
100 x 365
[ [
[200 x
1,00,200 x 18 x 1 184]
100 x 365
31.12.2019 By Balance 249
c/d
949 - 1,18,500 949 1,18,500
? ILLUSTRATION 2
From the following particulars prepare the account current to be rendered by Mr. Singh to Mr. Paul as on 31st
August, 2020. Interest must be calculated @ 10% p.a. (1 year = 365 days)
2020 `
June 11 Goods sent to Mr. Paul 1,020
June 15 Cash received from Mr. Paul 500
June 20 Goods sent to Mr. Paul 650
July 7 Goods sent to Mr. Paul 700
Aug 8 Cash received from Mr. Paul 1,100
SOLUTION
Mr. Paul in Account Current with Mr. Singh
(Interest to 31st August, 2020 @ 10% p.a.)
Date Particulars Due Amount Days Product Date Particulars Due Amount Days Product
2020 Date ` 2020 Date `
June 11 To Sales A/c June 11 1,020 81 82,620 June 15 By Cash A/c June 15 500 77 38,500
June 20 To Sales A/c June 20 650 72 46,800 Aug.8 By Cash A/c Aug.8 1,100 23 25,300
July 7 To Sales A/c July 7 700 55 38,500 Aug.31 By Balance of 1,04,120
product
Aug.31 To Interest A/c 28.53 Aug. 31 Balance c/d 798.53
1,04,120 10
x 100
365
2,398.53 1,67,920 2,398.53 1,67,920
Sept. To Balance b/d 798.53
? ILLUSTRATION 3
Following running transactions took place between Me and You during the month of February, 2020.
SOLUTION
‘You’ In Account Current with ‘Me’
(Interest to 31st March, 2020 @ 12% p.a.)
Date Particulars Due Amount Days Product Date Particulars Due Amount Days Product
2020 Date ` 2020 Date `
Feb 1 To Balance b/d 5,000 59 2,95,000 Feb 08 By Bills May 11 10,000 - -
Receivable
Feb 5 To Sales A/c Apr 07 8,250 - - Feb 10 By Purchases Mar 10 11,000 21 2,31,000
A/c
Feb 16 To Cash A/c Feb 16 2,500 43 1,07,500 Feb 12 By Bank A/c Apr 12 7,500 - -
Feb 24 To Bills payable Mar 24 5,000 7 35,000 Feb 28 By cash A/c Feb 28 2,500 31 77,500
Mar 31 To Red ink May 11 - 41 4,10,000 Mar 31 By Red ink Apr 07 - 7 57,750
Product as per Product as
contra per contra
Mar 31 To Red ink Apr 12 - 12 90,000 Mar 31 By balance of 5,71,250
product as per product
contra
Mar 31 To Interest 188
(5,71,250x12%
× 1/365)
Mar 31 To balance C/d 10,062
31,000 9,37,500 31,000 9,37,500
? ILLUSTRATION 4
From the following prepare an account current, to be rendered by Ali to Bali on 31st December, 2020 by means of
products method charging interest @ 8% p.a:
2020 Particulars `
Oct. 1 Balance due from Bali 2,000
Oct 19 Purchased goods from Bali 3,200
Oct 25 Returned goods to Bali 800
Nov 3 Sold goods to Bali 5,400
Nov 15 Bali accepted a bill drawn by Ali for one month 2,400
Nov. 30 Bills accepted by Bali earlier dishonoured on the due date 3,000
Dec 15 Received cash from Bali 2,000
SOLUTION
Bali in Account Current with Ali
(Interest to 31st Dec 2020, @ 8% p.a.)
Date Particulars Amount Days Product Date Particulars Amount Days Product
2020 ` 2020 `
Oct.1 To Balance b/d 2,000 92 1,84000 Oct.19 By Purchases A/c 3,200 73 2,33,600
Oct. 25 To Purchase returns 800 67 53,600 Dec. 18 By Bills receivable 2,400 13 31,200
A/c A/c (drawn for a
month)
Nov. 3 To Sales A/c 5,400 58 3,13,200 Dec 15 By cash A/c 2,000 16 32,000
Nov 30 To bills receivable 3,000 31 93,000 Dec. 31 By Balance of 3,47,000
(dishonoured) products
Dec. 31 To Interest Ac 76.05 Dec 31 By Balance c/d 3676.05
11,276.05 6,43,800 11,276.05 6,43,800
? ILLUSTRATION 5
From the following particulars make up an Account Current to be rendered by S. Dasgupta to A. Halder at 31st
Dec. reckoning interest at 5% p.a. (assume 1 year = 365 days)
2019 `
June 30 Balance owing by A. Halder 520
July 17 Goods sold to A. Halder 40
Aug. 1 Cash received from A. Halder 500
Aug. 19 Goods sold to A. Halder 720
Aug. 30 Goods sold to A. Halder 50
Sept. 1 Cash received from A. Halder 400
Sept. 1 A. Halder accepted Dasgupta’s Bill at 3 month date for 300
Oct. 22 Goods bought from A. Halder 20
Nov. 12 Goods sold to A. Halder 14
Dec. 14 Cash received from A. Halder 50
SOLUTION
A. Halder in Current Account with Mr. S. Dasgupta
(Interest to 31st December, 2019 @ 5% p.a.)
Date Particulars Due Amount Days Product Date Particulars Due Amount Days Product
June 30 To Balance b/d 520 185 96,200 Aug.1 By Cash A/c Aug.1 500 152 76,000
July 17 To Sales A/c July 17 40 167 6,680 Sep.1 By Cash A/c Sep.1 400 121 48,400
Aug.19 To Sales A/c Aug.19 720 134 96,480 Sep.1 By Bills Dec.4 300 27 8,100
Receivable
A/c (Note : 1)
Aug. 30 To Sales A/c Aug.30 50 123 6,150 Oct.22 By Purchases Oct.22 20 70 1,400
A/c
Nov.12 To Sales A/c Nov.12 14 49 686 Dec.14 By Cash A/c Dec.14 50 17 850
71,446 x 5%
365
1,353.79 2,06,196 1,353.79 2,06,196
Note: It is assumed that the bill was honoured on due date. The due date of the bill should be treated as date
of payment and days to be calculated from the due date of account.
Workings:
Calculation of Days
Date of Transactions : Due date June July Aug. Sept. Oct. Nov. Dec. Total
Opening Balance 1 +31 +31 +30 +31 +30 +31 = 185
July 17 July 17 - 14 +31 +30 +31 +30 +31 = 167
Aug. 1 Aug. 1 - - 30 +30 +31 +30 +31 = 152
Aug. 19 Aug. 19 - - 12 +30 +31 +30 +31 = 134
Aug. 30 Aug. 30 - - 1 +30 +31 +30 +31 = 123
Sep. 1 Sep. 1 - - - 29 +31 +30 +31 = 121
Sep. 1 Dec. 4 - - - - - - 27 = 27
Oct. 22 Oct. 22 - - - - 9 +30 +31 = 70
Nov. 12 Nov. 12 - - - - - 18 +31 = 49
Dec. 14 Dec. 14 - - - - - - 17 = 17
Note: While counting the number of days, for opening balances, the opening date as well as date upto
which the account is prepared, is counted.
? ILLUSTRATION 6
From the following prepare an account current, as sent by A to B on 30th June, 2020 by means of products method
charging interest @ 6% p.a:
2020 `
Jan. 1 Balance due from B 600
Jan.11 Sold goods to B 520
Jan. 18 B returns Goods 125
Feb 11 B Paid by cheque 400
Feb 14 B accepted a bill drawn by A for one month 300
Apr. 29 Goods sold to B 615
May 15 Received cash from B 700
SOLUTION
B in Account Current with A
(Interest to 31st June 2020, @ 6% p.a.)
Date Particulars Amount Days Products Date Particulars Amount Days Products
2020 ` 2020 `
Jan.1 To Balance b/d 600 182 1,09,200 Jan.18 By Sales Returns 125 164 20,500
Jan. 11 To Sales A/c 520 171 88,920 Feb. 11 By Bank A/c 400 140 56,000
Apr. 29 To Sales A/c 615 62 38,130 Feb. 14 By B/R A/c (due 300 105 31,500
June 30 To Interest A/c 15.75 date: March 17)
May 15 By Cash A/c 700 46 32,200
June By Balance of 96,050
30 products
By Balance c/d 225.75
1,750.75 2,36,250 1,750.75 2,36,250
Calculation of interest:
96,050 6
Interest = x = ` 15.75
366 100
Red - Ink Interest: In case the due date of a bill falls after the date of closing the account, then no interest
is allowed for that. However, interest from the date of closing to such due date is written in “Red-Ink” in
the appropriate side of the ‘Account current’. This interest is called Red-Ink interest. This Red Ink interest is
treated as negative interest. In actual practice, however the product of such bill [value of bill X (due date-
closing date) is written in ordinary ink in the opposite side on which the bill is entered]. It means interest
from future date from date of account current i.e., present date. In earlier periods, it was written in red ink;
hence it got the name of red ink interest. It implies that rebate will be allowed on interest paid/ received, if
settlement of future due transaction is done on account current date
This can also be understood in a different way. In an account current, interest is calculated on the amount
of a bill from the date of transaction to the closing date of the period concerned. In case the due date of
the bill falls after the closing date of the accounts, then no interest is allowed for that period. Such interest
is customarily written in red ink in the appropriate side of the account current. The interest is called Red-Ink
interest and is treated as negative interest.
? ILLUSTRATION 7
Following transaction took place between X and Y during the month of April, 2020.
April `
1 Amount payable by X to Y 10,000
7 Received acceptance of X to Y for 2 months 5,000
10 Bills receivable (accepted by Y) on 7.2.2020 is honoured on this due date
10 X sold goods to Y (invoice dated 10.5.2020) 15,000
12 X received cheque form Y dated 15.5.2020 7,500
15 Y sold goods to X (invoice dated 15.5.2020) 6,000
20 X returned goods sold by Y on 15.4.2020 1,000
20 Bill accepted by Y is dishonoured on this due date 5,000
You are required to make out an account current by products method to be rendered by X to Y as on 30.4.2020,
taking interest into account @ 10% p.a. (assume 1 year = 365 days)
SOLUTION
‘Y’ In Account Current with ‘X’
(Interest to 30th April, 2020 @ 10% p.a.)
Date Particulars Due Amount Days Product Date Particulars Due Amount Days Product
Date ` Date `
2020 2020 2020 2020
April 7 To Bills June 10 5,000 - - April 1 By Balance b/d 10,000 30 3,00,000
Payable
April 10 To Sales A/c May 10 15,000 - - April 12 By Bank A/c May 15 7,500 - -
(Cheque received
dated 15.5.2016)
April 20 To Purchase May 15 1,000 - - April 15 By Purchase A/c May 15 6,000 - -
Returns (invoice dated
15.5.2016)
April 20 To Bill April 20 5,000 10 50,000
Receivable
A/c
April 30 To Red Ink May 15 15 1,12,500 April 30 By Red Ink Product June10 - 41 2,05,000
Product as per contra
(` 7,500 x15) (5,000 x 41)
as per contra
April 30 To Red Ink May 15 15 90,000 April 30 By Red Ink May 10 - 10 1,50,000
Product Product
(` 6,000 x15) as per contra
as per contra (15,000 x 10)
April 30 To Balance 4,17,500 April 30 By Red Ink May 15 - - 15,000
of Product as per
product contra
(1,000 x 15)
April 30 By Interest A/c 114.38
10 1
4,17,500 x x
100 365
April 30 By Balance c/d 2,385.62
26,000 6,70,000 26,000 6,70,000
© The Institute of Chartered Accountants of India
6.118 PRINCIPLES AND PRACTICE OF ACCOUNTING
No entry is required for matured bill on 10th April since party is not contracted.
5.2.4 Method 3: Preparation of Account Current by Means of Product of Balances in case of Banks.
This method, also known as periodic balance method, is usually adopted in the case of banks where the
balance of account is taken out after every transaction. In this case, the number of days written against each
transaction are the days counted from its date or due date to the date of the following transaction. In the
case of the last transaction, the number of days is counted to the close of the period.
Each amount is multiplied with the number of days. If the amount represents a debit balance, the product
is entered in the Dr. Product column; and if it represents a credit balance, the product is written in the Cr.
Product column. The Dr. Product and Cr. Product columns are then totalled up. Interest is calculated on each
total at the given rate of interest; and the net interest is ascertained. If net interest is payable to the customer,
it will appear as “By Interest A/c”, and if it is due from the customer, it will appear as “To Interest A/c”.
? ILLUSTRATION 8
On 2nd January, 2020 Vinod opened a current account with the Allahabad Bank Limited; and deposited a sum of
` 30,000.
SOLUTION
Vinod Current Account with Allahabad Bank Ltd.
Date Particular Dr. Cr. Dr. or Cr. Balance Days Dr. Product Cr. Product
2020
SUMMARY
w When interest calculation becomes an integral part of the account. The account maintained is called
“Account Current”.
Some examples where it is maintained are:
(i) Frequent transactions between two parties.
(ii) Goods sent on consignment
(iii) Frequent transactions between a banker and his customers
(iv) In case of Joint venture when no separate set of books is maintained for joint venture
w There are three ways of preparing an Account Current :
(i) With the help of interest tables
(ii) By means of products
(iii) By means of products of balances
Theoretical Questions
1. Define Account Current. Explain ways of preparing an Account Current
2. Write short note on Red-ink interest.
Practical Questions
1. Roshan has a current account with partnership firm. It has debit balance of ` 75,000 as on 01-07-2020.
He has further deposited the following amounts:
Date Amount (`)
14-07-2020 1,38,000
18-08-2020 22,000
He withdrew the following amounts :
Date Amount (`)
29-07-2020 97,000
09-09-2020 11,000
Show Roshan’s A/c in the ledger of the firm. Interest is to be calculated at 10% on debit balance and 8% on
credit balance. You are required to prepare current account as on 30th September, 2020 by means of product
of balances method.
2. From the following particulars prepare a account current, as sent by Mr. Ram to Mr. Siva as on 31st
October 2020 by means of product method charging interest @ 5% p.a.
2020 Particulars `
1st July Balance due from Siva 750
15th August Sold goods to Siva 1250
20th August Goods returned by Siva 200
22nd Sep Siva paid by cheque 800
15th Oct Received cash from Siva 500
ANSWERS/HINTS
True and False
1. False: Account current statement of running transaction between two parties to ascertain the amount
along with interest payable. Current account is an account type to be maintained with the bank. In both
the interest is calculate, but then different methods to calculate the interest.
2. True: An extension of the counter transactions between two parties type under the average due date-
where in the date of the initial transaction is considered as the base date from which the no. of days to
the date of rendering the account is calculated.
3. False: The due date is considered for the purpose of calculation of number of days and not the date of
transaction.
4. False: It is B who is preparing and rendering the account current to Mr. A.
5. True: The bills of exchange which is honored will not appear in the account current, only in case of
dishonor, it will be appearing in the account current.
MCQs
1. (b) 2. (a) 3. (a)
Theoretical Questions
1. An Account Current is a running statement of transactions between parties for a given period of time
and includes interest allowed or charged on various items. It takes the form of an ledger account.
There are three ways of preparing an Account Current:
(i) With help of interest table.
(ii) By means of products.
(iii) By means of products of balances.
2. In case the due date of a bill falls after the date of closing the account, then no interest is allowed for that.
However, interest from the date of closing to such due date is written in “Red-Ink” in the appropriate
side of the ‘Account current’. This interest is called Red-Ink interest. This Red Ink interest is treated as
negative interest. In actual practice, however the product of such bill [value of bill X (due date-closing
date) is written in ordinary ink in the opposite side on which the bill is entered]. It means interest from
future date from date of account current i.e., present date. In earlier periods, it was written in red ink;
hence it got the name of red ink interest. It implies that rebate will be allowed on interest paid/ received,
if settlement of future due transaction is done on account current date
Practical Questions
Answers 1
Roshan’s Current Account with Partnership firm (as on 30.9.2020)
5 1
Interest = ` 1,34,900 x x = ` 18.48
100 365